* tramp-tests.el (tramp-test19-directory-files-and-attributes):
[bpt/emacs.git] / doc / misc / texinfo.tex
1 % texinfo.tex -- TeX macros to handle Texinfo files.
2 %
3 % Load plain if necessary, i.e., if running under initex.
4 \expandafter\ifx\csname fmtname\endcsname\relax\input plain\fi
5 %
6 \def\texinfoversion{2014-02-09.15}
7 %
8 % Copyright 1985, 1986, 1988, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995,
9 % 1996, 1997, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002, 2003, 2004, 2005, 2006,
10 % 2007, 2008, 2009, 2010, 2011, 2012, 2013, 2014 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
11 %
12 % This texinfo.tex file is free software: you can redistribute it and/or
13 % modify it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as
14 % published by the Free Software Foundation, either version 3 of the
15 % License, or (at your option) any later version.
16 %
17 % This texinfo.tex file is distributed in the hope that it will be
18 % useful, but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty
19 % of MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the GNU
20 % General Public License for more details.
21 %
22 % You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
23 % along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>.
24 %
25 % As a special exception, when this file is read by TeX when processing
26 % a Texinfo source document, you may use the result without
27 % restriction. This Exception is an additional permission under section 7
28 % of the GNU General Public License, version 3 ("GPLv3").
29 %
30 % Please try the latest version of texinfo.tex before submitting bug
31 % reports; you can get the latest version from:
32 % http://ftp.gnu.org/gnu/texinfo/ (the Texinfo release area), or
33 % http://ftpmirror.gnu.org/texinfo/ (same, via a mirror), or
34 % http://www.gnu.org/software/texinfo/ (the Texinfo home page)
35 % The texinfo.tex in any given distribution could well be out
36 % of date, so if that's what you're using, please check.
37 %
38 % Send bug reports to bug-texinfo@gnu.org. Please include including a
39 % complete document in each bug report with which we can reproduce the
40 % problem. Patches are, of course, greatly appreciated.
41 %
42 % To process a Texinfo manual with TeX, it's most reliable to use the
43 % texi2dvi shell script that comes with the distribution. For a simple
44 % manual foo.texi, however, you can get away with this:
45 % tex foo.texi
46 % texindex foo.??
47 % tex foo.texi
48 % tex foo.texi
49 % dvips foo.dvi -o # or whatever; this makes foo.ps.
50 % The extra TeX runs get the cross-reference information correct.
51 % Sometimes one run after texindex suffices, and sometimes you need more
52 % than two; texi2dvi does it as many times as necessary.
53 %
54 % It is possible to adapt texinfo.tex for other languages, to some
55 % extent. You can get the existing language-specific files from the
56 % full Texinfo distribution.
57 %
58 % The GNU Texinfo home page is http://www.gnu.org/software/texinfo.
59
60
61 \message{Loading texinfo [version \texinfoversion]:}
62
63 % If in a .fmt file, print the version number
64 % and turn on active characters that we couldn't do earlier because
65 % they might have appeared in the input file name.
66 \everyjob{\message{[Texinfo version \texinfoversion]}%
67 \catcode`+=\active \catcode`\_=\active}
68
69 \chardef\other=12
70
71 % We never want plain's \outer definition of \+ in Texinfo.
72 % For @tex, we can use \tabalign.
73 \let\+ = \relax
74
75 % Save some plain tex macros whose names we will redefine.
76 \let\ptexb=\b
77 \let\ptexbullet=\bullet
78 \let\ptexc=\c
79 \let\ptexcomma=\,
80 \let\ptexdot=\.
81 \let\ptexdots=\dots
82 \let\ptexend=\end
83 \let\ptexequiv=\equiv
84 \let\ptexexclam=\!
85 \let\ptexfootnote=\footnote
86 \let\ptexgtr=>
87 \let\ptexhat=^
88 \let\ptexi=\i
89 \let\ptexindent=\indent
90 \let\ptexinsert=\insert
91 \let\ptexlbrace=\{
92 \let\ptexless=<
93 \let\ptexnewwrite\newwrite
94 \let\ptexnoindent=\noindent
95 \let\ptexplus=+
96 \let\ptexraggedright=\raggedright
97 \let\ptexrbrace=\}
98 \let\ptexslash=\/
99 \let\ptexstar=\*
100 \let\ptext=\t
101 \let\ptextop=\top
102 {\catcode`\'=\active \global\let\ptexquoteright'}% active in plain's math mode
103
104 % If this character appears in an error message or help string, it
105 % starts a new line in the output.
106 \newlinechar = `^^J
107
108 % Use TeX 3.0's \inputlineno to get the line number, for better error
109 % messages, but if we're using an old version of TeX, don't do anything.
110 %
111 \ifx\inputlineno\thisisundefined
112 \let\linenumber = \empty % Pre-3.0.
113 \else
114 \def\linenumber{l.\the\inputlineno:\space}
115 \fi
116
117 % Set up fixed words for English if not already set.
118 \ifx\putwordAppendix\undefined \gdef\putwordAppendix{Appendix}\fi
119 \ifx\putwordChapter\undefined \gdef\putwordChapter{Chapter}\fi
120 \ifx\putworderror\undefined \gdef\putworderror{error}\fi
121 \ifx\putwordfile\undefined \gdef\putwordfile{file}\fi
122 \ifx\putwordin\undefined \gdef\putwordin{in}\fi
123 \ifx\putwordIndexIsEmpty\undefined \gdef\putwordIndexIsEmpty{(Index is empty)}\fi
124 \ifx\putwordIndexNonexistent\undefined \gdef\putwordIndexNonexistent{(Index is nonexistent)}\fi
125 \ifx\putwordInfo\undefined \gdef\putwordInfo{Info}\fi
126 \ifx\putwordInstanceVariableof\undefined \gdef\putwordInstanceVariableof{Instance Variable of}\fi
127 \ifx\putwordMethodon\undefined \gdef\putwordMethodon{Method on}\fi
128 \ifx\putwordNoTitle\undefined \gdef\putwordNoTitle{No Title}\fi
129 \ifx\putwordof\undefined \gdef\putwordof{of}\fi
130 \ifx\putwordon\undefined \gdef\putwordon{on}\fi
131 \ifx\putwordpage\undefined \gdef\putwordpage{page}\fi
132 \ifx\putwordsection\undefined \gdef\putwordsection{section}\fi
133 \ifx\putwordSection\undefined \gdef\putwordSection{Section}\fi
134 \ifx\putwordsee\undefined \gdef\putwordsee{see}\fi
135 \ifx\putwordSee\undefined \gdef\putwordSee{See}\fi
136 \ifx\putwordShortTOC\undefined \gdef\putwordShortTOC{Short Contents}\fi
137 \ifx\putwordTOC\undefined \gdef\putwordTOC{Table of Contents}\fi
138 %
139 \ifx\putwordMJan\undefined \gdef\putwordMJan{January}\fi
140 \ifx\putwordMFeb\undefined \gdef\putwordMFeb{February}\fi
141 \ifx\putwordMMar\undefined \gdef\putwordMMar{March}\fi
142 \ifx\putwordMApr\undefined \gdef\putwordMApr{April}\fi
143 \ifx\putwordMMay\undefined \gdef\putwordMMay{May}\fi
144 \ifx\putwordMJun\undefined \gdef\putwordMJun{June}\fi
145 \ifx\putwordMJul\undefined \gdef\putwordMJul{July}\fi
146 \ifx\putwordMAug\undefined \gdef\putwordMAug{August}\fi
147 \ifx\putwordMSep\undefined \gdef\putwordMSep{September}\fi
148 \ifx\putwordMOct\undefined \gdef\putwordMOct{October}\fi
149 \ifx\putwordMNov\undefined \gdef\putwordMNov{November}\fi
150 \ifx\putwordMDec\undefined \gdef\putwordMDec{December}\fi
151 %
152 \ifx\putwordDefmac\undefined \gdef\putwordDefmac{Macro}\fi
153 \ifx\putwordDefspec\undefined \gdef\putwordDefspec{Special Form}\fi
154 \ifx\putwordDefvar\undefined \gdef\putwordDefvar{Variable}\fi
155 \ifx\putwordDefopt\undefined \gdef\putwordDefopt{User Option}\fi
156 \ifx\putwordDeffunc\undefined \gdef\putwordDeffunc{Function}\fi
157
158 % Since the category of space is not known, we have to be careful.
159 \chardef\spacecat = 10
160 \def\spaceisspace{\catcode`\ =\spacecat}
161
162 % sometimes characters are active, so we need control sequences.
163 \chardef\ampChar = `\&
164 \chardef\colonChar = `\:
165 \chardef\commaChar = `\,
166 \chardef\dashChar = `\-
167 \chardef\dotChar = `\.
168 \chardef\exclamChar= `\!
169 \chardef\hashChar = `\#
170 \chardef\lquoteChar= `\`
171 \chardef\questChar = `\?
172 \chardef\rquoteChar= `\'
173 \chardef\semiChar = `\;
174 \chardef\slashChar = `\/
175 \chardef\underChar = `\_
176
177 % Ignore a token.
178 %
179 \def\gobble#1{}
180
181 % The following is used inside several \edef's.
182 \def\makecsname#1{\expandafter\noexpand\csname#1\endcsname}
183
184 % Hyphenation fixes.
185 \hyphenation{
186 Flor-i-da Ghost-script Ghost-view Mac-OS Post-Script
187 ap-pen-dix bit-map bit-maps
188 data-base data-bases eshell fall-ing half-way long-est man-u-script
189 man-u-scripts mini-buf-fer mini-buf-fers over-view par-a-digm
190 par-a-digms rath-er rec-tan-gu-lar ro-bot-ics se-vere-ly set-up spa-ces
191 spell-ing spell-ings
192 stand-alone strong-est time-stamp time-stamps which-ever white-space
193 wide-spread wrap-around
194 }
195
196 % Margin to add to right of even pages, to left of odd pages.
197 \newdimen\bindingoffset
198 \newdimen\normaloffset
199 \newdimen\pagewidth \newdimen\pageheight
200
201 % For a final copy, take out the rectangles
202 % that mark overfull boxes (in case you have decided
203 % that the text looks ok even though it passes the margin).
204 %
205 \def\finalout{\overfullrule=0pt }
206
207 % Sometimes it is convenient to have everything in the transcript file
208 % and nothing on the terminal. We don't just call \tracingall here,
209 % since that produces some useless output on the terminal. We also make
210 % some effort to order the tracing commands to reduce output in the log
211 % file; cf. trace.sty in LaTeX.
212 %
213 \def\gloggingall{\begingroup \globaldefs = 1 \loggingall \endgroup}%
214 \def\loggingall{%
215 \tracingstats2
216 \tracingpages1
217 \tracinglostchars2 % 2 gives us more in etex
218 \tracingparagraphs1
219 \tracingoutput1
220 \tracingmacros2
221 \tracingrestores1
222 \showboxbreadth\maxdimen \showboxdepth\maxdimen
223 \ifx\eTeXversion\thisisundefined\else % etex gives us more logging
224 \tracingscantokens1
225 \tracingifs1
226 \tracinggroups1
227 \tracingnesting2
228 \tracingassigns1
229 \fi
230 \tracingcommands3 % 3 gives us more in etex
231 \errorcontextlines16
232 }%
233
234 % @errormsg{MSG}. Do the index-like expansions on MSG, but if things
235 % aren't perfect, it's not the end of the world, being an error message,
236 % after all.
237 %
238 \def\errormsg{\begingroup \indexnofonts \doerrormsg}
239 \def\doerrormsg#1{\errmessage{#1}}
240
241 % add check for \lastpenalty to plain's definitions. If the last thing
242 % we did was a \nobreak, we don't want to insert more space.
243 %
244 \def\smallbreak{\ifnum\lastpenalty<10000\par\ifdim\lastskip<\smallskipamount
245 \removelastskip\penalty-50\smallskip\fi\fi}
246 \def\medbreak{\ifnum\lastpenalty<10000\par\ifdim\lastskip<\medskipamount
247 \removelastskip\penalty-100\medskip\fi\fi}
248 \def\bigbreak{\ifnum\lastpenalty<10000\par\ifdim\lastskip<\bigskipamount
249 \removelastskip\penalty-200\bigskip\fi\fi}
250
251 % Do @cropmarks to get crop marks.
252 %
253 \newif\ifcropmarks
254 \let\cropmarks = \cropmarkstrue
255 %
256 % Dimensions to add cropmarks at corners.
257 % Added by P. A. MacKay, 12 Nov. 1986
258 %
259 \newdimen\outerhsize \newdimen\outervsize % set by the paper size routines
260 \newdimen\cornerlong \cornerlong=1pc
261 \newdimen\cornerthick \cornerthick=.3pt
262 \newdimen\topandbottommargin \topandbottommargin=.75in
263
264 % Output a mark which sets \thischapter, \thissection and \thiscolor.
265 % We dump everything together because we only have one kind of mark.
266 % This works because we only use \botmark / \topmark, not \firstmark.
267 %
268 % A mark contains a subexpression of the \ifcase ... \fi construct.
269 % \get*marks macros below extract the needed part using \ifcase.
270 %
271 % Another complication is to let the user choose whether \thischapter
272 % (\thissection) refers to the chapter (section) in effect at the top
273 % of a page, or that at the bottom of a page. The solution is
274 % described on page 260 of The TeXbook. It involves outputting two
275 % marks for the sectioning macros, one before the section break, and
276 % one after. I won't pretend I can describe this better than DEK...
277 \def\domark{%
278 \toks0=\expandafter{\lastchapterdefs}%
279 \toks2=\expandafter{\lastsectiondefs}%
280 \toks4=\expandafter{\prevchapterdefs}%
281 \toks6=\expandafter{\prevsectiondefs}%
282 \toks8=\expandafter{\lastcolordefs}%
283 \mark{%
284 \the\toks0 \the\toks2 % 0: top marks (\last...)
285 \noexpand\or \the\toks4 \the\toks6 % 1: bottom marks (default, \prev...)
286 \noexpand\else \the\toks8 % 2: color marks
287 }%
288 }
289 % \topmark doesn't work for the very first chapter (after the title
290 % page or the contents), so we use \firstmark there -- this gets us
291 % the mark with the chapter defs, unless the user sneaks in, e.g.,
292 % @setcolor (or @url, or @link, etc.) between @contents and the very
293 % first @chapter.
294 \def\gettopheadingmarks{%
295 \ifcase0\topmark\fi
296 \ifx\thischapter\empty \ifcase0\firstmark\fi \fi
297 }
298 \def\getbottomheadingmarks{\ifcase1\botmark\fi}
299 \def\getcolormarks{\ifcase2\topmark\fi}
300
301 % Avoid "undefined control sequence" errors.
302 \def\lastchapterdefs{}
303 \def\lastsectiondefs{}
304 \def\prevchapterdefs{}
305 \def\prevsectiondefs{}
306 \def\lastcolordefs{}
307
308 % Main output routine.
309 \chardef\PAGE = 255
310 \output = {\onepageout{\pagecontents\PAGE}}
311
312 \newbox\headlinebox
313 \newbox\footlinebox
314
315 % \onepageout takes a vbox as an argument. Note that \pagecontents
316 % does insertions, but you have to call it yourself.
317 \def\onepageout#1{%
318 \ifcropmarks \hoffset=0pt \else \hoffset=\normaloffset \fi
319 %
320 \ifodd\pageno \advance\hoffset by \bindingoffset
321 \else \advance\hoffset by -\bindingoffset\fi
322 %
323 % Do this outside of the \shipout so @code etc. will be expanded in
324 % the headline as they should be, not taken literally (outputting ''code).
325 \def\commmonheadfootline{\let\hsize=\pagewidth \texinfochars}
326 %
327 \ifodd\pageno \getoddheadingmarks \else \getevenheadingmarks \fi
328 \global\setbox\headlinebox = \vbox{\commmonheadfootline \makeheadline}%
329 %
330 \ifodd\pageno \getoddfootingmarks \else \getevenfootingmarks \fi
331 \global\setbox\footlinebox = \vbox{\commmonheadfootline \makefootline}%
332 %
333 {%
334 % Have to do this stuff outside the \shipout because we want it to
335 % take effect in \write's, yet the group defined by the \vbox ends
336 % before the \shipout runs.
337 %
338 \indexdummies % don't expand commands in the output.
339 \normalturnoffactive % \ in index entries must not stay \, e.g., if
340 % the page break happens to be in the middle of an example.
341 % We don't want .vr (or whatever) entries like this:
342 % \entry{{\tt \indexbackslash }acronym}{32}{\code {\acronym}}
343 % "\acronym" won't work when it's read back in;
344 % it needs to be
345 % {\code {{\tt \backslashcurfont }acronym}
346 \shipout\vbox{%
347 % Do this early so pdf references go to the beginning of the page.
348 \ifpdfmakepagedest \pdfdest name{\the\pageno} xyz\fi
349 %
350 \ifcropmarks \vbox to \outervsize\bgroup
351 \hsize = \outerhsize
352 \vskip-\topandbottommargin
353 \vtop to0pt{%
354 \line{\ewtop\hfil\ewtop}%
355 \nointerlineskip
356 \line{%
357 \vbox{\moveleft\cornerthick\nstop}%
358 \hfill
359 \vbox{\moveright\cornerthick\nstop}%
360 }%
361 \vss}%
362 \vskip\topandbottommargin
363 \line\bgroup
364 \hfil % center the page within the outer (page) hsize.
365 \ifodd\pageno\hskip\bindingoffset\fi
366 \vbox\bgroup
367 \fi
368 %
369 \unvbox\headlinebox
370 \pagebody{#1}%
371 \ifdim\ht\footlinebox > 0pt
372 % Only leave this space if the footline is nonempty.
373 % (We lessened \vsize for it in \oddfootingyyy.)
374 % The \baselineskip=24pt in plain's \makefootline has no effect.
375 \vskip 24pt
376 \unvbox\footlinebox
377 \fi
378 %
379 \ifcropmarks
380 \egroup % end of \vbox\bgroup
381 \hfil\egroup % end of (centering) \line\bgroup
382 \vskip\topandbottommargin plus1fill minus1fill
383 \boxmaxdepth = \cornerthick
384 \vbox to0pt{\vss
385 \line{%
386 \vbox{\moveleft\cornerthick\nsbot}%
387 \hfill
388 \vbox{\moveright\cornerthick\nsbot}%
389 }%
390 \nointerlineskip
391 \line{\ewbot\hfil\ewbot}%
392 }%
393 \egroup % \vbox from first cropmarks clause
394 \fi
395 }% end of \shipout\vbox
396 }% end of group with \indexdummies
397 \advancepageno
398 \ifnum\outputpenalty>-20000 \else\dosupereject\fi
399 }
400
401 \newinsert\margin \dimen\margin=\maxdimen
402
403 \def\pagebody#1{\vbox to\pageheight{\boxmaxdepth=\maxdepth #1}}
404 {\catcode`\@ =11
405 \gdef\pagecontents#1{\ifvoid\topins\else\unvbox\topins\fi
406 % marginal hacks, juha@viisa.uucp (Juha Takala)
407 \ifvoid\margin\else % marginal info is present
408 \rlap{\kern\hsize\vbox to\z@{\kern1pt\box\margin \vss}}\fi
409 \dimen@=\dp#1\relax \unvbox#1\relax
410 \ifvoid\footins\else\vskip\skip\footins\footnoterule \unvbox\footins\fi
411 \ifr@ggedbottom \kern-\dimen@ \vfil \fi}
412 }
413
414 % Here are the rules for the cropmarks. Note that they are
415 % offset so that the space between them is truly \outerhsize or \outervsize
416 % (P. A. MacKay, 12 November, 1986)
417 %
418 \def\ewtop{\vrule height\cornerthick depth0pt width\cornerlong}
419 \def\nstop{\vbox
420 {\hrule height\cornerthick depth\cornerlong width\cornerthick}}
421 \def\ewbot{\vrule height0pt depth\cornerthick width\cornerlong}
422 \def\nsbot{\vbox
423 {\hrule height\cornerlong depth\cornerthick width\cornerthick}}
424
425 % Parse an argument, then pass it to #1. The argument is the rest of
426 % the input line (except we remove a trailing comment). #1 should be a
427 % macro which expects an ordinary undelimited TeX argument.
428 %
429 \def\parsearg{\parseargusing{}}
430 \def\parseargusing#1#2{%
431 \def\argtorun{#2}%
432 \begingroup
433 \obeylines
434 \spaceisspace
435 #1%
436 \parseargline\empty% Insert the \empty token, see \finishparsearg below.
437 }
438
439 {\obeylines %
440 \gdef\parseargline#1^^M{%
441 \endgroup % End of the group started in \parsearg.
442 \argremovecomment #1\comment\ArgTerm%
443 }%
444 }
445
446 % First remove any @comment, then any @c comment.
447 \def\argremovecomment#1\comment#2\ArgTerm{\argremovec #1\c\ArgTerm}
448 \def\argremovec#1\c#2\ArgTerm{\argcheckspaces#1\^^M\ArgTerm}
449
450 % Each occurrence of `\^^M' or `<space>\^^M' is replaced by a single space.
451 %
452 % \argremovec might leave us with trailing space, e.g.,
453 % @end itemize @c foo
454 % This space token undergoes the same procedure and is eventually removed
455 % by \finishparsearg.
456 %
457 \def\argcheckspaces#1\^^M{\argcheckspacesX#1\^^M \^^M}
458 \def\argcheckspacesX#1 \^^M{\argcheckspacesY#1\^^M}
459 \def\argcheckspacesY#1\^^M#2\^^M#3\ArgTerm{%
460 \def\temp{#3}%
461 \ifx\temp\empty
462 % Do not use \next, perhaps the caller of \parsearg uses it; reuse \temp:
463 \let\temp\finishparsearg
464 \else
465 \let\temp\argcheckspaces
466 \fi
467 % Put the space token in:
468 \temp#1 #3\ArgTerm
469 }
470
471 % If a _delimited_ argument is enclosed in braces, they get stripped; so
472 % to get _exactly_ the rest of the line, we had to prevent such situation.
473 % We prepended an \empty token at the very beginning and we expand it now,
474 % just before passing the control to \argtorun.
475 % (Similarly, we have to think about #3 of \argcheckspacesY above: it is
476 % either the null string, or it ends with \^^M---thus there is no danger
477 % that a pair of braces would be stripped.
478 %
479 % But first, we have to remove the trailing space token.
480 %
481 \def\finishparsearg#1 \ArgTerm{\expandafter\argtorun\expandafter{#1}}
482
483 % \parseargdef\foo{...}
484 % is roughly equivalent to
485 % \def\foo{\parsearg\Xfoo}
486 % \def\Xfoo#1{...}
487 %
488 % Actually, I use \csname\string\foo\endcsname, ie. \\foo, as it is my
489 % favourite TeX trick. --kasal, 16nov03
490
491 \def\parseargdef#1{%
492 \expandafter \doparseargdef \csname\string#1\endcsname #1%
493 }
494 \def\doparseargdef#1#2{%
495 \def#2{\parsearg#1}%
496 \def#1##1%
497 }
498
499 % Several utility definitions with active space:
500 {
501 \obeyspaces
502 \gdef\obeyedspace{ }
503
504 % Make each space character in the input produce a normal interword
505 % space in the output. Don't allow a line break at this space, as this
506 % is used only in environments like @example, where each line of input
507 % should produce a line of output anyway.
508 %
509 \gdef\sepspaces{\obeyspaces\let =\tie}
510
511 % If an index command is used in an @example environment, any spaces
512 % therein should become regular spaces in the raw index file, not the
513 % expansion of \tie (\leavevmode \penalty \@M \ ).
514 \gdef\unsepspaces{\let =\space}
515 }
516
517
518 \def\flushcr{\ifx\par\lisppar \def\next##1{}\else \let\next=\relax \fi \next}
519
520 % Define the framework for environments in texinfo.tex. It's used like this:
521 %
522 % \envdef\foo{...}
523 % \def\Efoo{...}
524 %
525 % It's the responsibility of \envdef to insert \begingroup before the
526 % actual body; @end closes the group after calling \Efoo. \envdef also
527 % defines \thisenv, so the current environment is known; @end checks
528 % whether the environment name matches. The \checkenv macro can also be
529 % used to check whether the current environment is the one expected.
530 %
531 % Non-false conditionals (@iftex, @ifset) don't fit into this, so they
532 % are not treated as environments; they don't open a group. (The
533 % implementation of @end takes care not to call \endgroup in this
534 % special case.)
535
536
537 % At run-time, environments start with this:
538 \def\startenvironment#1{\begingroup\def\thisenv{#1}}
539 % initialize
540 \let\thisenv\empty
541
542 % ... but they get defined via ``\envdef\foo{...}'':
543 \long\def\envdef#1#2{\def#1{\startenvironment#1#2}}
544 \def\envparseargdef#1#2{\parseargdef#1{\startenvironment#1#2}}
545
546 % Check whether we're in the right environment:
547 \def\checkenv#1{%
548 \def\temp{#1}%
549 \ifx\thisenv\temp
550 \else
551 \badenverr
552 \fi
553 }
554
555 % Environment mismatch, #1 expected:
556 \def\badenverr{%
557 \errhelp = \EMsimple
558 \errmessage{This command can appear only \inenvironment\temp,
559 not \inenvironment\thisenv}%
560 }
561 \def\inenvironment#1{%
562 \ifx#1\empty
563 outside of any environment%
564 \else
565 in environment \expandafter\string#1%
566 \fi
567 }
568
569 % @end foo executes the definition of \Efoo.
570 % But first, it executes a specialized version of \checkenv
571 %
572 \parseargdef\end{%
573 \if 1\csname iscond.#1\endcsname
574 \else
575 % The general wording of \badenverr may not be ideal.
576 \expandafter\checkenv\csname#1\endcsname
577 \csname E#1\endcsname
578 \endgroup
579 \fi
580 }
581
582 \newhelp\EMsimple{Press RETURN to continue.}
583
584
585 % Be sure we're in horizontal mode when doing a tie, since we make space
586 % equivalent to this in @example-like environments. Otherwise, a space
587 % at the beginning of a line will start with \penalty -- and
588 % since \penalty is valid in vertical mode, we'd end up putting the
589 % penalty on the vertical list instead of in the new paragraph.
590 {\catcode`@ = 11
591 % Avoid using \@M directly, because that causes trouble
592 % if the definition is written into an index file.
593 \global\let\tiepenalty = \@M
594 \gdef\tie{\leavevmode\penalty\tiepenalty\ }
595 }
596
597 % @: forces normal size whitespace following.
598 \def\:{\spacefactor=1000 }
599
600 % @* forces a line break.
601 \def\*{\unskip\hfil\break\hbox{}\ignorespaces}
602
603 % @/ allows a line break.
604 \let\/=\allowbreak
605
606 % @. is an end-of-sentence period.
607 \def\.{.\spacefactor=\endofsentencespacefactor\space}
608
609 % @! is an end-of-sentence bang.
610 \def\!{!\spacefactor=\endofsentencespacefactor\space}
611
612 % @? is an end-of-sentence query.
613 \def\?{?\spacefactor=\endofsentencespacefactor\space}
614
615 % @frenchspacing on|off says whether to put extra space after punctuation.
616 %
617 \def\onword{on}
618 \def\offword{off}
619 %
620 \parseargdef\frenchspacing{%
621 \def\temp{#1}%
622 \ifx\temp\onword \plainfrenchspacing
623 \else\ifx\temp\offword \plainnonfrenchspacing
624 \else
625 \errhelp = \EMsimple
626 \errmessage{Unknown @frenchspacing option `\temp', must be on|off}%
627 \fi\fi
628 }
629
630 % @w prevents a word break. Without the \leavevmode, @w at the
631 % beginning of a paragraph, when TeX is still in vertical mode, would
632 % produce a whole line of output instead of starting the paragraph.
633 \def\w#1{\leavevmode\hbox{#1}}
634
635 % @group ... @end group forces ... to be all on one page, by enclosing
636 % it in a TeX vbox. We use \vtop instead of \vbox to construct the box
637 % to keep its height that of a normal line. According to the rules for
638 % \topskip (p.114 of the TeXbook), the glue inserted is
639 % max (\topskip - \ht (first item), 0). If that height is large,
640 % therefore, no glue is inserted, and the space between the headline and
641 % the text is small, which looks bad.
642 %
643 % Another complication is that the group might be very large. This can
644 % cause the glue on the previous page to be unduly stretched, because it
645 % does not have much material. In this case, it's better to add an
646 % explicit \vfill so that the extra space is at the bottom. The
647 % threshold for doing this is if the group is more than \vfilllimit
648 % percent of a page (\vfilllimit can be changed inside of @tex).
649 %
650 \newbox\groupbox
651 \def\vfilllimit{0.7}
652 %
653 \envdef\group{%
654 \ifnum\catcode`\^^M=\active \else
655 \errhelp = \groupinvalidhelp
656 \errmessage{@group invalid in context where filling is enabled}%
657 \fi
658 \startsavinginserts
659 %
660 \setbox\groupbox = \vtop\bgroup
661 % Do @comment since we are called inside an environment such as
662 % @example, where each end-of-line in the input causes an
663 % end-of-line in the output. We don't want the end-of-line after
664 % the `@group' to put extra space in the output. Since @group
665 % should appear on a line by itself (according to the Texinfo
666 % manual), we don't worry about eating any user text.
667 \comment
668 }
669 %
670 % The \vtop produces a box with normal height and large depth; thus, TeX puts
671 % \baselineskip glue before it, and (when the next line of text is done)
672 % \lineskip glue after it. Thus, space below is not quite equal to space
673 % above. But it's pretty close.
674 \def\Egroup{%
675 % To get correct interline space between the last line of the group
676 % and the first line afterwards, we have to propagate \prevdepth.
677 \endgraf % Not \par, as it may have been set to \lisppar.
678 \global\dimen1 = \prevdepth
679 \egroup % End the \vtop.
680 % \dimen0 is the vertical size of the group's box.
681 \dimen0 = \ht\groupbox \advance\dimen0 by \dp\groupbox
682 % \dimen2 is how much space is left on the page (more or less).
683 \dimen2 = \pageheight \advance\dimen2 by -\pagetotal
684 % if the group doesn't fit on the current page, and it's a big big
685 % group, force a page break.
686 \ifdim \dimen0 > \dimen2
687 \ifdim \pagetotal < \vfilllimit\pageheight
688 \page
689 \fi
690 \fi
691 \box\groupbox
692 \prevdepth = \dimen1
693 \checkinserts
694 }
695 %
696 % TeX puts in an \escapechar (i.e., `@') at the beginning of the help
697 % message, so this ends up printing `@group can only ...'.
698 %
699 \newhelp\groupinvalidhelp{%
700 group can only be used in environments such as @example,^^J%
701 where each line of input produces a line of output.}
702
703 % @need space-in-mils
704 % forces a page break if there is not space-in-mils remaining.
705
706 \newdimen\mil \mil=0.001in
707
708 \parseargdef\need{%
709 % Ensure vertical mode, so we don't make a big box in the middle of a
710 % paragraph.
711 \par
712 %
713 % If the @need value is less than one line space, it's useless.
714 \dimen0 = #1\mil
715 \dimen2 = \ht\strutbox
716 \advance\dimen2 by \dp\strutbox
717 \ifdim\dimen0 > \dimen2
718 %
719 % Do a \strut just to make the height of this box be normal, so the
720 % normal leading is inserted relative to the preceding line.
721 % And a page break here is fine.
722 \vtop to #1\mil{\strut\vfil}%
723 %
724 % TeX does not even consider page breaks if a penalty added to the
725 % main vertical list is 10000 or more. But in order to see if the
726 % empty box we just added fits on the page, we must make it consider
727 % page breaks. On the other hand, we don't want to actually break the
728 % page after the empty box. So we use a penalty of 9999.
729 %
730 % There is an extremely small chance that TeX will actually break the
731 % page at this \penalty, if there are no other feasible breakpoints in
732 % sight. (If the user is using lots of big @group commands, which
733 % almost-but-not-quite fill up a page, TeX will have a hard time doing
734 % good page breaking, for example.) However, I could not construct an
735 % example where a page broke at this \penalty; if it happens in a real
736 % document, then we can reconsider our strategy.
737 \penalty9999
738 %
739 % Back up by the size of the box, whether we did a page break or not.
740 \kern -#1\mil
741 %
742 % Do not allow a page break right after this kern.
743 \nobreak
744 \fi
745 }
746
747 % @br forces paragraph break (and is undocumented).
748
749 \let\br = \par
750
751 % @page forces the start of a new page.
752 %
753 \def\page{\par\vfill\supereject}
754
755 % @exdent text....
756 % outputs text on separate line in roman font, starting at standard page margin
757
758 % This records the amount of indent in the innermost environment.
759 % That's how much \exdent should take out.
760 \newskip\exdentamount
761
762 % This defn is used inside fill environments such as @defun.
763 \parseargdef\exdent{\hfil\break\hbox{\kern -\exdentamount{\rm#1}}\hfil\break}
764
765 % This defn is used inside nofill environments such as @example.
766 \parseargdef\nofillexdent{{\advance \leftskip by -\exdentamount
767 \leftline{\hskip\leftskip{\rm#1}}}}
768
769 % @inmargin{WHICH}{TEXT} puts TEXT in the WHICH margin next to the current
770 % paragraph. For more general purposes, use the \margin insertion
771 % class. WHICH is `l' or `r'. Not documented, written for gawk manual.
772 %
773 \newskip\inmarginspacing \inmarginspacing=1cm
774 \def\strutdepth{\dp\strutbox}
775 %
776 \def\doinmargin#1#2{\strut\vadjust{%
777 \nobreak
778 \kern-\strutdepth
779 \vtop to \strutdepth{%
780 \baselineskip=\strutdepth
781 \vss
782 % if you have multiple lines of stuff to put here, you'll need to
783 % make the vbox yourself of the appropriate size.
784 \ifx#1l%
785 \llap{\ignorespaces #2\hskip\inmarginspacing}%
786 \else
787 \rlap{\hskip\hsize \hskip\inmarginspacing \ignorespaces #2}%
788 \fi
789 \null
790 }%
791 }}
792 \def\inleftmargin{\doinmargin l}
793 \def\inrightmargin{\doinmargin r}
794 %
795 % @inmargin{TEXT [, RIGHT-TEXT]}
796 % (if RIGHT-TEXT is given, use TEXT for left page, RIGHT-TEXT for right;
797 % else use TEXT for both).
798 %
799 \def\inmargin#1{\parseinmargin #1,,\finish}
800 \def\parseinmargin#1,#2,#3\finish{% not perfect, but better than nothing.
801 \setbox0 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #2}%
802 \ifdim\wd0 > 0pt
803 \def\lefttext{#1}% have both texts
804 \def\righttext{#2}%
805 \else
806 \def\lefttext{#1}% have only one text
807 \def\righttext{#1}%
808 \fi
809 %
810 \ifodd\pageno
811 \def\temp{\inrightmargin\righttext}% odd page -> outside is right margin
812 \else
813 \def\temp{\inleftmargin\lefttext}%
814 \fi
815 \temp
816 }
817
818 % @| inserts a changebar to the left of the current line. It should
819 % surround any changed text. This approach does *not* work if the
820 % change spans more than two lines of output. To handle that, we would
821 % have adopt a much more difficult approach (putting marks into the main
822 % vertical list for the beginning and end of each change). This command
823 % is not documented, not supported, and doesn't work.
824 %
825 \def\|{%
826 % \vadjust can only be used in horizontal mode.
827 \leavevmode
828 %
829 % Append this vertical mode material after the current line in the output.
830 \vadjust{%
831 % We want to insert a rule with the height and depth of the current
832 % leading; that is exactly what \strutbox is supposed to record.
833 \vskip-\baselineskip
834 %
835 % \vadjust-items are inserted at the left edge of the type. So
836 % the \llap here moves out into the left-hand margin.
837 \llap{%
838 %
839 % For a thicker or thinner bar, change the `1pt'.
840 \vrule height\baselineskip width1pt
841 %
842 % This is the space between the bar and the text.
843 \hskip 12pt
844 }%
845 }%
846 }
847
848 % @include FILE -- \input text of FILE.
849 %
850 \def\include{\parseargusing\filenamecatcodes\includezzz}
851 \def\includezzz#1{%
852 \pushthisfilestack
853 \def\thisfile{#1}%
854 {%
855 \makevalueexpandable % we want to expand any @value in FILE.
856 \turnoffactive % and allow special characters in the expansion
857 \indexnofonts % Allow `@@' and other weird things in file names.
858 \wlog{texinfo.tex: doing @include of #1^^J}%
859 \edef\temp{\noexpand\input #1 }%
860 %
861 % This trickery is to read FILE outside of a group, in case it makes
862 % definitions, etc.
863 \expandafter
864 }\temp
865 \popthisfilestack
866 }
867 \def\filenamecatcodes{%
868 \catcode`\\=\other
869 \catcode`~=\other
870 \catcode`^=\other
871 \catcode`_=\other
872 \catcode`|=\other
873 \catcode`<=\other
874 \catcode`>=\other
875 \catcode`+=\other
876 \catcode`-=\other
877 \catcode`\`=\other
878 \catcode`\'=\other
879 }
880
881 \def\pushthisfilestack{%
882 \expandafter\pushthisfilestackX\popthisfilestack\StackTerm
883 }
884 \def\pushthisfilestackX{%
885 \expandafter\pushthisfilestackY\thisfile\StackTerm
886 }
887 \def\pushthisfilestackY #1\StackTerm #2\StackTerm {%
888 \gdef\popthisfilestack{\gdef\thisfile{#1}\gdef\popthisfilestack{#2}}%
889 }
890
891 \def\popthisfilestack{\errthisfilestackempty}
892 \def\errthisfilestackempty{\errmessage{Internal error:
893 the stack of filenames is empty.}}
894 %
895 \def\thisfile{}
896
897 % @center line
898 % outputs that line, centered.
899 %
900 \parseargdef\center{%
901 \ifhmode
902 \let\centersub\centerH
903 \else
904 \let\centersub\centerV
905 \fi
906 \centersub{\hfil \ignorespaces#1\unskip \hfil}%
907 \let\centersub\relax % don't let the definition persist, just in case
908 }
909 \def\centerH#1{{%
910 \hfil\break
911 \advance\hsize by -\leftskip
912 \advance\hsize by -\rightskip
913 \line{#1}%
914 \break
915 }}
916 %
917 \newcount\centerpenalty
918 \def\centerV#1{%
919 % The idea here is the same as in \startdefun, \cartouche, etc.: if
920 % @center is the first thing after a section heading, we need to wipe
921 % out the negative parskip inserted by \sectionheading, but still
922 % prevent a page break here.
923 \centerpenalty = \lastpenalty
924 \ifnum\centerpenalty>10000 \vskip\parskip \fi
925 \ifnum\centerpenalty>9999 \penalty\centerpenalty \fi
926 \line{\kern\leftskip #1\kern\rightskip}%
927 }
928
929 % @sp n outputs n lines of vertical space
930 %
931 \parseargdef\sp{\vskip #1\baselineskip}
932
933 % @comment ...line which is ignored...
934 % @c is the same as @comment
935 % @ignore ... @end ignore is another way to write a comment
936 %
937 \def\comment{\begingroup \catcode`\^^M=\other%
938 \catcode`\@=\other \catcode`\{=\other \catcode`\}=\other%
939 \commentxxx}
940 {\catcode`\^^M=\other \gdef\commentxxx#1^^M{\endgroup}}
941 %
942 \let\c=\comment
943
944 % @paragraphindent NCHARS
945 % We'll use ems for NCHARS, close enough.
946 % NCHARS can also be the word `asis' or `none'.
947 % We cannot feasibly implement @paragraphindent asis, though.
948 %
949 \def\asisword{asis} % no translation, these are keywords
950 \def\noneword{none}
951 %
952 \parseargdef\paragraphindent{%
953 \def\temp{#1}%
954 \ifx\temp\asisword
955 \else
956 \ifx\temp\noneword
957 \defaultparindent = 0pt
958 \else
959 \defaultparindent = #1em
960 \fi
961 \fi
962 \parindent = \defaultparindent
963 }
964
965 % @exampleindent NCHARS
966 % We'll use ems for NCHARS like @paragraphindent.
967 % It seems @exampleindent asis isn't necessary, but
968 % I preserve it to make it similar to @paragraphindent.
969 \parseargdef\exampleindent{%
970 \def\temp{#1}%
971 \ifx\temp\asisword
972 \else
973 \ifx\temp\noneword
974 \lispnarrowing = 0pt
975 \else
976 \lispnarrowing = #1em
977 \fi
978 \fi
979 }
980
981 % @firstparagraphindent WORD
982 % If WORD is `none', then suppress indentation of the first paragraph
983 % after a section heading. If WORD is `insert', then do indent at such
984 % paragraphs.
985 %
986 % The paragraph indentation is suppressed or not by calling
987 % \suppressfirstparagraphindent, which the sectioning commands do.
988 % We switch the definition of this back and forth according to WORD.
989 % By default, we suppress indentation.
990 %
991 \def\suppressfirstparagraphindent{\dosuppressfirstparagraphindent}
992 \def\insertword{insert}
993 %
994 \parseargdef\firstparagraphindent{%
995 \def\temp{#1}%
996 \ifx\temp\noneword
997 \let\suppressfirstparagraphindent = \dosuppressfirstparagraphindent
998 \else\ifx\temp\insertword
999 \let\suppressfirstparagraphindent = \relax
1000 \else
1001 \errhelp = \EMsimple
1002 \errmessage{Unknown @firstparagraphindent option `\temp'}%
1003 \fi\fi
1004 }
1005
1006 % Here is how we actually suppress indentation. Redefine \everypar to
1007 % \kern backwards by \parindent, and then reset itself to empty.
1008 %
1009 % We also make \indent itself not actually do anything until the next
1010 % paragraph.
1011 %
1012 \gdef\dosuppressfirstparagraphindent{%
1013 \gdef\indent{%
1014 \restorefirstparagraphindent
1015 \indent
1016 }%
1017 \gdef\noindent{%
1018 \restorefirstparagraphindent
1019 \noindent
1020 }%
1021 \global\everypar = {%
1022 \kern -\parindent
1023 \restorefirstparagraphindent
1024 }%
1025 }
1026
1027 \gdef\restorefirstparagraphindent{%
1028 \global \let \indent = \ptexindent
1029 \global \let \noindent = \ptexnoindent
1030 \global \everypar = {}%
1031 }
1032
1033
1034 % @refill is a no-op.
1035 \let\refill=\relax
1036
1037 % If working on a large document in chapters, it is convenient to
1038 % be able to disable indexing, cross-referencing, and contents, for test runs.
1039 % This is done with @novalidate (before @setfilename).
1040 %
1041 \newif\iflinks \linkstrue % by default we want the aux files.
1042 \let\novalidate = \linksfalse
1043
1044 % @setfilename is done at the beginning of every texinfo file.
1045 % So open here the files we need to have open while reading the input.
1046 % This makes it possible to make a .fmt file for texinfo.
1047 \def\setfilename{%
1048 \fixbackslash % Turn off hack to swallow `\input texinfo'.
1049 \iflinks
1050 \tryauxfile
1051 % Open the new aux file. TeX will close it automatically at exit.
1052 \immediate\openout\auxfile=\jobname.aux
1053 \fi % \openindices needs to do some work in any case.
1054 \openindices
1055 \let\setfilename=\comment % Ignore extra @setfilename cmds.
1056 %
1057 % If texinfo.cnf is present on the system, read it.
1058 % Useful for site-wide @afourpaper, etc.
1059 \openin 1 texinfo.cnf
1060 \ifeof 1 \else \input texinfo.cnf \fi
1061 \closein 1
1062 %
1063 \comment % Ignore the actual filename.
1064 }
1065
1066 % Called from \setfilename.
1067 %
1068 \def\openindices{%
1069 \newindex{cp}%
1070 \newcodeindex{fn}%
1071 \newcodeindex{vr}%
1072 \newcodeindex{tp}%
1073 \newcodeindex{ky}%
1074 \newcodeindex{pg}%
1075 }
1076
1077 % @bye.
1078 \outer\def\bye{\pagealignmacro\tracingstats=1\ptexend}
1079
1080
1081 \message{pdf,}
1082 % adobe `portable' document format
1083 \newcount\tempnum
1084 \newcount\lnkcount
1085 \newtoks\filename
1086 \newcount\filenamelength
1087 \newcount\pgn
1088 \newtoks\toksA
1089 \newtoks\toksB
1090 \newtoks\toksC
1091 \newtoks\toksD
1092 \newbox\boxA
1093 \newcount\countA
1094 \newif\ifpdf
1095 \newif\ifpdfmakepagedest
1096
1097 % when pdftex is run in dvi mode, \pdfoutput is defined (so \pdfoutput=1
1098 % can be set). So we test for \relax and 0 as well as being undefined.
1099 \ifx\pdfoutput\thisisundefined
1100 \else
1101 \ifx\pdfoutput\relax
1102 \else
1103 \ifcase\pdfoutput
1104 \else
1105 \pdftrue
1106 \fi
1107 \fi
1108 \fi
1109
1110 % PDF uses PostScript string constants for the names of xref targets,
1111 % for display in the outlines, and in other places. Thus, we have to
1112 % double any backslashes. Otherwise, a name like "\node" will be
1113 % interpreted as a newline (\n), followed by o, d, e. Not good.
1114 %
1115 % See http://www.ntg.nl/pipermail/ntg-pdftex/2004-July/000654.html and
1116 % related messages. The final outcome is that it is up to the TeX user
1117 % to double the backslashes and otherwise make the string valid, so
1118 % that's what we do. pdftex 1.30.0 (ca.2005) introduced a primitive to
1119 % do this reliably, so we use it.
1120
1121 % #1 is a control sequence in which to do the replacements,
1122 % which we \xdef.
1123 \def\txiescapepdf#1{%
1124 \ifx\pdfescapestring\thisisundefined
1125 % No primitive available; should we give a warning or log?
1126 % Many times it won't matter.
1127 \else
1128 % The expandable \pdfescapestring primitive escapes parentheses,
1129 % backslashes, and other special chars.
1130 \xdef#1{\pdfescapestring{#1}}%
1131 \fi
1132 }
1133
1134 \newhelp\nopdfimagehelp{Texinfo supports .png, .jpg, .jpeg, and .pdf images
1135 with PDF output, and none of those formats could be found. (.eps cannot
1136 be supported due to the design of the PDF format; use regular TeX (DVI
1137 output) for that.)}
1138
1139 \ifpdf
1140 %
1141 % Color manipulation macros using ideas from pdfcolor.tex,
1142 % except using rgb instead of cmyk; the latter is said to render as a
1143 % very dark gray on-screen and a very dark halftone in print, instead
1144 % of actual black. The dark red here is dark enough to print on paper as
1145 % nearly black, but still distinguishable for online viewing. We use
1146 % black by default, though.
1147 \def\rgbDarkRed{0.50 0.09 0.12}
1148 \def\rgbBlack{0 0 0}
1149 %
1150 % k sets the color for filling (usual text, etc.);
1151 % K sets the color for stroking (thin rules, e.g., normal _'s).
1152 \def\pdfsetcolor#1{\pdfliteral{#1 rg #1 RG}}
1153 %
1154 % Set color, and create a mark which defines \thiscolor accordingly,
1155 % so that \makeheadline knows which color to restore.
1156 \def\setcolor#1{%
1157 \xdef\lastcolordefs{\gdef\noexpand\thiscolor{#1}}%
1158 \domark
1159 \pdfsetcolor{#1}%
1160 }
1161 %
1162 \def\maincolor{\rgbBlack}
1163 \pdfsetcolor{\maincolor}
1164 \edef\thiscolor{\maincolor}
1165 \def\lastcolordefs{}
1166 %
1167 \def\makefootline{%
1168 \baselineskip24pt
1169 \line{\pdfsetcolor{\maincolor}\the\footline}%
1170 }
1171 %
1172 \def\makeheadline{%
1173 \vbox to 0pt{%
1174 \vskip-22.5pt
1175 \line{%
1176 \vbox to8.5pt{}%
1177 % Extract \thiscolor definition from the marks.
1178 \getcolormarks
1179 % Typeset the headline with \maincolor, then restore the color.
1180 \pdfsetcolor{\maincolor}\the\headline\pdfsetcolor{\thiscolor}%
1181 }%
1182 \vss
1183 }%
1184 \nointerlineskip
1185 }
1186 %
1187 %
1188 \pdfcatalog{/PageMode /UseOutlines}
1189 %
1190 % #1 is image name, #2 width (might be empty/whitespace), #3 height (ditto).
1191 \def\dopdfimage#1#2#3{%
1192 \def\pdfimagewidth{#2}\setbox0 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #2}%
1193 \def\pdfimageheight{#3}\setbox2 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #3}%
1194 %
1195 % pdftex (and the PDF format) support .pdf, .png, .jpg (among
1196 % others). Let's try in that order, PDF first since if
1197 % someone has a scalable image, presumably better to use that than a
1198 % bitmap.
1199 \let\pdfimgext=\empty
1200 \begingroup
1201 \openin 1 #1.pdf \ifeof 1
1202 \openin 1 #1.PDF \ifeof 1
1203 \openin 1 #1.png \ifeof 1
1204 \openin 1 #1.jpg \ifeof 1
1205 \openin 1 #1.jpeg \ifeof 1
1206 \openin 1 #1.JPG \ifeof 1
1207 \errhelp = \nopdfimagehelp
1208 \errmessage{Could not find image file #1 for pdf}%
1209 \else \gdef\pdfimgext{JPG}%
1210 \fi
1211 \else \gdef\pdfimgext{jpeg}%
1212 \fi
1213 \else \gdef\pdfimgext{jpg}%
1214 \fi
1215 \else \gdef\pdfimgext{png}%
1216 \fi
1217 \else \gdef\pdfimgext{PDF}%
1218 \fi
1219 \else \gdef\pdfimgext{pdf}%
1220 \fi
1221 \closein 1
1222 \endgroup
1223 %
1224 % without \immediate, ancient pdftex seg faults when the same image is
1225 % included twice. (Version 3.14159-pre-1.0-unofficial-20010704.)
1226 \ifnum\pdftexversion < 14
1227 \immediate\pdfimage
1228 \else
1229 \immediate\pdfximage
1230 \fi
1231 \ifdim \wd0 >0pt width \pdfimagewidth \fi
1232 \ifdim \wd2 >0pt height \pdfimageheight \fi
1233 \ifnum\pdftexversion<13
1234 #1.\pdfimgext
1235 \else
1236 {#1.\pdfimgext}%
1237 \fi
1238 \ifnum\pdftexversion < 14 \else
1239 \pdfrefximage \pdflastximage
1240 \fi}
1241 %
1242 \def\pdfmkdest#1{{%
1243 % We have to set dummies so commands such as @code, and characters
1244 % such as \, aren't expanded when present in a section title.
1245 \indexnofonts
1246 \turnoffactive
1247 \makevalueexpandable
1248 \def\pdfdestname{#1}%
1249 \txiescapepdf\pdfdestname
1250 \safewhatsit{\pdfdest name{\pdfdestname} xyz}%
1251 }}
1252 %
1253 % used to mark target names; must be expandable.
1254 \def\pdfmkpgn#1{#1}
1255 %
1256 % by default, use black for everything.
1257 \def\urlcolor{\rgbBlack}
1258 \def\linkcolor{\rgbBlack}
1259 \def\endlink{\setcolor{\maincolor}\pdfendlink}
1260 %
1261 % Adding outlines to PDF; macros for calculating structure of outlines
1262 % come from Petr Olsak
1263 \def\expnumber#1{\expandafter\ifx\csname#1\endcsname\relax 0%
1264 \else \csname#1\endcsname \fi}
1265 \def\advancenumber#1{\tempnum=\expnumber{#1}\relax
1266 \advance\tempnum by 1
1267 \expandafter\xdef\csname#1\endcsname{\the\tempnum}}
1268 %
1269 % #1 is the section text, which is what will be displayed in the
1270 % outline by the pdf viewer. #2 is the pdf expression for the number
1271 % of subentries (or empty, for subsubsections). #3 is the node text,
1272 % which might be empty if this toc entry had no corresponding node.
1273 % #4 is the page number
1274 %
1275 \def\dopdfoutline#1#2#3#4{%
1276 % Generate a link to the node text if that exists; else, use the
1277 % page number. We could generate a destination for the section
1278 % text in the case where a section has no node, but it doesn't
1279 % seem worth the trouble, since most documents are normally structured.
1280 \edef\pdfoutlinedest{#3}%
1281 \ifx\pdfoutlinedest\empty
1282 \def\pdfoutlinedest{#4}%
1283 \else
1284 \txiescapepdf\pdfoutlinedest
1285 \fi
1286 %
1287 % Also escape PDF chars in the display string.
1288 \edef\pdfoutlinetext{#1}%
1289 \txiescapepdf\pdfoutlinetext
1290 %
1291 \pdfoutline goto name{\pdfmkpgn{\pdfoutlinedest}}#2{\pdfoutlinetext}%
1292 }
1293 %
1294 \def\pdfmakeoutlines{%
1295 \begingroup
1296 % Read toc silently, to get counts of subentries for \pdfoutline.
1297 \def\partentry##1##2##3##4{}% ignore parts in the outlines
1298 \def\numchapentry##1##2##3##4{%
1299 \def\thischapnum{##2}%
1300 \def\thissecnum{0}%
1301 \def\thissubsecnum{0}%
1302 }%
1303 \def\numsecentry##1##2##3##4{%
1304 \advancenumber{chap\thischapnum}%
1305 \def\thissecnum{##2}%
1306 \def\thissubsecnum{0}%
1307 }%
1308 \def\numsubsecentry##1##2##3##4{%
1309 \advancenumber{sec\thissecnum}%
1310 \def\thissubsecnum{##2}%
1311 }%
1312 \def\numsubsubsecentry##1##2##3##4{%
1313 \advancenumber{subsec\thissubsecnum}%
1314 }%
1315 \def\thischapnum{0}%
1316 \def\thissecnum{0}%
1317 \def\thissubsecnum{0}%
1318 %
1319 % use \def rather than \let here because we redefine \chapentry et
1320 % al. a second time, below.
1321 \def\appentry{\numchapentry}%
1322 \def\appsecentry{\numsecentry}%
1323 \def\appsubsecentry{\numsubsecentry}%
1324 \def\appsubsubsecentry{\numsubsubsecentry}%
1325 \def\unnchapentry{\numchapentry}%
1326 \def\unnsecentry{\numsecentry}%
1327 \def\unnsubsecentry{\numsubsecentry}%
1328 \def\unnsubsubsecentry{\numsubsubsecentry}%
1329 \readdatafile{toc}%
1330 %
1331 % Read toc second time, this time actually producing the outlines.
1332 % The `-' means take the \expnumber as the absolute number of
1333 % subentries, which we calculated on our first read of the .toc above.
1334 %
1335 % We use the node names as the destinations.
1336 \def\numchapentry##1##2##3##4{%
1337 \dopdfoutline{##1}{count-\expnumber{chap##2}}{##3}{##4}}%
1338 \def\numsecentry##1##2##3##4{%
1339 \dopdfoutline{##1}{count-\expnumber{sec##2}}{##3}{##4}}%
1340 \def\numsubsecentry##1##2##3##4{%
1341 \dopdfoutline{##1}{count-\expnumber{subsec##2}}{##3}{##4}}%
1342 \def\numsubsubsecentry##1##2##3##4{% count is always zero
1343 \dopdfoutline{##1}{}{##3}{##4}}%
1344 %
1345 % PDF outlines are displayed using system fonts, instead of
1346 % document fonts. Therefore we cannot use special characters,
1347 % since the encoding is unknown. For example, the eogonek from
1348 % Latin 2 (0xea) gets translated to a | character. Info from
1349 % Staszek Wawrykiewicz, 19 Jan 2004 04:09:24 +0100.
1350 %
1351 % TODO this right, we have to translate 8-bit characters to
1352 % their "best" equivalent, based on the @documentencoding. Too
1353 % much work for too little return. Just use the ASCII equivalents
1354 % we use for the index sort strings.
1355 %
1356 \indexnofonts
1357 \setupdatafile
1358 % We can have normal brace characters in the PDF outlines, unlike
1359 % Texinfo index files. So set that up.
1360 \def\{{\lbracecharliteral}%
1361 \def\}{\rbracecharliteral}%
1362 \catcode`\\=\active \otherbackslash
1363 \input \tocreadfilename
1364 \endgroup
1365 }
1366 {\catcode`[=1 \catcode`]=2
1367 \catcode`{=\other \catcode`}=\other
1368 \gdef\lbracecharliteral[{]%
1369 \gdef\rbracecharliteral[}]%
1370 ]
1371 %
1372 \def\skipspaces#1{\def\PP{#1}\def\D{|}%
1373 \ifx\PP\D\let\nextsp\relax
1374 \else\let\nextsp\skipspaces
1375 \addtokens{\filename}{\PP}%
1376 \advance\filenamelength by 1
1377 \fi
1378 \nextsp}
1379 \def\getfilename#1{%
1380 \filenamelength=0
1381 % If we don't expand the argument now, \skipspaces will get
1382 % snagged on things like "@value{foo}".
1383 \edef\temp{#1}%
1384 \expandafter\skipspaces\temp|\relax
1385 }
1386 \ifnum\pdftexversion < 14
1387 \let \startlink \pdfannotlink
1388 \else
1389 \let \startlink \pdfstartlink
1390 \fi
1391 % make a live url in pdf output.
1392 \def\pdfurl#1{%
1393 \begingroup
1394 % it seems we really need yet another set of dummies; have not
1395 % tried to figure out what each command should do in the context
1396 % of @url. for now, just make @/ a no-op, that's the only one
1397 % people have actually reported a problem with.
1398 %
1399 \normalturnoffactive
1400 \def\@{@}%
1401 \let\/=\empty
1402 \makevalueexpandable
1403 % do we want to go so far as to use \indexnofonts instead of just
1404 % special-casing \var here?
1405 \def\var##1{##1}%
1406 %
1407 \leavevmode\setcolor{\urlcolor}%
1408 \startlink attr{/Border [0 0 0]}%
1409 user{/Subtype /Link /A << /S /URI /URI (#1) >>}%
1410 \endgroup}
1411 \def\pdfgettoks#1.{\setbox\boxA=\hbox{\toksA={#1.}\toksB={}\maketoks}}
1412 \def\addtokens#1#2{\edef\addtoks{\noexpand#1={\the#1#2}}\addtoks}
1413 \def\adn#1{\addtokens{\toksC}{#1}\global\countA=1\let\next=\maketoks}
1414 \def\poptoks#1#2|ENDTOKS|{\let\first=#1\toksD={#1}\toksA={#2}}
1415 \def\maketoks{%
1416 \expandafter\poptoks\the\toksA|ENDTOKS|\relax
1417 \ifx\first0\adn0
1418 \else\ifx\first1\adn1 \else\ifx\first2\adn2 \else\ifx\first3\adn3
1419 \else\ifx\first4\adn4 \else\ifx\first5\adn5 \else\ifx\first6\adn6
1420 \else\ifx\first7\adn7 \else\ifx\first8\adn8 \else\ifx\first9\adn9
1421 \else
1422 \ifnum0=\countA\else\makelink\fi
1423 \ifx\first.\let\next=\done\else
1424 \let\next=\maketoks
1425 \addtokens{\toksB}{\the\toksD}
1426 \ifx\first,\addtokens{\toksB}{\space}\fi
1427 \fi
1428 \fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi
1429 \next}
1430 \def\makelink{\addtokens{\toksB}%
1431 {\noexpand\pdflink{\the\toksC}}\toksC={}\global\countA=0}
1432 \def\pdflink#1{%
1433 \startlink attr{/Border [0 0 0]} goto name{\pdfmkpgn{#1}}
1434 \setcolor{\linkcolor}#1\endlink}
1435 \def\done{\edef\st{\global\noexpand\toksA={\the\toksB}}\st}
1436 \else
1437 % non-pdf mode
1438 \let\pdfmkdest = \gobble
1439 \let\pdfurl = \gobble
1440 \let\endlink = \relax
1441 \let\setcolor = \gobble
1442 \let\pdfsetcolor = \gobble
1443 \let\pdfmakeoutlines = \relax
1444 \fi % \ifx\pdfoutput
1445
1446
1447 \message{fonts,}
1448
1449 % Change the current font style to #1, remembering it in \curfontstyle.
1450 % For now, we do not accumulate font styles: @b{@i{foo}} prints foo in
1451 % italics, not bold italics.
1452 %
1453 \def\setfontstyle#1{%
1454 \def\curfontstyle{#1}% not as a control sequence, because we are \edef'd.
1455 \csname ten#1\endcsname % change the current font
1456 }
1457
1458 % Select #1 fonts with the current style.
1459 %
1460 \def\selectfonts#1{\csname #1fonts\endcsname \csname\curfontstyle\endcsname}
1461
1462 \def\rm{\fam=0 \setfontstyle{rm}}
1463 \def\it{\fam=\itfam \setfontstyle{it}}
1464 \def\sl{\fam=\slfam \setfontstyle{sl}}
1465 \def\bf{\fam=\bffam \setfontstyle{bf}}\def\bfstylename{bf}
1466 \def\tt{\fam=\ttfam \setfontstyle{tt}}
1467
1468 % Unfortunately, we have to override this for titles and the like, since
1469 % in those cases "rm" is bold. Sigh.
1470 \def\rmisbold{\rm\def\curfontstyle{bf}}
1471
1472 % Texinfo sort of supports the sans serif font style, which plain TeX does not.
1473 % So we set up a \sf.
1474 \newfam\sffam
1475 \def\sf{\fam=\sffam \setfontstyle{sf}}
1476 \let\li = \sf % Sometimes we call it \li, not \sf.
1477
1478 % We don't need math for this font style.
1479 \def\ttsl{\setfontstyle{ttsl}}
1480
1481
1482 % Set the baselineskip to #1, and the lineskip and strut size
1483 % correspondingly. There is no deep meaning behind these magic numbers
1484 % used as factors; they just match (closely enough) what Knuth defined.
1485 %
1486 \def\lineskipfactor{.08333}
1487 \def\strutheightpercent{.70833}
1488 \def\strutdepthpercent {.29167}
1489 %
1490 % can get a sort of poor man's double spacing by redefining this.
1491 \def\baselinefactor{1}
1492 %
1493 \newdimen\textleading
1494 \def\setleading#1{%
1495 \dimen0 = #1\relax
1496 \normalbaselineskip = \baselinefactor\dimen0
1497 \normallineskip = \lineskipfactor\normalbaselineskip
1498 \normalbaselines
1499 \setbox\strutbox =\hbox{%
1500 \vrule width0pt height\strutheightpercent\baselineskip
1501 depth \strutdepthpercent \baselineskip
1502 }%
1503 }
1504
1505 % PDF CMaps. See also LaTeX's t1.cmap.
1506 %
1507 % do nothing with this by default.
1508 \expandafter\let\csname cmapOT1\endcsname\gobble
1509 \expandafter\let\csname cmapOT1IT\endcsname\gobble
1510 \expandafter\let\csname cmapOT1TT\endcsname\gobble
1511
1512 % if we are producing pdf, and we have \pdffontattr, then define cmaps.
1513 % (\pdffontattr was introduced many years ago, but people still run
1514 % older pdftex's; it's easy to conditionalize, so we do.)
1515 \ifpdf \ifx\pdffontattr\thisisundefined \else
1516 \begingroup
1517 \catcode`\^^M=\active \def^^M{^^J}% Output line endings as the ^^J char.
1518 \catcode`\%=12 \immediate\pdfobj stream {%!PS-Adobe-3.0 Resource-CMap
1519 %%DocumentNeededResources: ProcSet (CIDInit)
1520 %%IncludeResource: ProcSet (CIDInit)
1521 %%BeginResource: CMap (TeX-OT1-0)
1522 %%Title: (TeX-OT1-0 TeX OT1 0)
1523 %%Version: 1.000
1524 %%EndComments
1525 /CIDInit /ProcSet findresource begin
1526 12 dict begin
1527 begincmap
1528 /CIDSystemInfo
1529 << /Registry (TeX)
1530 /Ordering (OT1)
1531 /Supplement 0
1532 >> def
1533 /CMapName /TeX-OT1-0 def
1534 /CMapType 2 def
1535 1 begincodespacerange
1536 <00> <7F>
1537 endcodespacerange
1538 8 beginbfrange
1539 <00> <01> <0393>
1540 <09> <0A> <03A8>
1541 <23> <26> <0023>
1542 <28> <3B> <0028>
1543 <3F> <5B> <003F>
1544 <5D> <5E> <005D>
1545 <61> <7A> <0061>
1546 <7B> <7C> <2013>
1547 endbfrange
1548 40 beginbfchar
1549 <02> <0398>
1550 <03> <039B>
1551 <04> <039E>
1552 <05> <03A0>
1553 <06> <03A3>
1554 <07> <03D2>
1555 <08> <03A6>
1556 <0B> <00660066>
1557 <0C> <00660069>
1558 <0D> <0066006C>
1559 <0E> <006600660069>
1560 <0F> <00660066006C>
1561 <10> <0131>
1562 <11> <0237>
1563 <12> <0060>
1564 <13> <00B4>
1565 <14> <02C7>
1566 <15> <02D8>
1567 <16> <00AF>
1568 <17> <02DA>
1569 <18> <00B8>
1570 <19> <00DF>
1571 <1A> <00E6>
1572 <1B> <0153>
1573 <1C> <00F8>
1574 <1D> <00C6>
1575 <1E> <0152>
1576 <1F> <00D8>
1577 <21> <0021>
1578 <22> <201D>
1579 <27> <2019>
1580 <3C> <00A1>
1581 <3D> <003D>
1582 <3E> <00BF>
1583 <5C> <201C>
1584 <5F> <02D9>
1585 <60> <2018>
1586 <7D> <02DD>
1587 <7E> <007E>
1588 <7F> <00A8>
1589 endbfchar
1590 endcmap
1591 CMapName currentdict /CMap defineresource pop
1592 end
1593 end
1594 %%EndResource
1595 %%EOF
1596 }\endgroup
1597 \expandafter\edef\csname cmapOT1\endcsname#1{%
1598 \pdffontattr#1{/ToUnicode \the\pdflastobj\space 0 R}%
1599 }%
1600 %
1601 % \cmapOT1IT
1602 \begingroup
1603 \catcode`\^^M=\active \def^^M{^^J}% Output line endings as the ^^J char.
1604 \catcode`\%=12 \immediate\pdfobj stream {%!PS-Adobe-3.0 Resource-CMap
1605 %%DocumentNeededResources: ProcSet (CIDInit)
1606 %%IncludeResource: ProcSet (CIDInit)
1607 %%BeginResource: CMap (TeX-OT1IT-0)
1608 %%Title: (TeX-OT1IT-0 TeX OT1IT 0)
1609 %%Version: 1.000
1610 %%EndComments
1611 /CIDInit /ProcSet findresource begin
1612 12 dict begin
1613 begincmap
1614 /CIDSystemInfo
1615 << /Registry (TeX)
1616 /Ordering (OT1IT)
1617 /Supplement 0
1618 >> def
1619 /CMapName /TeX-OT1IT-0 def
1620 /CMapType 2 def
1621 1 begincodespacerange
1622 <00> <7F>
1623 endcodespacerange
1624 8 beginbfrange
1625 <00> <01> <0393>
1626 <09> <0A> <03A8>
1627 <25> <26> <0025>
1628 <28> <3B> <0028>
1629 <3F> <5B> <003F>
1630 <5D> <5E> <005D>
1631 <61> <7A> <0061>
1632 <7B> <7C> <2013>
1633 endbfrange
1634 42 beginbfchar
1635 <02> <0398>
1636 <03> <039B>
1637 <04> <039E>
1638 <05> <03A0>
1639 <06> <03A3>
1640 <07> <03D2>
1641 <08> <03A6>
1642 <0B> <00660066>
1643 <0C> <00660069>
1644 <0D> <0066006C>
1645 <0E> <006600660069>
1646 <0F> <00660066006C>
1647 <10> <0131>
1648 <11> <0237>
1649 <12> <0060>
1650 <13> <00B4>
1651 <14> <02C7>
1652 <15> <02D8>
1653 <16> <00AF>
1654 <17> <02DA>
1655 <18> <00B8>
1656 <19> <00DF>
1657 <1A> <00E6>
1658 <1B> <0153>
1659 <1C> <00F8>
1660 <1D> <00C6>
1661 <1E> <0152>
1662 <1F> <00D8>
1663 <21> <0021>
1664 <22> <201D>
1665 <23> <0023>
1666 <24> <00A3>
1667 <27> <2019>
1668 <3C> <00A1>
1669 <3D> <003D>
1670 <3E> <00BF>
1671 <5C> <201C>
1672 <5F> <02D9>
1673 <60> <2018>
1674 <7D> <02DD>
1675 <7E> <007E>
1676 <7F> <00A8>
1677 endbfchar
1678 endcmap
1679 CMapName currentdict /CMap defineresource pop
1680 end
1681 end
1682 %%EndResource
1683 %%EOF
1684 }\endgroup
1685 \expandafter\edef\csname cmapOT1IT\endcsname#1{%
1686 \pdffontattr#1{/ToUnicode \the\pdflastobj\space 0 R}%
1687 }%
1688 %
1689 % \cmapOT1TT
1690 \begingroup
1691 \catcode`\^^M=\active \def^^M{^^J}% Output line endings as the ^^J char.
1692 \catcode`\%=12 \immediate\pdfobj stream {%!PS-Adobe-3.0 Resource-CMap
1693 %%DocumentNeededResources: ProcSet (CIDInit)
1694 %%IncludeResource: ProcSet (CIDInit)
1695 %%BeginResource: CMap (TeX-OT1TT-0)
1696 %%Title: (TeX-OT1TT-0 TeX OT1TT 0)
1697 %%Version: 1.000
1698 %%EndComments
1699 /CIDInit /ProcSet findresource begin
1700 12 dict begin
1701 begincmap
1702 /CIDSystemInfo
1703 << /Registry (TeX)
1704 /Ordering (OT1TT)
1705 /Supplement 0
1706 >> def
1707 /CMapName /TeX-OT1TT-0 def
1708 /CMapType 2 def
1709 1 begincodespacerange
1710 <00> <7F>
1711 endcodespacerange
1712 5 beginbfrange
1713 <00> <01> <0393>
1714 <09> <0A> <03A8>
1715 <21> <26> <0021>
1716 <28> <5F> <0028>
1717 <61> <7E> <0061>
1718 endbfrange
1719 32 beginbfchar
1720 <02> <0398>
1721 <03> <039B>
1722 <04> <039E>
1723 <05> <03A0>
1724 <06> <03A3>
1725 <07> <03D2>
1726 <08> <03A6>
1727 <0B> <2191>
1728 <0C> <2193>
1729 <0D> <0027>
1730 <0E> <00A1>
1731 <0F> <00BF>
1732 <10> <0131>
1733 <11> <0237>
1734 <12> <0060>
1735 <13> <00B4>
1736 <14> <02C7>
1737 <15> <02D8>
1738 <16> <00AF>
1739 <17> <02DA>
1740 <18> <00B8>
1741 <19> <00DF>
1742 <1A> <00E6>
1743 <1B> <0153>
1744 <1C> <00F8>
1745 <1D> <00C6>
1746 <1E> <0152>
1747 <1F> <00D8>
1748 <20> <2423>
1749 <27> <2019>
1750 <60> <2018>
1751 <7F> <00A8>
1752 endbfchar
1753 endcmap
1754 CMapName currentdict /CMap defineresource pop
1755 end
1756 end
1757 %%EndResource
1758 %%EOF
1759 }\endgroup
1760 \expandafter\edef\csname cmapOT1TT\endcsname#1{%
1761 \pdffontattr#1{/ToUnicode \the\pdflastobj\space 0 R}%
1762 }%
1763 \fi\fi
1764
1765
1766 % Set the font macro #1 to the font named \fontprefix#2.
1767 % #3 is the font's design size, #4 is a scale factor, #5 is the CMap
1768 % encoding (only OT1, OT1IT and OT1TT are allowed, or empty to omit).
1769 % Example:
1770 % #1 = \textrm
1771 % #2 = \rmshape
1772 % #3 = 10
1773 % #4 = \mainmagstep
1774 % #5 = OT1
1775 %
1776 \def\setfont#1#2#3#4#5{%
1777 \font#1=\fontprefix#2#3 scaled #4
1778 \csname cmap#5\endcsname#1%
1779 }
1780 % This is what gets called when #5 of \setfont is empty.
1781 \let\cmap\gobble
1782 %
1783 % (end of cmaps)
1784
1785 % Use cm as the default font prefix.
1786 % To specify the font prefix, you must define \fontprefix
1787 % before you read in texinfo.tex.
1788 \ifx\fontprefix\thisisundefined
1789 \def\fontprefix{cm}
1790 \fi
1791 % Support font families that don't use the same naming scheme as CM.
1792 \def\rmshape{r}
1793 \def\rmbshape{bx} % where the normal face is bold
1794 \def\bfshape{b}
1795 \def\bxshape{bx}
1796 \def\ttshape{tt}
1797 \def\ttbshape{tt}
1798 \def\ttslshape{sltt}
1799 \def\itshape{ti}
1800 \def\itbshape{bxti}
1801 \def\slshape{sl}
1802 \def\slbshape{bxsl}
1803 \def\sfshape{ss}
1804 \def\sfbshape{ss}
1805 \def\scshape{csc}
1806 \def\scbshape{csc}
1807
1808 % Definitions for a main text size of 11pt. (The default in Texinfo.)
1809 %
1810 \def\definetextfontsizexi{%
1811 % Text fonts (11.2pt, magstep1).
1812 \def\textnominalsize{11pt}
1813 \edef\mainmagstep{\magstephalf}
1814 \setfont\textrm\rmshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1}
1815 \setfont\texttt\ttshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1TT}
1816 \setfont\textbf\bfshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1}
1817 \setfont\textit\itshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1IT}
1818 \setfont\textsl\slshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1}
1819 \setfont\textsf\sfshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1}
1820 \setfont\textsc\scshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1}
1821 \setfont\textttsl\ttslshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1TT}
1822 \font\texti=cmmi10 scaled \mainmagstep
1823 \font\textsy=cmsy10 scaled \mainmagstep
1824 \def\textecsize{1095}
1825
1826 % A few fonts for @defun names and args.
1827 \setfont\defbf\bfshape{10}{\magstep1}{OT1}
1828 \setfont\deftt\ttshape{10}{\magstep1}{OT1TT}
1829 \setfont\defttsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstep1}{OT1TT}
1830 \def\df{\let\tentt=\deftt \let\tenbf = \defbf \let\tenttsl=\defttsl \bf}
1831
1832 % Fonts for indices, footnotes, small examples (9pt).
1833 \def\smallnominalsize{9pt}
1834 \setfont\smallrm\rmshape{9}{1000}{OT1}
1835 \setfont\smalltt\ttshape{9}{1000}{OT1TT}
1836 \setfont\smallbf\bfshape{10}{900}{OT1}
1837 \setfont\smallit\itshape{9}{1000}{OT1IT}
1838 \setfont\smallsl\slshape{9}{1000}{OT1}
1839 \setfont\smallsf\sfshape{9}{1000}{OT1}
1840 \setfont\smallsc\scshape{10}{900}{OT1}
1841 \setfont\smallttsl\ttslshape{10}{900}{OT1TT}
1842 \font\smalli=cmmi9
1843 \font\smallsy=cmsy9
1844 \def\smallecsize{0900}
1845
1846 % Fonts for small examples (8pt).
1847 \def\smallernominalsize{8pt}
1848 \setfont\smallerrm\rmshape{8}{1000}{OT1}
1849 \setfont\smallertt\ttshape{8}{1000}{OT1TT}
1850 \setfont\smallerbf\bfshape{10}{800}{OT1}
1851 \setfont\smallerit\itshape{8}{1000}{OT1IT}
1852 \setfont\smallersl\slshape{8}{1000}{OT1}
1853 \setfont\smallersf\sfshape{8}{1000}{OT1}
1854 \setfont\smallersc\scshape{10}{800}{OT1}
1855 \setfont\smallerttsl\ttslshape{10}{800}{OT1TT}
1856 \font\smalleri=cmmi8
1857 \font\smallersy=cmsy8
1858 \def\smallerecsize{0800}
1859
1860 % Fonts for title page (20.4pt):
1861 \def\titlenominalsize{20pt}
1862 \setfont\titlerm\rmbshape{12}{\magstep3}{OT1}
1863 \setfont\titleit\itbshape{10}{\magstep4}{OT1IT}
1864 \setfont\titlesl\slbshape{10}{\magstep4}{OT1}
1865 \setfont\titlett\ttbshape{12}{\magstep3}{OT1TT}
1866 \setfont\titlettsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstep4}{OT1TT}
1867 \setfont\titlesf\sfbshape{17}{\magstep1}{OT1}
1868 \let\titlebf=\titlerm
1869 \setfont\titlesc\scbshape{10}{\magstep4}{OT1}
1870 \font\titlei=cmmi12 scaled \magstep3
1871 \font\titlesy=cmsy10 scaled \magstep4
1872 \def\titleecsize{2074}
1873
1874 % Chapter (and unnumbered) fonts (17.28pt).
1875 \def\chapnominalsize{17pt}
1876 \setfont\chaprm\rmbshape{12}{\magstep2}{OT1}
1877 \setfont\chapit\itbshape{10}{\magstep3}{OT1IT}
1878 \setfont\chapsl\slbshape{10}{\magstep3}{OT1}
1879 \setfont\chaptt\ttbshape{12}{\magstep2}{OT1TT}
1880 \setfont\chapttsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstep3}{OT1TT}
1881 \setfont\chapsf\sfbshape{17}{1000}{OT1}
1882 \let\chapbf=\chaprm
1883 \setfont\chapsc\scbshape{10}{\magstep3}{OT1}
1884 \font\chapi=cmmi12 scaled \magstep2
1885 \font\chapsy=cmsy10 scaled \magstep3
1886 \def\chapecsize{1728}
1887
1888 % Section fonts (14.4pt).
1889 \def\secnominalsize{14pt}
1890 \setfont\secrm\rmbshape{12}{\magstep1}{OT1}
1891 \setfont\secit\itbshape{10}{\magstep2}{OT1IT}
1892 \setfont\secsl\slbshape{10}{\magstep2}{OT1}
1893 \setfont\sectt\ttbshape{12}{\magstep1}{OT1TT}
1894 \setfont\secttsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstep2}{OT1TT}
1895 \setfont\secsf\sfbshape{12}{\magstep1}{OT1}
1896 \let\secbf\secrm
1897 \setfont\secsc\scbshape{10}{\magstep2}{OT1}
1898 \font\seci=cmmi12 scaled \magstep1
1899 \font\secsy=cmsy10 scaled \magstep2
1900 \def\sececsize{1440}
1901
1902 % Subsection fonts (13.15pt).
1903 \def\ssecnominalsize{13pt}
1904 \setfont\ssecrm\rmbshape{12}{\magstephalf}{OT1}
1905 \setfont\ssecit\itbshape{10}{1315}{OT1IT}
1906 \setfont\ssecsl\slbshape{10}{1315}{OT1}
1907 \setfont\ssectt\ttbshape{12}{\magstephalf}{OT1TT}
1908 \setfont\ssecttsl\ttslshape{10}{1315}{OT1TT}
1909 \setfont\ssecsf\sfbshape{12}{\magstephalf}{OT1}
1910 \let\ssecbf\ssecrm
1911 \setfont\ssecsc\scbshape{10}{1315}{OT1}
1912 \font\sseci=cmmi12 scaled \magstephalf
1913 \font\ssecsy=cmsy10 scaled 1315
1914 \def\ssececsize{1200}
1915
1916 % Reduced fonts for @acro in text (10pt).
1917 \def\reducednominalsize{10pt}
1918 \setfont\reducedrm\rmshape{10}{1000}{OT1}
1919 \setfont\reducedtt\ttshape{10}{1000}{OT1TT}
1920 \setfont\reducedbf\bfshape{10}{1000}{OT1}
1921 \setfont\reducedit\itshape{10}{1000}{OT1IT}
1922 \setfont\reducedsl\slshape{10}{1000}{OT1}
1923 \setfont\reducedsf\sfshape{10}{1000}{OT1}
1924 \setfont\reducedsc\scshape{10}{1000}{OT1}
1925 \setfont\reducedttsl\ttslshape{10}{1000}{OT1TT}
1926 \font\reducedi=cmmi10
1927 \font\reducedsy=cmsy10
1928 \def\reducedecsize{1000}
1929
1930 \textleading = 13.2pt % line spacing for 11pt CM
1931 \textfonts % reset the current fonts
1932 \rm
1933 } % end of 11pt text font size definitions, \definetextfontsizexi
1934
1935
1936 % Definitions to make the main text be 10pt Computer Modern, with
1937 % section, chapter, etc., sizes following suit. This is for the GNU
1938 % Press printing of the Emacs 22 manual. Maybe other manuals in the
1939 % future. Used with @smallbook, which sets the leading to 12pt.
1940 %
1941 \def\definetextfontsizex{%
1942 % Text fonts (10pt).
1943 \def\textnominalsize{10pt}
1944 \edef\mainmagstep{1000}
1945 \setfont\textrm\rmshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1}
1946 \setfont\texttt\ttshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1TT}
1947 \setfont\textbf\bfshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1}
1948 \setfont\textit\itshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1IT}
1949 \setfont\textsl\slshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1}
1950 \setfont\textsf\sfshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1}
1951 \setfont\textsc\scshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1}
1952 \setfont\textttsl\ttslshape{10}{\mainmagstep}{OT1TT}
1953 \font\texti=cmmi10 scaled \mainmagstep
1954 \font\textsy=cmsy10 scaled \mainmagstep
1955 \def\textecsize{1000}
1956
1957 % A few fonts for @defun names and args.
1958 \setfont\defbf\bfshape{10}{\magstephalf}{OT1}
1959 \setfont\deftt\ttshape{10}{\magstephalf}{OT1TT}
1960 \setfont\defttsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstephalf}{OT1TT}
1961 \def\df{\let\tentt=\deftt \let\tenbf = \defbf \let\tenttsl=\defttsl \bf}
1962
1963 % Fonts for indices, footnotes, small examples (9pt).
1964 \def\smallnominalsize{9pt}
1965 \setfont\smallrm\rmshape{9}{1000}{OT1}
1966 \setfont\smalltt\ttshape{9}{1000}{OT1TT}
1967 \setfont\smallbf\bfshape{10}{900}{OT1}
1968 \setfont\smallit\itshape{9}{1000}{OT1IT}
1969 \setfont\smallsl\slshape{9}{1000}{OT1}
1970 \setfont\smallsf\sfshape{9}{1000}{OT1}
1971 \setfont\smallsc\scshape{10}{900}{OT1}
1972 \setfont\smallttsl\ttslshape{10}{900}{OT1TT}
1973 \font\smalli=cmmi9
1974 \font\smallsy=cmsy9
1975 \def\smallecsize{0900}
1976
1977 % Fonts for small examples (8pt).
1978 \def\smallernominalsize{8pt}
1979 \setfont\smallerrm\rmshape{8}{1000}{OT1}
1980 \setfont\smallertt\ttshape{8}{1000}{OT1TT}
1981 \setfont\smallerbf\bfshape{10}{800}{OT1}
1982 \setfont\smallerit\itshape{8}{1000}{OT1IT}
1983 \setfont\smallersl\slshape{8}{1000}{OT1}
1984 \setfont\smallersf\sfshape{8}{1000}{OT1}
1985 \setfont\smallersc\scshape{10}{800}{OT1}
1986 \setfont\smallerttsl\ttslshape{10}{800}{OT1TT}
1987 \font\smalleri=cmmi8
1988 \font\smallersy=cmsy8
1989 \def\smallerecsize{0800}
1990
1991 % Fonts for title page (20.4pt):
1992 \def\titlenominalsize{20pt}
1993 \setfont\titlerm\rmbshape{12}{\magstep3}{OT1}
1994 \setfont\titleit\itbshape{10}{\magstep4}{OT1IT}
1995 \setfont\titlesl\slbshape{10}{\magstep4}{OT1}
1996 \setfont\titlett\ttbshape{12}{\magstep3}{OT1TT}
1997 \setfont\titlettsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstep4}{OT1TT}
1998 \setfont\titlesf\sfbshape{17}{\magstep1}{OT1}
1999 \let\titlebf=\titlerm
2000 \setfont\titlesc\scbshape{10}{\magstep4}{OT1}
2001 \font\titlei=cmmi12 scaled \magstep3
2002 \font\titlesy=cmsy10 scaled \magstep4
2003 \def\titleecsize{2074}
2004
2005 % Chapter fonts (14.4pt).
2006 \def\chapnominalsize{14pt}
2007 \setfont\chaprm\rmbshape{12}{\magstep1}{OT1}
2008 \setfont\chapit\itbshape{10}{\magstep2}{OT1IT}
2009 \setfont\chapsl\slbshape{10}{\magstep2}{OT1}
2010 \setfont\chaptt\ttbshape{12}{\magstep1}{OT1TT}
2011 \setfont\chapttsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstep2}{OT1TT}
2012 \setfont\chapsf\sfbshape{12}{\magstep1}{OT1}
2013 \let\chapbf\chaprm
2014 \setfont\chapsc\scbshape{10}{\magstep2}{OT1}
2015 \font\chapi=cmmi12 scaled \magstep1
2016 \font\chapsy=cmsy10 scaled \magstep2
2017 \def\chapecsize{1440}
2018
2019 % Section fonts (12pt).
2020 \def\secnominalsize{12pt}
2021 \setfont\secrm\rmbshape{12}{1000}{OT1}
2022 \setfont\secit\itbshape{10}{\magstep1}{OT1IT}
2023 \setfont\secsl\slbshape{10}{\magstep1}{OT1}
2024 \setfont\sectt\ttbshape{12}{1000}{OT1TT}
2025 \setfont\secttsl\ttslshape{10}{\magstep1}{OT1TT}
2026 \setfont\secsf\sfbshape{12}{1000}{OT1}
2027 \let\secbf\secrm
2028 \setfont\secsc\scbshape{10}{\magstep1}{OT1}
2029 \font\seci=cmmi12
2030 \font\secsy=cmsy10 scaled \magstep1
2031 \def\sececsize{1200}
2032
2033 % Subsection fonts (10pt).
2034 \def\ssecnominalsize{10pt}
2035 \setfont\ssecrm\rmbshape{10}{1000}{OT1}
2036 \setfont\ssecit\itbshape{10}{1000}{OT1IT}
2037 \setfont\ssecsl\slbshape{10}{1000}{OT1}
2038 \setfont\ssectt\ttbshape{10}{1000}{OT1TT}
2039 \setfont\ssecttsl\ttslshape{10}{1000}{OT1TT}
2040 \setfont\ssecsf\sfbshape{10}{1000}{OT1}
2041 \let\ssecbf\ssecrm
2042 \setfont\ssecsc\scbshape{10}{1000}{OT1}
2043 \font\sseci=cmmi10
2044 \font\ssecsy=cmsy10
2045 \def\ssececsize{1000}
2046
2047 % Reduced fonts for @acro in text (9pt).
2048 \def\reducednominalsize{9pt}
2049 \setfont\reducedrm\rmshape{9}{1000}{OT1}
2050 \setfont\reducedtt\ttshape{9}{1000}{OT1TT}
2051 \setfont\reducedbf\bfshape{10}{900}{OT1}
2052 \setfont\reducedit\itshape{9}{1000}{OT1IT}
2053 \setfont\reducedsl\slshape{9}{1000}{OT1}
2054 \setfont\reducedsf\sfshape{9}{1000}{OT1}
2055 \setfont\reducedsc\scshape{10}{900}{OT1}
2056 \setfont\reducedttsl\ttslshape{10}{900}{OT1TT}
2057 \font\reducedi=cmmi9
2058 \font\reducedsy=cmsy9
2059 \def\reducedecsize{0900}
2060
2061 \divide\parskip by 2 % reduce space between paragraphs
2062 \textleading = 12pt % line spacing for 10pt CM
2063 \textfonts % reset the current fonts
2064 \rm
2065 } % end of 10pt text font size definitions, \definetextfontsizex
2066
2067
2068 % We provide the user-level command
2069 % @fonttextsize 10
2070 % (or 11) to redefine the text font size. pt is assumed.
2071 %
2072 \def\xiword{11}
2073 \def\xword{10}
2074 \def\xwordpt{10pt}
2075 %
2076 \parseargdef\fonttextsize{%
2077 \def\textsizearg{#1}%
2078 %\wlog{doing @fonttextsize \textsizearg}%
2079 %
2080 % Set \globaldefs so that documents can use this inside @tex, since
2081 % makeinfo 4.8 does not support it, but we need it nonetheless.
2082 %
2083 \begingroup \globaldefs=1
2084 \ifx\textsizearg\xword \definetextfontsizex
2085 \else \ifx\textsizearg\xiword \definetextfontsizexi
2086 \else
2087 \errhelp=\EMsimple
2088 \errmessage{@fonttextsize only supports `10' or `11', not `\textsizearg'}
2089 \fi\fi
2090 \endgroup
2091 }
2092
2093
2094 % In order for the font changes to affect most math symbols and letters,
2095 % we have to define the \textfont of the standard families. Since
2096 % texinfo doesn't allow for producing subscripts and superscripts except
2097 % in the main text, we don't bother to reset \scriptfont and
2098 % \scriptscriptfont (which would also require loading a lot more fonts).
2099 %
2100 \def\resetmathfonts{%
2101 \textfont0=\tenrm \textfont1=\teni \textfont2=\tensy
2102 \textfont\itfam=\tenit \textfont\slfam=\tensl \textfont\bffam=\tenbf
2103 \textfont\ttfam=\tentt \textfont\sffam=\tensf
2104 }
2105
2106 % The font-changing commands redefine the meanings of \tenSTYLE, instead
2107 % of just \STYLE. We do this because \STYLE needs to also set the
2108 % current \fam for math mode. Our \STYLE (e.g., \rm) commands hardwire
2109 % \tenSTYLE to set the current font.
2110 %
2111 % Each font-changing command also sets the names \lsize (one size lower)
2112 % and \lllsize (three sizes lower). These relative commands are used in
2113 % the LaTeX logo and acronyms.
2114 %
2115 % This all needs generalizing, badly.
2116 %
2117 \def\textfonts{%
2118 \let\tenrm=\textrm \let\tenit=\textit \let\tensl=\textsl
2119 \let\tenbf=\textbf \let\tentt=\texttt \let\smallcaps=\textsc
2120 \let\tensf=\textsf \let\teni=\texti \let\tensy=\textsy
2121 \let\tenttsl=\textttsl
2122 \def\curfontsize{text}%
2123 \def\lsize{reduced}\def\lllsize{smaller}%
2124 \resetmathfonts \setleading{\textleading}}
2125 \def\titlefonts{%
2126 \let\tenrm=\titlerm \let\tenit=\titleit \let\tensl=\titlesl
2127 \let\tenbf=\titlebf \let\tentt=\titlett \let\smallcaps=\titlesc
2128 \let\tensf=\titlesf \let\teni=\titlei \let\tensy=\titlesy
2129 \let\tenttsl=\titlettsl
2130 \def\curfontsize{title}%
2131 \def\lsize{chap}\def\lllsize{subsec}%
2132 \resetmathfonts \setleading{27pt}}
2133 \def\titlefont#1{{\titlefonts\rmisbold #1}}
2134 \def\chapfonts{%
2135 \let\tenrm=\chaprm \let\tenit=\chapit \let\tensl=\chapsl
2136 \let\tenbf=\chapbf \let\tentt=\chaptt \let\smallcaps=\chapsc
2137 \let\tensf=\chapsf \let\teni=\chapi \let\tensy=\chapsy
2138 \let\tenttsl=\chapttsl
2139 \def\curfontsize{chap}%
2140 \def\lsize{sec}\def\lllsize{text}%
2141 \resetmathfonts \setleading{19pt}}
2142 \def\secfonts{%
2143 \let\tenrm=\secrm \let\tenit=\secit \let\tensl=\secsl
2144 \let\tenbf=\secbf \let\tentt=\sectt \let\smallcaps=\secsc
2145 \let\tensf=\secsf \let\teni=\seci \let\tensy=\secsy
2146 \let\tenttsl=\secttsl
2147 \def\curfontsize{sec}%
2148 \def\lsize{subsec}\def\lllsize{reduced}%
2149 \resetmathfonts \setleading{16pt}}
2150 \def\subsecfonts{%
2151 \let\tenrm=\ssecrm \let\tenit=\ssecit \let\tensl=\ssecsl
2152 \let\tenbf=\ssecbf \let\tentt=\ssectt \let\smallcaps=\ssecsc
2153 \let\tensf=\ssecsf \let\teni=\sseci \let\tensy=\ssecsy
2154 \let\tenttsl=\ssecttsl
2155 \def\curfontsize{ssec}%
2156 \def\lsize{text}\def\lllsize{small}%
2157 \resetmathfonts \setleading{15pt}}
2158 \let\subsubsecfonts = \subsecfonts
2159 \def\reducedfonts{%
2160 \let\tenrm=\reducedrm \let\tenit=\reducedit \let\tensl=\reducedsl
2161 \let\tenbf=\reducedbf \let\tentt=\reducedtt \let\reducedcaps=\reducedsc
2162 \let\tensf=\reducedsf \let\teni=\reducedi \let\tensy=\reducedsy
2163 \let\tenttsl=\reducedttsl
2164 \def\curfontsize{reduced}%
2165 \def\lsize{small}\def\lllsize{smaller}%
2166 \resetmathfonts \setleading{10.5pt}}
2167 \def\smallfonts{%
2168 \let\tenrm=\smallrm \let\tenit=\smallit \let\tensl=\smallsl
2169 \let\tenbf=\smallbf \let\tentt=\smalltt \let\smallcaps=\smallsc
2170 \let\tensf=\smallsf \let\teni=\smalli \let\tensy=\smallsy
2171 \let\tenttsl=\smallttsl
2172 \def\curfontsize{small}%
2173 \def\lsize{smaller}\def\lllsize{smaller}%
2174 \resetmathfonts \setleading{10.5pt}}
2175 \def\smallerfonts{%
2176 \let\tenrm=\smallerrm \let\tenit=\smallerit \let\tensl=\smallersl
2177 \let\tenbf=\smallerbf \let\tentt=\smallertt \let\smallcaps=\smallersc
2178 \let\tensf=\smallersf \let\teni=\smalleri \let\tensy=\smallersy
2179 \let\tenttsl=\smallerttsl
2180 \def\curfontsize{smaller}%
2181 \def\lsize{smaller}\def\lllsize{smaller}%
2182 \resetmathfonts \setleading{9.5pt}}
2183
2184 % Fonts for short table of contents.
2185 \setfont\shortcontrm\rmshape{12}{1000}{OT1}
2186 \setfont\shortcontbf\bfshape{10}{\magstep1}{OT1} % no cmb12
2187 \setfont\shortcontsl\slshape{12}{1000}{OT1}
2188 \setfont\shortconttt\ttshape{12}{1000}{OT1TT}
2189
2190 % Define these just so they can be easily changed for other fonts.
2191 \def\angleleft{$\langle$}
2192 \def\angleright{$\rangle$}
2193
2194 % Set the fonts to use with the @small... environments.
2195 \let\smallexamplefonts = \smallfonts
2196
2197 % About \smallexamplefonts. If we use \smallfonts (9pt), @smallexample
2198 % can fit this many characters:
2199 % 8.5x11=86 smallbook=72 a4=90 a5=69
2200 % If we use \scriptfonts (8pt), then we can fit this many characters:
2201 % 8.5x11=90+ smallbook=80 a4=90+ a5=77
2202 % For me, subjectively, the few extra characters that fit aren't worth
2203 % the additional smallness of 8pt. So I'm making the default 9pt.
2204 %
2205 % By the way, for comparison, here's what fits with @example (10pt):
2206 % 8.5x11=71 smallbook=60 a4=75 a5=58
2207 % --karl, 24jan03.
2208
2209 % Set up the default fonts, so we can use them for creating boxes.
2210 %
2211 \definetextfontsizexi
2212
2213
2214 \message{markup,}
2215
2216 % Check if we are currently using a typewriter font. Since all the
2217 % Computer Modern typewriter fonts have zero interword stretch (and
2218 % shrink), and it is reasonable to expect all typewriter fonts to have
2219 % this property, we can check that font parameter.
2220 %
2221 \def\ifmonospace{\ifdim\fontdimen3\font=0pt }
2222
2223 % Markup style infrastructure. \defmarkupstylesetup\INITMACRO will
2224 % define and register \INITMACRO to be called on markup style changes.
2225 % \INITMACRO can check \currentmarkupstyle for the innermost
2226 % style and the set of \ifmarkupSTYLE switches for all styles
2227 % currently in effect.
2228 \newif\ifmarkupvar
2229 \newif\ifmarkupsamp
2230 \newif\ifmarkupkey
2231 %\newif\ifmarkupfile % @file == @samp.
2232 %\newif\ifmarkupoption % @option == @samp.
2233 \newif\ifmarkupcode
2234 \newif\ifmarkupkbd
2235 %\newif\ifmarkupenv % @env == @code.
2236 %\newif\ifmarkupcommand % @command == @code.
2237 \newif\ifmarkuptex % @tex (and part of @math, for now).
2238 \newif\ifmarkupexample
2239 \newif\ifmarkupverb
2240 \newif\ifmarkupverbatim
2241
2242 \let\currentmarkupstyle\empty
2243
2244 \def\setupmarkupstyle#1{%
2245 \csname markup#1true\endcsname
2246 \def\currentmarkupstyle{#1}%
2247 \markupstylesetup
2248 }
2249
2250 \let\markupstylesetup\empty
2251
2252 \def\defmarkupstylesetup#1{%
2253 \expandafter\def\expandafter\markupstylesetup
2254 \expandafter{\markupstylesetup #1}%
2255 \def#1%
2256 }
2257
2258 % Markup style setup for left and right quotes.
2259 \defmarkupstylesetup\markupsetuplq{%
2260 \expandafter\let\expandafter \temp
2261 \csname markupsetuplq\currentmarkupstyle\endcsname
2262 \ifx\temp\relax \markupsetuplqdefault \else \temp \fi
2263 }
2264
2265 \defmarkupstylesetup\markupsetuprq{%
2266 \expandafter\let\expandafter \temp
2267 \csname markupsetuprq\currentmarkupstyle\endcsname
2268 \ifx\temp\relax \markupsetuprqdefault \else \temp \fi
2269 }
2270
2271 {
2272 \catcode`\'=\active
2273 \catcode`\`=\active
2274
2275 \gdef\markupsetuplqdefault{\let`\lq}
2276 \gdef\markupsetuprqdefault{\let'\rq}
2277
2278 \gdef\markupsetcodequoteleft{\let`\codequoteleft}
2279 \gdef\markupsetcodequoteright{\let'\codequoteright}
2280 }
2281
2282 \let\markupsetuplqcode \markupsetcodequoteleft
2283 \let\markupsetuprqcode \markupsetcodequoteright
2284 %
2285 \let\markupsetuplqexample \markupsetcodequoteleft
2286 \let\markupsetuprqexample \markupsetcodequoteright
2287 %
2288 \let\markupsetuplqkbd \markupsetcodequoteleft
2289 \let\markupsetuprqkbd \markupsetcodequoteright
2290 %
2291 \let\markupsetuplqsamp \markupsetcodequoteleft
2292 \let\markupsetuprqsamp \markupsetcodequoteright
2293 %
2294 \let\markupsetuplqverb \markupsetcodequoteleft
2295 \let\markupsetuprqverb \markupsetcodequoteright
2296 %
2297 \let\markupsetuplqverbatim \markupsetcodequoteleft
2298 \let\markupsetuprqverbatim \markupsetcodequoteright
2299
2300 % Allow an option to not use regular directed right quote/apostrophe
2301 % (char 0x27), but instead the undirected quote from cmtt (char 0x0d).
2302 % The undirected quote is ugly, so don't make it the default, but it
2303 % works for pasting with more pdf viewers (at least evince), the
2304 % lilypond developers report. xpdf does work with the regular 0x27.
2305 %
2306 \def\codequoteright{%
2307 \expandafter\ifx\csname SETtxicodequoteundirected\endcsname\relax
2308 \expandafter\ifx\csname SETcodequoteundirected\endcsname\relax
2309 '%
2310 \else \char'15 \fi
2311 \else \char'15 \fi
2312 }
2313 %
2314 % and a similar option for the left quote char vs. a grave accent.
2315 % Modern fonts display ASCII 0x60 as a grave accent, so some people like
2316 % the code environments to do likewise.
2317 %
2318 \def\codequoteleft{%
2319 \expandafter\ifx\csname SETtxicodequotebacktick\endcsname\relax
2320 \expandafter\ifx\csname SETcodequotebacktick\endcsname\relax
2321 % [Knuth] pp. 380,381,391
2322 % \relax disables Spanish ligatures ?` and !` of \tt font.
2323 \relax`%
2324 \else \char'22 \fi
2325 \else \char'22 \fi
2326 }
2327
2328 % Commands to set the quote options.
2329 %
2330 \parseargdef\codequoteundirected{%
2331 \def\temp{#1}%
2332 \ifx\temp\onword
2333 \expandafter\let\csname SETtxicodequoteundirected\endcsname
2334 = t%
2335 \else\ifx\temp\offword
2336 \expandafter\let\csname SETtxicodequoteundirected\endcsname
2337 = \relax
2338 \else
2339 \errhelp = \EMsimple
2340 \errmessage{Unknown @codequoteundirected value `\temp', must be on|off}%
2341 \fi\fi
2342 }
2343 %
2344 \parseargdef\codequotebacktick{%
2345 \def\temp{#1}%
2346 \ifx\temp\onword
2347 \expandafter\let\csname SETtxicodequotebacktick\endcsname
2348 = t%
2349 \else\ifx\temp\offword
2350 \expandafter\let\csname SETtxicodequotebacktick\endcsname
2351 = \relax
2352 \else
2353 \errhelp = \EMsimple
2354 \errmessage{Unknown @codequotebacktick value `\temp', must be on|off}%
2355 \fi\fi
2356 }
2357
2358 % [Knuth] pp. 380,381,391, disable Spanish ligatures ?` and !` of \tt font.
2359 \def\noligaturesquoteleft{\relax\lq}
2360
2361 % Count depth in font-changes, for error checks
2362 \newcount\fontdepth \fontdepth=0
2363
2364 % Font commands.
2365
2366 % #1 is the font command (\sl or \it), #2 is the text to slant.
2367 % If we are in a monospaced environment, however, 1) always use \ttsl,
2368 % and 2) do not add an italic correction.
2369 \def\dosmartslant#1#2{%
2370 \ifusingtt
2371 {{\ttsl #2}\let\next=\relax}%
2372 {\def\next{{#1#2}\futurelet\next\smartitaliccorrection}}%
2373 \next
2374 }
2375 \def\smartslanted{\dosmartslant\sl}
2376 \def\smartitalic{\dosmartslant\it}
2377
2378 % Output an italic correction unless \next (presumed to be the following
2379 % character) is such as not to need one.
2380 \def\smartitaliccorrection{%
2381 \ifx\next,%
2382 \else\ifx\next-%
2383 \else\ifx\next.%
2384 \else\ifx\next\.%
2385 \else\ifx\next\comma%
2386 \else\ptexslash
2387 \fi\fi\fi\fi\fi
2388 \aftersmartic
2389 }
2390
2391 % Unconditional use \ttsl, and no ic. @var is set to this for defuns.
2392 \def\ttslanted#1{{\ttsl #1}}
2393
2394 % @cite is like \smartslanted except unconditionally use \sl. We never want
2395 % ttsl for book titles, do we?
2396 \def\cite#1{{\sl #1}\futurelet\next\smartitaliccorrection}
2397
2398 \def\aftersmartic{}
2399 \def\var#1{%
2400 \let\saveaftersmartic = \aftersmartic
2401 \def\aftersmartic{\null\let\aftersmartic=\saveaftersmartic}%
2402 \smartslanted{#1}%
2403 }
2404
2405 \let\i=\smartitalic
2406 \let\slanted=\smartslanted
2407 \let\dfn=\smartslanted
2408 \let\emph=\smartitalic
2409
2410 % Explicit font changes: @r, @sc, undocumented @ii.
2411 \def\r#1{{\rm #1}} % roman font
2412 \def\sc#1{{\smallcaps#1}} % smallcaps font
2413 \def\ii#1{{\it #1}} % italic font
2414
2415 % @b, explicit bold. Also @strong.
2416 \def\b#1{{\bf #1}}
2417 \let\strong=\b
2418
2419 % @sansserif, explicit sans.
2420 \def\sansserif#1{{\sf #1}}
2421
2422 % We can't just use \exhyphenpenalty, because that only has effect at
2423 % the end of a paragraph. Restore normal hyphenation at the end of the
2424 % group within which \nohyphenation is presumably called.
2425 %
2426 \def\nohyphenation{\hyphenchar\font = -1 \aftergroup\restorehyphenation}
2427 \def\restorehyphenation{\hyphenchar\font = `- }
2428
2429 % Set sfcode to normal for the chars that usually have another value.
2430 % Can't use plain's \frenchspacing because it uses the `\x notation, and
2431 % sometimes \x has an active definition that messes things up.
2432 %
2433 \catcode`@=11
2434 \def\plainfrenchspacing{%
2435 \sfcode\dotChar =\@m \sfcode\questChar=\@m \sfcode\exclamChar=\@m
2436 \sfcode\colonChar=\@m \sfcode\semiChar =\@m \sfcode\commaChar =\@m
2437 \def\endofsentencespacefactor{1000}% for @. and friends
2438 }
2439 \def\plainnonfrenchspacing{%
2440 \sfcode`\.3000\sfcode`\?3000\sfcode`\!3000
2441 \sfcode`\:2000\sfcode`\;1500\sfcode`\,1250
2442 \def\endofsentencespacefactor{3000}% for @. and friends
2443 }
2444 \catcode`@=\other
2445 \def\endofsentencespacefactor{3000}% default
2446
2447 % @t, explicit typewriter.
2448 \def\t#1{%
2449 {\tt \rawbackslash \plainfrenchspacing #1}%
2450 \null
2451 }
2452
2453 % @samp.
2454 \def\samp#1{{\setupmarkupstyle{samp}\lq\tclose{#1}\rq\null}}
2455
2456 % @indicateurl is \samp, that is, with quotes.
2457 \let\indicateurl=\samp
2458
2459 % @code (and similar) prints in typewriter, but with spaces the same
2460 % size as normal in the surrounding text, without hyphenation, etc.
2461 % This is a subroutine for that.
2462 \def\tclose#1{%
2463 {%
2464 % Change normal interword space to be same as for the current font.
2465 \spaceskip = \fontdimen2\font
2466 %
2467 % Switch to typewriter.
2468 \tt
2469 %
2470 % But `\ ' produces the large typewriter interword space.
2471 \def\ {{\spaceskip = 0pt{} }}%
2472 %
2473 % Turn off hyphenation.
2474 \nohyphenation
2475 %
2476 \rawbackslash
2477 \plainfrenchspacing
2478 #1%
2479 }%
2480 \null % reset spacefactor to 1000
2481 }
2482
2483 % We *must* turn on hyphenation at `-' and `_' in @code.
2484 % (But see \codedashfinish below.)
2485 % Otherwise, it is too hard to avoid overfull hboxes
2486 % in the Emacs manual, the Library manual, etc.
2487 %
2488 % Unfortunately, TeX uses one parameter (\hyphenchar) to control
2489 % both hyphenation at - and hyphenation within words.
2490 % We must therefore turn them both off (\tclose does that)
2491 % and arrange explicitly to hyphenate at a dash. -- rms.
2492 {
2493 \catcode`\-=\active \catcode`\_=\active
2494 \catcode`\'=\active \catcode`\`=\active
2495 \global\let'=\rq \global\let`=\lq % default definitions
2496 %
2497 \global\def\code{\begingroup
2498 \setupmarkupstyle{code}%
2499 % The following should really be moved into \setupmarkupstyle handlers.
2500 \catcode\dashChar=\active \catcode\underChar=\active
2501 \ifallowcodebreaks
2502 \let-\codedash
2503 \let_\codeunder
2504 \else
2505 \let-\normaldash
2506 \let_\realunder
2507 \fi
2508 % Given -foo (with a single dash), we do not want to allow a break
2509 % after the hyphen.
2510 \global\let\codedashprev=\codedash
2511 %
2512 \codex
2513 }
2514 %
2515 \gdef\codedash{\futurelet\next\codedashfinish}
2516 \gdef\codedashfinish{%
2517 \normaldash % always output the dash character itself.
2518 %
2519 % Now, output a discretionary to allow a line break, unless
2520 % (a) the next character is a -, or
2521 % (b) the preceding character is a -.
2522 % E.g., given --posix, we do not want to allow a break after either -.
2523 % Given --foo-bar, we do want to allow a break between the - and the b.
2524 \ifx\next\codedash \else
2525 \ifx\codedashprev\codedash
2526 \else \discretionary{}{}{}\fi
2527 \fi
2528 % we need the space after the = for the case when \next itself is a
2529 % space token; it would get swallowed otherwise. As in @code{- a}.
2530 \global\let\codedashprev= \next
2531 }
2532 }
2533 \def\normaldash{-}
2534 %
2535 \def\codex #1{\tclose{#1}\endgroup}
2536
2537 \def\codeunder{%
2538 % this is all so @math{@code{var_name}+1} can work. In math mode, _
2539 % is "active" (mathcode"8000) and \normalunderscore (or \char95, etc.)
2540 % will therefore expand the active definition of _, which is us
2541 % (inside @code that is), therefore an endless loop.
2542 \ifusingtt{\ifmmode
2543 \mathchar"075F % class 0=ordinary, family 7=ttfam, pos 0x5F=_.
2544 \else\normalunderscore \fi
2545 \discretionary{}{}{}}%
2546 {\_}%
2547 }
2548
2549 % An additional complication: the above will allow breaks after, e.g.,
2550 % each of the four underscores in __typeof__. This is bad.
2551 % @allowcodebreaks provides a document-level way to turn breaking at -
2552 % and _ on and off.
2553 %
2554 \newif\ifallowcodebreaks \allowcodebreakstrue
2555
2556 \def\keywordtrue{true}
2557 \def\keywordfalse{false}
2558
2559 \parseargdef\allowcodebreaks{%
2560 \def\txiarg{#1}%
2561 \ifx\txiarg\keywordtrue
2562 \allowcodebreakstrue
2563 \else\ifx\txiarg\keywordfalse
2564 \allowcodebreaksfalse
2565 \else
2566 \errhelp = \EMsimple
2567 \errmessage{Unknown @allowcodebreaks option `\txiarg', must be true|false}%
2568 \fi\fi
2569 }
2570
2571 % For @command, @env, @file, @option quotes seem unnecessary,
2572 % so use \code rather than \samp.
2573 \let\command=\code
2574 \let\env=\code
2575 \let\file=\code
2576 \let\option=\code
2577
2578 % @uref (abbreviation for `urlref') aka @url takes an optional
2579 % (comma-separated) second argument specifying the text to display and
2580 % an optional third arg as text to display instead of (rather than in
2581 % addition to) the url itself. First (mandatory) arg is the url.
2582
2583 % TeX-only option to allow changing PDF output to show only the second
2584 % arg (if given), and not the url (which is then just the link target).
2585 \newif\ifurefurlonlylink
2586
2587 % The main macro is \urefbreak, which allows breaking at expected
2588 % places within the url. (There used to be another version, which
2589 % didn't support automatic breaking.)
2590 \def\urefbreak{\begingroup \urefcatcodes \dourefbreak}
2591 \let\uref=\urefbreak
2592 %
2593 \def\dourefbreak#1{\urefbreakfinish #1,,,\finish}
2594 \def\urefbreakfinish#1,#2,#3,#4\finish{% doesn't work in @example
2595 \unsepspaces
2596 \pdfurl{#1}%
2597 \setbox0 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #3}%
2598 \ifdim\wd0 > 0pt
2599 \unhbox0 % third arg given, show only that
2600 \else
2601 \setbox0 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #2}% look for second arg
2602 \ifdim\wd0 > 0pt
2603 \ifpdf
2604 \ifurefurlonlylink
2605 % PDF plus option to not display url, show just arg
2606 \unhbox0
2607 \else
2608 % PDF, normally display both arg and url for consistency,
2609 % visibility, if the pdf is eventually used to print, etc.
2610 \unhbox0\ (\urefcode{#1})%
2611 \fi
2612 \else
2613 \unhbox0\ (\urefcode{#1})% DVI, always show arg and url
2614 \fi
2615 \else
2616 \urefcode{#1}% only url given, so show it
2617 \fi
2618 \fi
2619 \endlink
2620 \endgroup}
2621
2622 % Allow line breaks around only a few characters (only).
2623 \def\urefcatcodes{%
2624 \catcode\ampChar=\active \catcode\dotChar=\active
2625 \catcode\hashChar=\active \catcode\questChar=\active
2626 \catcode\slashChar=\active
2627 }
2628 {
2629 \urefcatcodes
2630 %
2631 \global\def\urefcode{\begingroup
2632 \setupmarkupstyle{code}%
2633 \urefcatcodes
2634 \let&\urefcodeamp
2635 \let.\urefcodedot
2636 \let#\urefcodehash
2637 \let?\urefcodequest
2638 \let/\urefcodeslash
2639 \codex
2640 }
2641 %
2642 % By default, they are just regular characters.
2643 \global\def&{\normalamp}
2644 \global\def.{\normaldot}
2645 \global\def#{\normalhash}
2646 \global\def?{\normalquest}
2647 \global\def/{\normalslash}
2648 }
2649
2650 % we put a little stretch before and after the breakable chars, to help
2651 % line breaking of long url's. The unequal skips make look better in
2652 % cmtt at least, especially for dots.
2653 \def\urefprestretchamount{.13em}
2654 \def\urefpoststretchamount{.1em}
2655 \def\urefprestretch{\urefprebreak \hskip0pt plus\urefprestretchamount\relax}
2656 \def\urefpoststretch{\urefpostbreak \hskip0pt plus\urefprestretchamount\relax}
2657 %
2658 \def\urefcodeamp{\urefprestretch \&\urefpoststretch}
2659 \def\urefcodedot{\urefprestretch .\urefpoststretch}
2660 \def\urefcodehash{\urefprestretch \#\urefpoststretch}
2661 \def\urefcodequest{\urefprestretch ?\urefpoststretch}
2662 \def\urefcodeslash{\futurelet\next\urefcodeslashfinish}
2663 {
2664 \catcode`\/=\active
2665 \global\def\urefcodeslashfinish{%
2666 \urefprestretch \slashChar
2667 % Allow line break only after the final / in a sequence of
2668 % slashes, to avoid line break between the slashes in http://.
2669 \ifx\next/\else \urefpoststretch \fi
2670 }
2671 }
2672
2673 % One more complication: by default we'll break after the special
2674 % characters, but some people like to break before the special chars, so
2675 % allow that. Also allow no breaking at all, for manual control.
2676 %
2677 \parseargdef\urefbreakstyle{%
2678 \def\txiarg{#1}%
2679 \ifx\txiarg\wordnone
2680 \def\urefprebreak{\nobreak}\def\urefpostbreak{\nobreak}
2681 \else\ifx\txiarg\wordbefore
2682 \def\urefprebreak{\allowbreak}\def\urefpostbreak{\nobreak}
2683 \else\ifx\txiarg\wordafter
2684 \def\urefprebreak{\nobreak}\def\urefpostbreak{\allowbreak}
2685 \else
2686 \errhelp = \EMsimple
2687 \errmessage{Unknown @urefbreakstyle setting `\txiarg'}%
2688 \fi\fi\fi
2689 }
2690 \def\wordafter{after}
2691 \def\wordbefore{before}
2692 \def\wordnone{none}
2693
2694 \urefbreakstyle after
2695
2696 % @url synonym for @uref, since that's how everyone uses it.
2697 %
2698 \let\url=\uref
2699
2700 % rms does not like angle brackets --karl, 17may97.
2701 % So now @email is just like @uref, unless we are pdf.
2702 %
2703 %\def\email#1{\angleleft{\tt #1}\angleright}
2704 \ifpdf
2705 \def\email#1{\doemail#1,,\finish}
2706 \def\doemail#1,#2,#3\finish{\begingroup
2707 \unsepspaces
2708 \pdfurl{mailto:#1}%
2709 \setbox0 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #2}%
2710 \ifdim\wd0>0pt\unhbox0\else\code{#1}\fi
2711 \endlink
2712 \endgroup}
2713 \else
2714 \let\email=\uref
2715 \fi
2716
2717 % @kbdinputstyle -- arg is `distinct' (@kbd uses slanted tty font always),
2718 % `example' (@kbd uses ttsl only inside of @example and friends),
2719 % or `code' (@kbd uses normal tty font always).
2720 \parseargdef\kbdinputstyle{%
2721 \def\txiarg{#1}%
2722 \ifx\txiarg\worddistinct
2723 \gdef\kbdexamplefont{\ttsl}\gdef\kbdfont{\ttsl}%
2724 \else\ifx\txiarg\wordexample
2725 \gdef\kbdexamplefont{\ttsl}\gdef\kbdfont{\tt}%
2726 \else\ifx\txiarg\wordcode
2727 \gdef\kbdexamplefont{\tt}\gdef\kbdfont{\tt}%
2728 \else
2729 \errhelp = \EMsimple
2730 \errmessage{Unknown @kbdinputstyle setting `\txiarg'}%
2731 \fi\fi\fi
2732 }
2733 \def\worddistinct{distinct}
2734 \def\wordexample{example}
2735 \def\wordcode{code}
2736
2737 % Default is `distinct'.
2738 \kbdinputstyle distinct
2739
2740 % @kbd is like @code, except that if the argument is just one @key command,
2741 % then @kbd has no effect.
2742 \def\kbd#1{{\def\look{#1}\expandafter\kbdsub\look??\par}}
2743
2744 \def\xkey{\key}
2745 \def\kbdsub#1#2#3\par{%
2746 \def\one{#1}\def\three{#3}\def\threex{??}%
2747 \ifx\one\xkey\ifx\threex\three \key{#2}%
2748 \else{\tclose{\kbdfont\setupmarkupstyle{kbd}\look}}\fi
2749 \else{\tclose{\kbdfont\setupmarkupstyle{kbd}\look}}\fi
2750 }
2751
2752 % definition of @key that produces a lozenge. Doesn't adjust to text size.
2753 %\setfont\keyrm\rmshape{8}{1000}{OT1}
2754 %\font\keysy=cmsy9
2755 %\def\key#1{{\keyrm\textfont2=\keysy \leavevmode\hbox{%
2756 % \raise0.4pt\hbox{\angleleft}\kern-.08em\vtop{%
2757 % \vbox{\hrule\kern-0.4pt
2758 % \hbox{\raise0.4pt\hbox{\vphantom{\angleleft}}#1}}%
2759 % \kern-0.4pt\hrule}%
2760 % \kern-.06em\raise0.4pt\hbox{\angleright}}}}
2761
2762 % definition of @key with no lozenge. If the current font is already
2763 % monospace, don't change it; that way, we respect @kbdinputstyle. But
2764 % if it isn't monospace, then use \tt.
2765 %
2766 \def\key#1{{\setupmarkupstyle{key}%
2767 \nohyphenation
2768 \ifmonospace\else\tt\fi
2769 #1}\null}
2770
2771 % @clicksequence{File @click{} Open ...}
2772 \def\clicksequence#1{\begingroup #1\endgroup}
2773
2774 % @clickstyle @arrow (by default)
2775 \parseargdef\clickstyle{\def\click{#1}}
2776 \def\click{\arrow}
2777
2778 % Typeset a dimension, e.g., `in' or `pt'. The only reason for the
2779 % argument is to make the input look right: @dmn{pt} instead of @dmn{}pt.
2780 %
2781 \def\dmn#1{\thinspace #1}
2782
2783 % @l was never documented to mean ``switch to the Lisp font'',
2784 % and it is not used as such in any manual I can find. We need it for
2785 % Polish suppressed-l. --karl, 22sep96.
2786 %\def\l#1{{\li #1}\null}
2787
2788 % @acronym for "FBI", "NATO", and the like.
2789 % We print this one point size smaller, since it's intended for
2790 % all-uppercase.
2791 %
2792 \def\acronym#1{\doacronym #1,,\finish}
2793 \def\doacronym#1,#2,#3\finish{%
2794 {\selectfonts\lsize #1}%
2795 \def\temp{#2}%
2796 \ifx\temp\empty \else
2797 \space ({\unsepspaces \ignorespaces \temp \unskip})%
2798 \fi
2799 \null % reset \spacefactor=1000
2800 }
2801
2802 % @abbr for "Comput. J." and the like.
2803 % No font change, but don't do end-of-sentence spacing.
2804 %
2805 \def\abbr#1{\doabbr #1,,\finish}
2806 \def\doabbr#1,#2,#3\finish{%
2807 {\plainfrenchspacing #1}%
2808 \def\temp{#2}%
2809 \ifx\temp\empty \else
2810 \space ({\unsepspaces \ignorespaces \temp \unskip})%
2811 \fi
2812 \null % reset \spacefactor=1000
2813 }
2814
2815 % @asis just yields its argument. Used with @table, for example.
2816 %
2817 \def\asis#1{#1}
2818
2819 % @math outputs its argument in math mode.
2820 %
2821 % One complication: _ usually means subscripts, but it could also mean
2822 % an actual _ character, as in @math{@var{some_variable} + 1}. So make
2823 % _ active, and distinguish by seeing if the current family is \slfam,
2824 % which is what @var uses.
2825 {
2826 \catcode`\_ = \active
2827 \gdef\mathunderscore{%
2828 \catcode`\_=\active
2829 \def_{\ifnum\fam=\slfam \_\else\sb\fi}%
2830 }
2831 }
2832 % Another complication: we want \\ (and @\) to output a math (or tt) \.
2833 % FYI, plain.tex uses \\ as a temporary control sequence (for no
2834 % particular reason), but this is not advertised and we don't care.
2835 %
2836 % The \mathchar is class=0=ordinary, family=7=ttfam, position=5C=\.
2837 \def\mathbackslash{\ifnum\fam=\ttfam \mathchar"075C \else\backslash \fi}
2838 %
2839 \def\math{%
2840 \tex
2841 \mathunderscore
2842 \let\\ = \mathbackslash
2843 \mathactive
2844 % make the texinfo accent commands work in math mode
2845 \let\"=\ddot
2846 \let\'=\acute
2847 \let\==\bar
2848 \let\^=\hat
2849 \let\`=\grave
2850 \let\u=\breve
2851 \let\v=\check
2852 \let\~=\tilde
2853 \let\dotaccent=\dot
2854 $\finishmath
2855 }
2856 \def\finishmath#1{#1$\endgroup} % Close the group opened by \tex.
2857
2858 % Some active characters (such as <) are spaced differently in math.
2859 % We have to reset their definitions in case the @math was an argument
2860 % to a command which sets the catcodes (such as @item or @section).
2861 %
2862 {
2863 \catcode`^ = \active
2864 \catcode`< = \active
2865 \catcode`> = \active
2866 \catcode`+ = \active
2867 \catcode`' = \active
2868 \gdef\mathactive{%
2869 \let^ = \ptexhat
2870 \let< = \ptexless
2871 \let> = \ptexgtr
2872 \let+ = \ptexplus
2873 \let' = \ptexquoteright
2874 }
2875 }
2876
2877 % ctrl is no longer a Texinfo command, but leave this definition for fun.
2878 \def\ctrl #1{{\tt \rawbackslash \hat}#1}
2879
2880 % @inlinefmt{FMTNAME,PROCESSED-TEXT} and @inlineraw{FMTNAME,RAW-TEXT}.
2881 % Ignore unless FMTNAME == tex; then it is like @iftex and @tex,
2882 % except specified as a normal braced arg, so no newlines to worry about.
2883 %
2884 \def\outfmtnametex{tex}
2885 %
2886 \long\def\inlinefmt#1{\doinlinefmt #1,\finish}
2887 \long\def\doinlinefmt#1,#2,\finish{%
2888 \def\inlinefmtname{#1}%
2889 \ifx\inlinefmtname\outfmtnametex \ignorespaces #2\fi
2890 }
2891 %
2892 % @inlinefmtifelse{FMTNAME,THEN-TEXT,ELSE-TEXT} expands THEN-TEXT if
2893 % FMTNAME is tex, else ELSE-TEXT.
2894 \long\def\inlinefmtifelse#1{\doinlinefmtifelse #1,,,\finish}
2895 \long\def\doinlinefmtifelse#1,#2,#3,#4,\finish{%
2896 \def\inlinefmtname{#1}%
2897 \ifx\inlinefmtname\outfmtnametex \ignorespaces #2\else \ignorespaces #3\fi
2898 }
2899 %
2900 % For raw, must switch into @tex before parsing the argument, to avoid
2901 % setting catcodes prematurely. Doing it this way means that, for
2902 % example, @inlineraw{html, foo{bar} gets a parse error instead of being
2903 % ignored. But this isn't important because if people want a literal
2904 % *right* brace they would have to use a command anyway, so they may as
2905 % well use a command to get a left brace too. We could re-use the
2906 % delimiter character idea from \verb, but it seems like overkill.
2907 %
2908 \long\def\inlineraw{\tex \doinlineraw}
2909 \long\def\doinlineraw#1{\doinlinerawtwo #1,\finish}
2910 \def\doinlinerawtwo#1,#2,\finish{%
2911 \def\inlinerawname{#1}%
2912 \ifx\inlinerawname\outfmtnametex \ignorespaces #2\fi
2913 \endgroup % close group opened by \tex.
2914 }
2915
2916 % @inlineifset{VAR, TEXT} expands TEXT if VAR is @set.
2917 %
2918 \long\def\inlineifset#1{\doinlineifset #1,\finish}
2919 \long\def\doinlineifset#1,#2,\finish{%
2920 \def\inlinevarname{#1}%
2921 \expandafter\ifx\csname SET\inlinevarname\endcsname\relax
2922 \else\ignorespaces#2\fi
2923 }
2924
2925 % @inlineifclear{VAR, TEXT} expands TEXT if VAR is not @set.
2926 %
2927 \long\def\inlineifclear#1{\doinlineifclear #1,\finish}
2928 \long\def\doinlineifclear#1,#2,\finish{%
2929 \def\inlinevarname{#1}%
2930 \expandafter\ifx\csname SET\inlinevarname\endcsname\relax \ignorespaces#2\fi
2931 }
2932
2933
2934 \message{glyphs,}
2935 % and logos.
2936
2937 % @@ prints an @, as does @atchar{}.
2938 \def\@{\char64 }
2939 \let\atchar=\@
2940
2941 % @{ @} @lbracechar{} @rbracechar{} all generate brace characters.
2942 % Unless we're in typewriter, use \ecfont because the CM text fonts do
2943 % not have braces, and we don't want to switch into math.
2944 \def\mylbrace{{\ifmonospace\else\ecfont\fi \char123}}
2945 \def\myrbrace{{\ifmonospace\else\ecfont\fi \char125}}
2946 \let\{=\mylbrace \let\lbracechar=\{
2947 \let\}=\myrbrace \let\rbracechar=\}
2948 \begingroup
2949 % Definitions to produce \{ and \} commands for indices,
2950 % and @{ and @} for the aux/toc files.
2951 \catcode`\{ = \other \catcode`\} = \other
2952 \catcode`\[ = 1 \catcode`\] = 2
2953 \catcode`\! = 0 \catcode`\\ = \other
2954 !gdef!lbracecmd[\{]%
2955 !gdef!rbracecmd[\}]%
2956 !gdef!lbraceatcmd[@{]%
2957 !gdef!rbraceatcmd[@}]%
2958 !endgroup
2959
2960 % @comma{} to avoid , parsing problems.
2961 \let\comma = ,
2962
2963 % Accents: @, @dotaccent @ringaccent @ubaraccent @udotaccent
2964 % Others are defined by plain TeX: @` @' @" @^ @~ @= @u @v @H.
2965 \let\, = \ptexc
2966 \let\dotaccent = \ptexdot
2967 \def\ringaccent#1{{\accent23 #1}}
2968 \let\tieaccent = \ptext
2969 \let\ubaraccent = \ptexb
2970 \let\udotaccent = \d
2971
2972 % Other special characters: @questiondown @exclamdown @ordf @ordm
2973 % Plain TeX defines: @AA @AE @O @OE @L (plus lowercase versions) @ss.
2974 \def\questiondown{?`}
2975 \def\exclamdown{!`}
2976 \def\ordf{\leavevmode\raise1ex\hbox{\selectfonts\lllsize \underbar{a}}}
2977 \def\ordm{\leavevmode\raise1ex\hbox{\selectfonts\lllsize \underbar{o}}}
2978
2979 % Dotless i and dotless j, used for accents.
2980 \def\imacro{i}
2981 \def\jmacro{j}
2982 \def\dotless#1{%
2983 \def\temp{#1}%
2984 \ifx\temp\imacro \ifmmode\imath \else\ptexi \fi
2985 \else\ifx\temp\jmacro \ifmmode\jmath \else\j \fi
2986 \else \errmessage{@dotless can be used only with i or j}%
2987 \fi\fi
2988 }
2989
2990 % The \TeX{} logo, as in plain, but resetting the spacing so that a
2991 % period following counts as ending a sentence. (Idea found in latex.)
2992 %
2993 \edef\TeX{\TeX \spacefactor=1000 }
2994
2995 % @LaTeX{} logo. Not quite the same results as the definition in
2996 % latex.ltx, since we use a different font for the raised A; it's most
2997 % convenient for us to use an explicitly smaller font, rather than using
2998 % the \scriptstyle font (since we don't reset \scriptstyle and
2999 % \scriptscriptstyle).
3000 %
3001 \def\LaTeX{%
3002 L\kern-.36em
3003 {\setbox0=\hbox{T}%
3004 \vbox to \ht0{\hbox{%
3005 \ifx\textnominalsize\xwordpt
3006 % for 10pt running text, \lllsize (8pt) is too small for the A in LaTeX.
3007 % Revert to plain's \scriptsize, which is 7pt.
3008 \count255=\the\fam $\fam\count255 \scriptstyle A$%
3009 \else
3010 % For 11pt, we can use our lllsize.
3011 \selectfonts\lllsize A%
3012 \fi
3013 }%
3014 \vss
3015 }}%
3016 \kern-.15em
3017 \TeX
3018 }
3019
3020 % Some math mode symbols.
3021 \def\bullet{$\ptexbullet$}
3022 \def\geq{\ifmmode \ge\else $\ge$\fi}
3023 \def\leq{\ifmmode \le\else $\le$\fi}
3024 \def\minus{\ifmmode -\else $-$\fi}
3025
3026 % @dots{} outputs an ellipsis using the current font.
3027 % We do .5em per period so that it has the same spacing in the cm
3028 % typewriter fonts as three actual period characters; on the other hand,
3029 % in other typewriter fonts three periods are wider than 1.5em. So do
3030 % whichever is larger.
3031 %
3032 \def\dots{%
3033 \leavevmode
3034 \setbox0=\hbox{...}% get width of three periods
3035 \ifdim\wd0 > 1.5em
3036 \dimen0 = \wd0
3037 \else
3038 \dimen0 = 1.5em
3039 \fi
3040 \hbox to \dimen0{%
3041 \hskip 0pt plus.25fil
3042 .\hskip 0pt plus1fil
3043 .\hskip 0pt plus1fil
3044 .\hskip 0pt plus.5fil
3045 }%
3046 }
3047
3048 % @enddots{} is an end-of-sentence ellipsis.
3049 %
3050 \def\enddots{%
3051 \dots
3052 \spacefactor=\endofsentencespacefactor
3053 }
3054
3055 % @point{}, @result{}, @expansion{}, @print{}, @equiv{}.
3056 %
3057 % Since these characters are used in examples, they should be an even number of
3058 % \tt widths. Each \tt character is 1en, so two makes it 1em.
3059 %
3060 \def\point{$\star$}
3061 \def\arrow{\leavevmode\raise.05ex\hbox to 1em{\hfil$\rightarrow$\hfil}}
3062 \def\result{\leavevmode\raise.05ex\hbox to 1em{\hfil$\Rightarrow$\hfil}}
3063 \def\expansion{\leavevmode\hbox to 1em{\hfil$\mapsto$\hfil}}
3064 \def\print{\leavevmode\lower.1ex\hbox to 1em{\hfil$\dashv$\hfil}}
3065 \def\equiv{\leavevmode\hbox to 1em{\hfil$\ptexequiv$\hfil}}
3066
3067 % The @error{} command.
3068 % Adapted from the TeXbook's \boxit.
3069 %
3070 \newbox\errorbox
3071 %
3072 {\tentt \global\dimen0 = 3em}% Width of the box.
3073 \dimen2 = .55pt % Thickness of rules
3074 % The text. (`r' is open on the right, `e' somewhat less so on the left.)
3075 \setbox0 = \hbox{\kern-.75pt \reducedsf \putworderror\kern-1.5pt}
3076 %
3077 \setbox\errorbox=\hbox to \dimen0{\hfil
3078 \hsize = \dimen0 \advance\hsize by -5.8pt % Space to left+right.
3079 \advance\hsize by -2\dimen2 % Rules.
3080 \vbox{%
3081 \hrule height\dimen2
3082 \hbox{\vrule width\dimen2 \kern3pt % Space to left of text.
3083 \vtop{\kern2.4pt \box0 \kern2.4pt}% Space above/below.
3084 \kern3pt\vrule width\dimen2}% Space to right.
3085 \hrule height\dimen2}
3086 \hfil}
3087 %
3088 \def\error{\leavevmode\lower.7ex\copy\errorbox}
3089
3090 % @pounds{} is a sterling sign, which Knuth put in the CM italic font.
3091 %
3092 \def\pounds{{\it\$}}
3093
3094 % @euro{} comes from a separate font, depending on the current style.
3095 % We use the free feym* fonts from the eurosym package by Henrik
3096 % Theiling, which support regular, slanted, bold and bold slanted (and
3097 % "outlined" (blackboard board, sort of) versions, which we don't need).
3098 % It is available from http://www.ctan.org/tex-archive/fonts/eurosym.
3099 %
3100 % Although only regular is the truly official Euro symbol, we ignore
3101 % that. The Euro is designed to be slightly taller than the regular
3102 % font height.
3103 %
3104 % feymr - regular
3105 % feymo - slanted
3106 % feybr - bold
3107 % feybo - bold slanted
3108 %
3109 % There is no good (free) typewriter version, to my knowledge.
3110 % A feymr10 euro is ~7.3pt wide, while a normal cmtt10 char is ~5.25pt wide.
3111 % Hmm.
3112 %
3113 % Also doesn't work in math. Do we need to do math with euro symbols?
3114 % Hope not.
3115 %
3116 %
3117 \def\euro{{\eurofont e}}
3118 \def\eurofont{%
3119 % We set the font at each command, rather than predefining it in
3120 % \textfonts and the other font-switching commands, so that
3121 % installations which never need the symbol don't have to have the
3122 % font installed.
3123 %
3124 % There is only one designed size (nominal 10pt), so we always scale
3125 % that to the current nominal size.
3126 %
3127 % By the way, simply using "at 1em" works for cmr10 and the like, but
3128 % does not work for cmbx10 and other extended/shrunken fonts.
3129 %
3130 \def\eurosize{\csname\curfontsize nominalsize\endcsname}%
3131 %
3132 \ifx\curfontstyle\bfstylename
3133 % bold:
3134 \font\thiseurofont = \ifusingit{feybo10}{feybr10} at \eurosize
3135 \else
3136 % regular:
3137 \font\thiseurofont = \ifusingit{feymo10}{feymr10} at \eurosize
3138 \fi
3139 \thiseurofont
3140 }
3141
3142 % Glyphs from the EC fonts. We don't use \let for the aliases, because
3143 % sometimes we redefine the original macro, and the alias should reflect
3144 % the redefinition.
3145 %
3146 % Use LaTeX names for the Icelandic letters.
3147 \def\DH{{\ecfont \char"D0}} % Eth
3148 \def\dh{{\ecfont \char"F0}} % eth
3149 \def\TH{{\ecfont \char"DE}} % Thorn
3150 \def\th{{\ecfont \char"FE}} % thorn
3151 %
3152 \def\guillemetleft{{\ecfont \char"13}}
3153 \def\guillemotleft{\guillemetleft}
3154 \def\guillemetright{{\ecfont \char"14}}
3155 \def\guillemotright{\guillemetright}
3156 \def\guilsinglleft{{\ecfont \char"0E}}
3157 \def\guilsinglright{{\ecfont \char"0F}}
3158 \def\quotedblbase{{\ecfont \char"12}}
3159 \def\quotesinglbase{{\ecfont \char"0D}}
3160 %
3161 % This positioning is not perfect (see the ogonek LaTeX package), but
3162 % we have the precomposed glyphs for the most common cases. We put the
3163 % tests to use those glyphs in the single \ogonek macro so we have fewer
3164 % dummy definitions to worry about for index entries, etc.
3165 %
3166 % ogonek is also used with other letters in Lithuanian (IOU), but using
3167 % the precomposed glyphs for those is not so easy since they aren't in
3168 % the same EC font.
3169 \def\ogonek#1{{%
3170 \def\temp{#1}%
3171 \ifx\temp\macrocharA\Aogonek
3172 \else\ifx\temp\macrochara\aogonek
3173 \else\ifx\temp\macrocharE\Eogonek
3174 \else\ifx\temp\macrochare\eogonek
3175 \else
3176 \ecfont \setbox0=\hbox{#1}%
3177 \ifdim\ht0=1ex\accent"0C #1%
3178 \else\ooalign{\unhbox0\crcr\hidewidth\char"0C \hidewidth}%
3179 \fi
3180 \fi\fi\fi\fi
3181 }%
3182 }
3183 \def\Aogonek{{\ecfont \char"81}}\def\macrocharA{A}
3184 \def\aogonek{{\ecfont \char"A1}}\def\macrochara{a}
3185 \def\Eogonek{{\ecfont \char"86}}\def\macrocharE{E}
3186 \def\eogonek{{\ecfont \char"A6}}\def\macrochare{e}
3187 %
3188 % Use the ec* fonts (cm-super in outline format) for non-CM glyphs.
3189 \def\ecfont{%
3190 % We can't distinguish serif/sans and italic/slanted, but this
3191 % is used for crude hacks anyway (like adding French and German
3192 % quotes to documents typeset with CM, where we lose kerning), so
3193 % hopefully nobody will notice/care.
3194 \edef\ecsize{\csname\curfontsize ecsize\endcsname}%
3195 \edef\nominalsize{\csname\curfontsize nominalsize\endcsname}%
3196 \ifmonospace
3197 % typewriter:
3198 \font\thisecfont = ectt\ecsize \space at \nominalsize
3199 \else
3200 \ifx\curfontstyle\bfstylename
3201 % bold:
3202 \font\thisecfont = ecb\ifusingit{i}{x}\ecsize \space at \nominalsize
3203 \else
3204 % regular:
3205 \font\thisecfont = ec\ifusingit{ti}{rm}\ecsize \space at \nominalsize
3206 \fi
3207 \fi
3208 \thisecfont
3209 }
3210
3211 % @registeredsymbol - R in a circle. The font for the R should really
3212 % be smaller yet, but lllsize is the best we can do for now.
3213 % Adapted from the plain.tex definition of \copyright.
3214 %
3215 \def\registeredsymbol{%
3216 $^{{\ooalign{\hfil\raise.07ex\hbox{\selectfonts\lllsize R}%
3217 \hfil\crcr\Orb}}%
3218 }$%
3219 }
3220
3221 % @textdegree - the normal degrees sign.
3222 %
3223 \def\textdegree{$^\circ$}
3224
3225 % Laurent Siebenmann reports \Orb undefined with:
3226 % Textures 1.7.7 (preloaded format=plain 93.10.14) (68K) 16 APR 2004 02:38
3227 % so we'll define it if necessary.
3228 %
3229 \ifx\Orb\thisisundefined
3230 \def\Orb{\mathhexbox20D}
3231 \fi
3232
3233 % Quotes.
3234 \chardef\quotedblleft="5C
3235 \chardef\quotedblright=`\"
3236 \chardef\quoteleft=`\`
3237 \chardef\quoteright=`\'
3238
3239
3240 \message{page headings,}
3241
3242 \newskip\titlepagetopglue \titlepagetopglue = 1.5in
3243 \newskip\titlepagebottomglue \titlepagebottomglue = 2pc
3244
3245 % First the title page. Must do @settitle before @titlepage.
3246 \newif\ifseenauthor
3247 \newif\iffinishedtitlepage
3248
3249 % Do an implicit @contents or @shortcontents after @end titlepage if the
3250 % user says @setcontentsaftertitlepage or @setshortcontentsaftertitlepage.
3251 %
3252 \newif\ifsetcontentsaftertitlepage
3253 \let\setcontentsaftertitlepage = \setcontentsaftertitlepagetrue
3254 \newif\ifsetshortcontentsaftertitlepage
3255 \let\setshortcontentsaftertitlepage = \setshortcontentsaftertitlepagetrue
3256
3257 \parseargdef\shorttitlepage{%
3258 \begingroup \hbox{}\vskip 1.5in \chaprm \centerline{#1}%
3259 \endgroup\page\hbox{}\page}
3260
3261 \envdef\titlepage{%
3262 % Open one extra group, as we want to close it in the middle of \Etitlepage.
3263 \begingroup
3264 \parindent=0pt \textfonts
3265 % Leave some space at the very top of the page.
3266 \vglue\titlepagetopglue
3267 % No rule at page bottom unless we print one at the top with @title.
3268 \finishedtitlepagetrue
3269 %
3270 % Most title ``pages'' are actually two pages long, with space
3271 % at the top of the second. We don't want the ragged left on the second.
3272 \let\oldpage = \page
3273 \def\page{%
3274 \iffinishedtitlepage\else
3275 \finishtitlepage
3276 \fi
3277 \let\page = \oldpage
3278 \page
3279 \null
3280 }%
3281 }
3282
3283 \def\Etitlepage{%
3284 \iffinishedtitlepage\else
3285 \finishtitlepage
3286 \fi
3287 % It is important to do the page break before ending the group,
3288 % because the headline and footline are only empty inside the group.
3289 % If we use the new definition of \page, we always get a blank page
3290 % after the title page, which we certainly don't want.
3291 \oldpage
3292 \endgroup
3293 %
3294 % Need this before the \...aftertitlepage checks so that if they are
3295 % in effect the toc pages will come out with page numbers.
3296 \HEADINGSon
3297 %
3298 % If they want short, they certainly want long too.
3299 \ifsetshortcontentsaftertitlepage
3300 \shortcontents
3301 \contents
3302 \global\let\shortcontents = \relax
3303 \global\let\contents = \relax
3304 \fi
3305 %
3306 \ifsetcontentsaftertitlepage
3307 \contents
3308 \global\let\contents = \relax
3309 \global\let\shortcontents = \relax
3310 \fi
3311 }
3312
3313 \def\finishtitlepage{%
3314 \vskip4pt \hrule height 2pt width \hsize
3315 \vskip\titlepagebottomglue
3316 \finishedtitlepagetrue
3317 }
3318
3319 % Settings used for typesetting titles: no hyphenation, no indentation,
3320 % don't worry much about spacing, ragged right. This should be used
3321 % inside a \vbox, and fonts need to be set appropriately first. Because
3322 % it is always used for titles, nothing else, we call \rmisbold. \par
3323 % should be specified before the end of the \vbox, since a vbox is a group.
3324 %
3325 \def\raggedtitlesettings{%
3326 \rmisbold
3327 \hyphenpenalty=10000
3328 \parindent=0pt
3329 \tolerance=5000
3330 \ptexraggedright
3331 }
3332
3333 % Macros to be used within @titlepage:
3334
3335 \let\subtitlerm=\tenrm
3336 \def\subtitlefont{\subtitlerm \normalbaselineskip = 13pt \normalbaselines}
3337
3338 \parseargdef\title{%
3339 \checkenv\titlepage
3340 \vbox{\titlefonts \raggedtitlesettings #1\par}%
3341 % print a rule at the page bottom also.
3342 \finishedtitlepagefalse
3343 \vskip4pt \hrule height 4pt width \hsize \vskip4pt
3344 }
3345
3346 \parseargdef\subtitle{%
3347 \checkenv\titlepage
3348 {\subtitlefont \rightline{#1}}%
3349 }
3350
3351 % @author should come last, but may come many times.
3352 % It can also be used inside @quotation.
3353 %
3354 \parseargdef\author{%
3355 \def\temp{\quotation}%
3356 \ifx\thisenv\temp
3357 \def\quotationauthor{#1}% printed in \Equotation.
3358 \else
3359 \checkenv\titlepage
3360 \ifseenauthor\else \vskip 0pt plus 1filll \seenauthortrue \fi
3361 {\secfonts\rmisbold \leftline{#1}}%
3362 \fi
3363 }
3364
3365
3366 % Set up page headings and footings.
3367
3368 \let\thispage=\folio
3369
3370 \newtoks\evenheadline % headline on even pages
3371 \newtoks\oddheadline % headline on odd pages
3372 \newtoks\evenfootline % footline on even pages
3373 \newtoks\oddfootline % footline on odd pages
3374
3375 % Now make TeX use those variables
3376 \headline={{\textfonts\rm \ifodd\pageno \the\oddheadline
3377 \else \the\evenheadline \fi}}
3378 \footline={{\textfonts\rm \ifodd\pageno \the\oddfootline
3379 \else \the\evenfootline \fi}\HEADINGShook}
3380 \let\HEADINGShook=\relax
3381
3382 % Commands to set those variables.
3383 % For example, this is what @headings on does
3384 % @evenheading @thistitle|@thispage|@thischapter
3385 % @oddheading @thischapter|@thispage|@thistitle
3386 % @evenfooting @thisfile||
3387 % @oddfooting ||@thisfile
3388
3389
3390 \def\evenheading{\parsearg\evenheadingxxx}
3391 \def\evenheadingxxx #1{\evenheadingyyy #1\|\|\|\|\finish}
3392 \def\evenheadingyyy #1\|#2\|#3\|#4\finish{%
3393 \global\evenheadline={\rlap{\centerline{#2}}\line{#1\hfil#3}}}
3394
3395 \def\oddheading{\parsearg\oddheadingxxx}
3396 \def\oddheadingxxx #1{\oddheadingyyy #1\|\|\|\|\finish}
3397 \def\oddheadingyyy #1\|#2\|#3\|#4\finish{%
3398 \global\oddheadline={\rlap{\centerline{#2}}\line{#1\hfil#3}}}
3399
3400 \parseargdef\everyheading{\oddheadingxxx{#1}\evenheadingxxx{#1}}%
3401
3402 \def\evenfooting{\parsearg\evenfootingxxx}
3403 \def\evenfootingxxx #1{\evenfootingyyy #1\|\|\|\|\finish}
3404 \def\evenfootingyyy #1\|#2\|#3\|#4\finish{%
3405 \global\evenfootline={\rlap{\centerline{#2}}\line{#1\hfil#3}}}
3406
3407 \def\oddfooting{\parsearg\oddfootingxxx}
3408 \def\oddfootingxxx #1{\oddfootingyyy #1\|\|\|\|\finish}
3409 \def\oddfootingyyy #1\|#2\|#3\|#4\finish{%
3410 \global\oddfootline = {\rlap{\centerline{#2}}\line{#1\hfil#3}}%
3411 %
3412 % Leave some space for the footline. Hopefully ok to assume
3413 % @evenfooting will not be used by itself.
3414 \global\advance\pageheight by -12pt
3415 \global\advance\vsize by -12pt
3416 }
3417
3418 \parseargdef\everyfooting{\oddfootingxxx{#1}\evenfootingxxx{#1}}
3419
3420 % @evenheadingmarks top \thischapter <- chapter at the top of a page
3421 % @evenheadingmarks bottom \thischapter <- chapter at the bottom of a page
3422 %
3423 % The same set of arguments for:
3424 %
3425 % @oddheadingmarks
3426 % @evenfootingmarks
3427 % @oddfootingmarks
3428 % @everyheadingmarks
3429 % @everyfootingmarks
3430
3431 \def\evenheadingmarks{\headingmarks{even}{heading}}
3432 \def\oddheadingmarks{\headingmarks{odd}{heading}}
3433 \def\evenfootingmarks{\headingmarks{even}{footing}}
3434 \def\oddfootingmarks{\headingmarks{odd}{footing}}
3435 \def\everyheadingmarks#1 {\headingmarks{even}{heading}{#1}
3436 \headingmarks{odd}{heading}{#1} }
3437 \def\everyfootingmarks#1 {\headingmarks{even}{footing}{#1}
3438 \headingmarks{odd}{footing}{#1} }
3439 % #1 = even/odd, #2 = heading/footing, #3 = top/bottom.
3440 \def\headingmarks#1#2#3 {%
3441 \expandafter\let\expandafter\temp \csname get#3headingmarks\endcsname
3442 \global\expandafter\let\csname get#1#2marks\endcsname \temp
3443 }
3444
3445 \everyheadingmarks bottom
3446 \everyfootingmarks bottom
3447
3448 % @headings double turns headings on for double-sided printing.
3449 % @headings single turns headings on for single-sided printing.
3450 % @headings off turns them off.
3451 % @headings on same as @headings double, retained for compatibility.
3452 % @headings after turns on double-sided headings after this page.
3453 % @headings doubleafter turns on double-sided headings after this page.
3454 % @headings singleafter turns on single-sided headings after this page.
3455 % By default, they are off at the start of a document,
3456 % and turned `on' after @end titlepage.
3457
3458 \def\headings #1 {\csname HEADINGS#1\endcsname}
3459
3460 \def\headingsoff{% non-global headings elimination
3461 \evenheadline={\hfil}\evenfootline={\hfil}%
3462 \oddheadline={\hfil}\oddfootline={\hfil}%
3463 }
3464
3465 \def\HEADINGSoff{{\globaldefs=1 \headingsoff}} % global setting
3466 \HEADINGSoff % it's the default
3467
3468 % When we turn headings on, set the page number to 1.
3469 % For double-sided printing, put current file name in lower left corner,
3470 % chapter name on inside top of right hand pages, document
3471 % title on inside top of left hand pages, and page numbers on outside top
3472 % edge of all pages.
3473 \def\HEADINGSdouble{%
3474 \global\pageno=1
3475 \global\evenfootline={\hfil}
3476 \global\oddfootline={\hfil}
3477 \global\evenheadline={\line{\folio\hfil\thistitle}}
3478 \global\oddheadline={\line{\thischapter\hfil\folio}}
3479 \global\let\contentsalignmacro = \chapoddpage
3480 }
3481 \let\contentsalignmacro = \chappager
3482
3483 % For single-sided printing, chapter title goes across top left of page,
3484 % page number on top right.
3485 \def\HEADINGSsingle{%
3486 \global\pageno=1
3487 \global\evenfootline={\hfil}
3488 \global\oddfootline={\hfil}
3489 \global\evenheadline={\line{\thischapter\hfil\folio}}
3490 \global\oddheadline={\line{\thischapter\hfil\folio}}
3491 \global\let\contentsalignmacro = \chappager
3492 }
3493 \def\HEADINGSon{\HEADINGSdouble}
3494
3495 \def\HEADINGSafter{\let\HEADINGShook=\HEADINGSdoublex}
3496 \let\HEADINGSdoubleafter=\HEADINGSafter
3497 \def\HEADINGSdoublex{%
3498 \global\evenfootline={\hfil}
3499 \global\oddfootline={\hfil}
3500 \global\evenheadline={\line{\folio\hfil\thistitle}}
3501 \global\oddheadline={\line{\thischapter\hfil\folio}}
3502 \global\let\contentsalignmacro = \chapoddpage
3503 }
3504
3505 \def\HEADINGSsingleafter{\let\HEADINGShook=\HEADINGSsinglex}
3506 \def\HEADINGSsinglex{%
3507 \global\evenfootline={\hfil}
3508 \global\oddfootline={\hfil}
3509 \global\evenheadline={\line{\thischapter\hfil\folio}}
3510 \global\oddheadline={\line{\thischapter\hfil\folio}}
3511 \global\let\contentsalignmacro = \chappager
3512 }
3513
3514 % Subroutines used in generating headings
3515 % This produces Day Month Year style of output.
3516 % Only define if not already defined, in case a txi-??.tex file has set
3517 % up a different format (e.g., txi-cs.tex does this).
3518 \ifx\today\thisisundefined
3519 \def\today{%
3520 \number\day\space
3521 \ifcase\month
3522 \or\putwordMJan\or\putwordMFeb\or\putwordMMar\or\putwordMApr
3523 \or\putwordMMay\or\putwordMJun\or\putwordMJul\or\putwordMAug
3524 \or\putwordMSep\or\putwordMOct\or\putwordMNov\or\putwordMDec
3525 \fi
3526 \space\number\year}
3527 \fi
3528
3529 % @settitle line... specifies the title of the document, for headings.
3530 % It generates no output of its own.
3531 \def\thistitle{\putwordNoTitle}
3532 \def\settitle{\parsearg{\gdef\thistitle}}
3533
3534
3535 \message{tables,}
3536 % Tables -- @table, @ftable, @vtable, @item(x).
3537
3538 % default indentation of table text
3539 \newdimen\tableindent \tableindent=.8in
3540 % default indentation of @itemize and @enumerate text
3541 \newdimen\itemindent \itemindent=.3in
3542 % margin between end of table item and start of table text.
3543 \newdimen\itemmargin \itemmargin=.1in
3544
3545 % used internally for \itemindent minus \itemmargin
3546 \newdimen\itemmax
3547
3548 % Note @table, @ftable, and @vtable define @item, @itemx, etc., with
3549 % these defs.
3550 % They also define \itemindex
3551 % to index the item name in whatever manner is desired (perhaps none).
3552
3553 \newif\ifitemxneedsnegativevskip
3554
3555 \def\itemxpar{\par\ifitemxneedsnegativevskip\nobreak\vskip-\parskip\nobreak\fi}
3556
3557 \def\internalBitem{\smallbreak \parsearg\itemzzz}
3558 \def\internalBitemx{\itemxpar \parsearg\itemzzz}
3559
3560 \def\itemzzz #1{\begingroup %
3561 \advance\hsize by -\rightskip
3562 \advance\hsize by -\tableindent
3563 \setbox0=\hbox{\itemindicate{#1}}%
3564 \itemindex{#1}%
3565 \nobreak % This prevents a break before @itemx.
3566 %
3567 % If the item text does not fit in the space we have, put it on a line
3568 % by itself, and do not allow a page break either before or after that
3569 % line. We do not start a paragraph here because then if the next
3570 % command is, e.g., @kindex, the whatsit would get put into the
3571 % horizontal list on a line by itself, resulting in extra blank space.
3572 \ifdim \wd0>\itemmax
3573 %
3574 % Make this a paragraph so we get the \parskip glue and wrapping,
3575 % but leave it ragged-right.
3576 \begingroup
3577 \advance\leftskip by-\tableindent
3578 \advance\hsize by\tableindent
3579 \advance\rightskip by0pt plus1fil\relax
3580 \leavevmode\unhbox0\par
3581 \endgroup
3582 %
3583 % We're going to be starting a paragraph, but we don't want the
3584 % \parskip glue -- logically it's part of the @item we just started.
3585 \nobreak \vskip-\parskip
3586 %
3587 % Stop a page break at the \parskip glue coming up. However, if
3588 % what follows is an environment such as @example, there will be no
3589 % \parskip glue; then the negative vskip we just inserted would
3590 % cause the example and the item to crash together. So we use this
3591 % bizarre value of 10001 as a signal to \aboveenvbreak to insert
3592 % \parskip glue after all. Section titles are handled this way also.
3593 %
3594 \penalty 10001
3595 \endgroup
3596 \itemxneedsnegativevskipfalse
3597 \else
3598 % The item text fits into the space. Start a paragraph, so that the
3599 % following text (if any) will end up on the same line.
3600 \noindent
3601 % Do this with kerns and \unhbox so that if there is a footnote in
3602 % the item text, it can migrate to the main vertical list and
3603 % eventually be printed.
3604 \nobreak\kern-\tableindent
3605 \dimen0 = \itemmax \advance\dimen0 by \itemmargin \advance\dimen0 by -\wd0
3606 \unhbox0
3607 \nobreak\kern\dimen0
3608 \endgroup
3609 \itemxneedsnegativevskiptrue
3610 \fi
3611 }
3612
3613 \def\item{\errmessage{@item while not in a list environment}}
3614 \def\itemx{\errmessage{@itemx while not in a list environment}}
3615
3616 % @table, @ftable, @vtable.
3617 \envdef\table{%
3618 \let\itemindex\gobble
3619 \tablecheck{table}%
3620 }
3621 \envdef\ftable{%
3622 \def\itemindex ##1{\doind {fn}{\code{##1}}}%
3623 \tablecheck{ftable}%
3624 }
3625 \envdef\vtable{%
3626 \def\itemindex ##1{\doind {vr}{\code{##1}}}%
3627 \tablecheck{vtable}%
3628 }
3629 \def\tablecheck#1{%
3630 \ifnum \the\catcode`\^^M=\active
3631 \endgroup
3632 \errmessage{This command won't work in this context; perhaps the problem is
3633 that we are \inenvironment\thisenv}%
3634 \def\next{\doignore{#1}}%
3635 \else
3636 \let\next\tablex
3637 \fi
3638 \next
3639 }
3640 \def\tablex#1{%
3641 \def\itemindicate{#1}%
3642 \parsearg\tabley
3643 }
3644 \def\tabley#1{%
3645 {%
3646 \makevalueexpandable
3647 \edef\temp{\noexpand\tablez #1\space\space\space}%
3648 \expandafter
3649 }\temp \endtablez
3650 }
3651 \def\tablez #1 #2 #3 #4\endtablez{%
3652 \aboveenvbreak
3653 \ifnum 0#1>0 \advance \leftskip by #1\mil \fi
3654 \ifnum 0#2>0 \tableindent=#2\mil \fi
3655 \ifnum 0#3>0 \advance \rightskip by #3\mil \fi
3656 \itemmax=\tableindent
3657 \advance \itemmax by -\itemmargin
3658 \advance \leftskip by \tableindent
3659 \exdentamount=\tableindent
3660 \parindent = 0pt
3661 \parskip = \smallskipamount
3662 \ifdim \parskip=0pt \parskip=2pt \fi
3663 \let\item = \internalBitem
3664 \let\itemx = \internalBitemx
3665 }
3666 \def\Etable{\endgraf\afterenvbreak}
3667 \let\Eftable\Etable
3668 \let\Evtable\Etable
3669 \let\Eitemize\Etable
3670 \let\Eenumerate\Etable
3671
3672 % This is the counter used by @enumerate, which is really @itemize
3673
3674 \newcount \itemno
3675
3676 \envdef\itemize{\parsearg\doitemize}
3677
3678 \def\doitemize#1{%
3679 \aboveenvbreak
3680 \itemmax=\itemindent
3681 \advance\itemmax by -\itemmargin
3682 \advance\leftskip by \itemindent
3683 \exdentamount=\itemindent
3684 \parindent=0pt
3685 \parskip=\smallskipamount
3686 \ifdim\parskip=0pt \parskip=2pt \fi
3687 %
3688 % Try typesetting the item mark so that if the document erroneously says
3689 % something like @itemize @samp (intending @table), there's an error
3690 % right away at the @itemize. It's not the best error message in the
3691 % world, but it's better than leaving it to the @item. This means if
3692 % the user wants an empty mark, they have to say @w{} not just @w.
3693 \def\itemcontents{#1}%
3694 \setbox0 = \hbox{\itemcontents}%
3695 %
3696 % @itemize with no arg is equivalent to @itemize @bullet.
3697 \ifx\itemcontents\empty\def\itemcontents{\bullet}\fi
3698 %
3699 \let\item=\itemizeitem
3700 }
3701
3702 % Definition of @item while inside @itemize and @enumerate.
3703 %
3704 \def\itemizeitem{%
3705 \advance\itemno by 1 % for enumerations
3706 {\let\par=\endgraf \smallbreak}% reasonable place to break
3707 {%
3708 % If the document has an @itemize directly after a section title, a
3709 % \nobreak will be last on the list, and \sectionheading will have
3710 % done a \vskip-\parskip. In that case, we don't want to zero
3711 % parskip, or the item text will crash with the heading. On the
3712 % other hand, when there is normal text preceding the item (as there
3713 % usually is), we do want to zero parskip, or there would be too much
3714 % space. In that case, we won't have a \nobreak before. At least
3715 % that's the theory.
3716 \ifnum\lastpenalty<10000 \parskip=0in \fi
3717 \noindent
3718 \hbox to 0pt{\hss \itemcontents \kern\itemmargin}%
3719 %
3720 \vadjust{\penalty 1200}}% not good to break after first line of item.
3721 \flushcr
3722 }
3723
3724 % \splitoff TOKENS\endmark defines \first to be the first token in
3725 % TOKENS, and \rest to be the remainder.
3726 %
3727 \def\splitoff#1#2\endmark{\def\first{#1}\def\rest{#2}}%
3728
3729 % Allow an optional argument of an uppercase letter, lowercase letter,
3730 % or number, to specify the first label in the enumerated list. No
3731 % argument is the same as `1'.
3732 %
3733 \envparseargdef\enumerate{\enumeratey #1 \endenumeratey}
3734 \def\enumeratey #1 #2\endenumeratey{%
3735 % If we were given no argument, pretend we were given `1'.
3736 \def\thearg{#1}%
3737 \ifx\thearg\empty \def\thearg{1}\fi
3738 %
3739 % Detect if the argument is a single token. If so, it might be a
3740 % letter. Otherwise, the only valid thing it can be is a number.
3741 % (We will always have one token, because of the test we just made.
3742 % This is a good thing, since \splitoff doesn't work given nothing at
3743 % all -- the first parameter is undelimited.)
3744 \expandafter\splitoff\thearg\endmark
3745 \ifx\rest\empty
3746 % Only one token in the argument. It could still be anything.
3747 % A ``lowercase letter'' is one whose \lccode is nonzero.
3748 % An ``uppercase letter'' is one whose \lccode is both nonzero, and
3749 % not equal to itself.
3750 % Otherwise, we assume it's a number.
3751 %
3752 % We need the \relax at the end of the \ifnum lines to stop TeX from
3753 % continuing to look for a <number>.
3754 %
3755 \ifnum\lccode\expandafter`\thearg=0\relax
3756 \numericenumerate % a number (we hope)
3757 \else
3758 % It's a letter.
3759 \ifnum\lccode\expandafter`\thearg=\expandafter`\thearg\relax
3760 \lowercaseenumerate % lowercase letter
3761 \else
3762 \uppercaseenumerate % uppercase letter
3763 \fi
3764 \fi
3765 \else
3766 % Multiple tokens in the argument. We hope it's a number.
3767 \numericenumerate
3768 \fi
3769 }
3770
3771 % An @enumerate whose labels are integers. The starting integer is
3772 % given in \thearg.
3773 %
3774 \def\numericenumerate{%
3775 \itemno = \thearg
3776 \startenumeration{\the\itemno}%
3777 }
3778
3779 % The starting (lowercase) letter is in \thearg.
3780 \def\lowercaseenumerate{%
3781 \itemno = \expandafter`\thearg
3782 \startenumeration{%
3783 % Be sure we're not beyond the end of the alphabet.
3784 \ifnum\itemno=0
3785 \errmessage{No more lowercase letters in @enumerate; get a bigger
3786 alphabet}%
3787 \fi
3788 \char\lccode\itemno
3789 }%
3790 }
3791
3792 % The starting (uppercase) letter is in \thearg.
3793 \def\uppercaseenumerate{%
3794 \itemno = \expandafter`\thearg
3795 \startenumeration{%
3796 % Be sure we're not beyond the end of the alphabet.
3797 \ifnum\itemno=0
3798 \errmessage{No more uppercase letters in @enumerate; get a bigger
3799 alphabet}
3800 \fi
3801 \char\uccode\itemno
3802 }%
3803 }
3804
3805 % Call \doitemize, adding a period to the first argument and supplying the
3806 % common last two arguments. Also subtract one from the initial value in
3807 % \itemno, since @item increments \itemno.
3808 %
3809 \def\startenumeration#1{%
3810 \advance\itemno by -1
3811 \doitemize{#1.}\flushcr
3812 }
3813
3814 % @alphaenumerate and @capsenumerate are abbreviations for giving an arg
3815 % to @enumerate.
3816 %
3817 \def\alphaenumerate{\enumerate{a}}
3818 \def\capsenumerate{\enumerate{A}}
3819 \def\Ealphaenumerate{\Eenumerate}
3820 \def\Ecapsenumerate{\Eenumerate}
3821
3822
3823 % @multitable macros
3824 % Amy Hendrickson, 8/18/94, 3/6/96
3825 %
3826 % @multitable ... @end multitable will make as many columns as desired.
3827 % Contents of each column will wrap at width given in preamble. Width
3828 % can be specified either with sample text given in a template line,
3829 % or in percent of \hsize, the current width of text on page.
3830
3831 % Table can continue over pages but will only break between lines.
3832
3833 % To make preamble:
3834 %
3835 % Either define widths of columns in terms of percent of \hsize:
3836 % @multitable @columnfractions .25 .3 .45
3837 % @item ...
3838 %
3839 % Numbers following @columnfractions are the percent of the total
3840 % current hsize to be used for each column. You may use as many
3841 % columns as desired.
3842
3843
3844 % Or use a template:
3845 % @multitable {Column 1 template} {Column 2 template} {Column 3 template}
3846 % @item ...
3847 % using the widest term desired in each column.
3848
3849 % Each new table line starts with @item, each subsequent new column
3850 % starts with @tab. Empty columns may be produced by supplying @tab's
3851 % with nothing between them for as many times as empty columns are needed,
3852 % ie, @tab@tab@tab will produce two empty columns.
3853
3854 % @item, @tab do not need to be on their own lines, but it will not hurt
3855 % if they are.
3856
3857 % Sample multitable:
3858
3859 % @multitable {Column 1 template} {Column 2 template} {Column 3 template}
3860 % @item first col stuff @tab second col stuff @tab third col
3861 % @item
3862 % first col stuff
3863 % @tab
3864 % second col stuff
3865 % @tab
3866 % third col
3867 % @item first col stuff @tab second col stuff
3868 % @tab Many paragraphs of text may be used in any column.
3869 %
3870 % They will wrap at the width determined by the template.
3871 % @item@tab@tab This will be in third column.
3872 % @end multitable
3873
3874 % Default dimensions may be reset by user.
3875 % @multitableparskip is vertical space between paragraphs in table.
3876 % @multitableparindent is paragraph indent in table.
3877 % @multitablecolmargin is horizontal space to be left between columns.
3878 % @multitablelinespace is space to leave between table items, baseline
3879 % to baseline.
3880 % 0pt means it depends on current normal line spacing.
3881 %
3882 \newskip\multitableparskip
3883 \newskip\multitableparindent
3884 \newdimen\multitablecolspace
3885 \newskip\multitablelinespace
3886 \multitableparskip=0pt
3887 \multitableparindent=6pt
3888 \multitablecolspace=12pt
3889 \multitablelinespace=0pt
3890
3891 % Macros used to set up halign preamble:
3892 %
3893 \let\endsetuptable\relax
3894 \def\xendsetuptable{\endsetuptable}
3895 \let\columnfractions\relax
3896 \def\xcolumnfractions{\columnfractions}
3897 \newif\ifsetpercent
3898
3899 % #1 is the @columnfraction, usually a decimal number like .5, but might
3900 % be just 1. We just use it, whatever it is.
3901 %
3902 \def\pickupwholefraction#1 {%
3903 \global\advance\colcount by 1
3904 \expandafter\xdef\csname col\the\colcount\endcsname{#1\hsize}%
3905 \setuptable
3906 }
3907
3908 \newcount\colcount
3909 \def\setuptable#1{%
3910 \def\firstarg{#1}%
3911 \ifx\firstarg\xendsetuptable
3912 \let\go = \relax
3913 \else
3914 \ifx\firstarg\xcolumnfractions
3915 \global\setpercenttrue
3916 \else
3917 \ifsetpercent
3918 \let\go\pickupwholefraction
3919 \else
3920 \global\advance\colcount by 1
3921 \setbox0=\hbox{#1\unskip\space}% Add a normal word space as a
3922 % separator; typically that is always in the input, anyway.
3923 \expandafter\xdef\csname col\the\colcount\endcsname{\the\wd0}%
3924 \fi
3925 \fi
3926 \ifx\go\pickupwholefraction
3927 % Put the argument back for the \pickupwholefraction call, so
3928 % we'll always have a period there to be parsed.
3929 \def\go{\pickupwholefraction#1}%
3930 \else
3931 \let\go = \setuptable
3932 \fi%
3933 \fi
3934 \go
3935 }
3936
3937 % multitable-only commands.
3938 %
3939 % @headitem starts a heading row, which we typeset in bold.
3940 % Assignments have to be global since we are inside the implicit group
3941 % of an alignment entry. \everycr resets \everytab so we don't have to
3942 % undo it ourselves.
3943 \def\headitemfont{\b}% for people to use in the template row; not changeable
3944 \def\headitem{%
3945 \checkenv\multitable
3946 \crcr
3947 \global\everytab={\bf}% can't use \headitemfont since the parsing differs
3948 \the\everytab % for the first item
3949 }%
3950 %
3951 % A \tab used to include \hskip1sp. But then the space in a template
3952 % line is not enough. That is bad. So let's go back to just `&' until
3953 % we again encounter the problem the 1sp was intended to solve.
3954 % --karl, nathan@acm.org, 20apr99.
3955 \def\tab{\checkenv\multitable &\the\everytab}%
3956
3957 % @multitable ... @end multitable definitions:
3958 %
3959 \newtoks\everytab % insert after every tab.
3960 %
3961 \envdef\multitable{%
3962 \vskip\parskip
3963 \startsavinginserts
3964 %
3965 % @item within a multitable starts a normal row.
3966 % We use \def instead of \let so that if one of the multitable entries
3967 % contains an @itemize, we don't choke on the \item (seen as \crcr aka
3968 % \endtemplate) expanding \doitemize.
3969 \def\item{\crcr}%
3970 %
3971 \tolerance=9500
3972 \hbadness=9500
3973 \setmultitablespacing
3974 \parskip=\multitableparskip
3975 \parindent=\multitableparindent
3976 \overfullrule=0pt
3977 \global\colcount=0
3978 %
3979 \everycr = {%
3980 \noalign{%
3981 \global\everytab={}%
3982 \global\colcount=0 % Reset the column counter.
3983 % Check for saved footnotes, etc.
3984 \checkinserts
3985 % Keeps underfull box messages off when table breaks over pages.
3986 %\filbreak
3987 % Maybe so, but it also creates really weird page breaks when the
3988 % table breaks over pages. Wouldn't \vfil be better? Wait until the
3989 % problem manifests itself, so it can be fixed for real --karl.
3990 }%
3991 }%
3992 %
3993 \parsearg\domultitable
3994 }
3995 \def\domultitable#1{%
3996 % To parse everything between @multitable and @item:
3997 \setuptable#1 \endsetuptable
3998 %
3999 % This preamble sets up a generic column definition, which will
4000 % be used as many times as user calls for columns.
4001 % \vtop will set a single line and will also let text wrap and
4002 % continue for many paragraphs if desired.
4003 \halign\bgroup &%
4004 \global\advance\colcount by 1
4005 \multistrut
4006 \vtop{%
4007 % Use the current \colcount to find the correct column width:
4008 \hsize=\expandafter\csname col\the\colcount\endcsname
4009 %
4010 % In order to keep entries from bumping into each other
4011 % we will add a \leftskip of \multitablecolspace to all columns after
4012 % the first one.
4013 %
4014 % If a template has been used, we will add \multitablecolspace
4015 % to the width of each template entry.
4016 %
4017 % If the user has set preamble in terms of percent of \hsize we will
4018 % use that dimension as the width of the column, and the \leftskip
4019 % will keep entries from bumping into each other. Table will start at
4020 % left margin and final column will justify at right margin.
4021 %
4022 % Make sure we don't inherit \rightskip from the outer environment.
4023 \rightskip=0pt
4024 \ifnum\colcount=1
4025 % The first column will be indented with the surrounding text.
4026 \advance\hsize by\leftskip
4027 \else
4028 \ifsetpercent \else
4029 % If user has not set preamble in terms of percent of \hsize
4030 % we will advance \hsize by \multitablecolspace.
4031 \advance\hsize by \multitablecolspace
4032 \fi
4033 % In either case we will make \leftskip=\multitablecolspace:
4034 \leftskip=\multitablecolspace
4035 \fi
4036 % Ignoring space at the beginning and end avoids an occasional spurious
4037 % blank line, when TeX decides to break the line at the space before the
4038 % box from the multistrut, so the strut ends up on a line by itself.
4039 % For example:
4040 % @multitable @columnfractions .11 .89
4041 % @item @code{#}
4042 % @tab Legal holiday which is valid in major parts of the whole country.
4043 % Is automatically provided with highlighting sequences respectively
4044 % marking characters.
4045 \noindent\ignorespaces##\unskip\multistrut
4046 }\cr
4047 }
4048 \def\Emultitable{%
4049 \crcr
4050 \egroup % end the \halign
4051 \global\setpercentfalse
4052 }
4053
4054 \def\setmultitablespacing{%
4055 \def\multistrut{\strut}% just use the standard line spacing
4056 %
4057 % Compute \multitablelinespace (if not defined by user) for use in
4058 % \multitableparskip calculation. We used define \multistrut based on
4059 % this, but (ironically) that caused the spacing to be off.
4060 % See bug-texinfo report from Werner Lemberg, 31 Oct 2004 12:52:20 +0100.
4061 \ifdim\multitablelinespace=0pt
4062 \setbox0=\vbox{X}\global\multitablelinespace=\the\baselineskip
4063 \global\advance\multitablelinespace by-\ht0
4064 \fi
4065 % Test to see if parskip is larger than space between lines of
4066 % table. If not, do nothing.
4067 % If so, set to same dimension as multitablelinespace.
4068 \ifdim\multitableparskip>\multitablelinespace
4069 \global\multitableparskip=\multitablelinespace
4070 \global\advance\multitableparskip-7pt % to keep parskip somewhat smaller
4071 % than skip between lines in the table.
4072 \fi%
4073 \ifdim\multitableparskip=0pt
4074 \global\multitableparskip=\multitablelinespace
4075 \global\advance\multitableparskip-7pt % to keep parskip somewhat smaller
4076 % than skip between lines in the table.
4077 \fi}
4078
4079
4080 \message{conditionals,}
4081
4082 % @iftex, @ifnotdocbook, @ifnothtml, @ifnotinfo, @ifnotplaintext,
4083 % @ifnotxml always succeed. They currently do nothing; we don't
4084 % attempt to check whether the conditionals are properly nested. But we
4085 % have to remember that they are conditionals, so that @end doesn't
4086 % attempt to close an environment group.
4087 %
4088 \def\makecond#1{%
4089 \expandafter\let\csname #1\endcsname = \relax
4090 \expandafter\let\csname iscond.#1\endcsname = 1
4091 }
4092 \makecond{iftex}
4093 \makecond{ifnotdocbook}
4094 \makecond{ifnothtml}
4095 \makecond{ifnotinfo}
4096 \makecond{ifnotplaintext}
4097 \makecond{ifnotxml}
4098
4099 % Ignore @ignore, @ifhtml, @ifinfo, and the like.
4100 %
4101 \def\direntry{\doignore{direntry}}
4102 \def\documentdescription{\doignore{documentdescription}}
4103 \def\docbook{\doignore{docbook}}
4104 \def\html{\doignore{html}}
4105 \def\ifdocbook{\doignore{ifdocbook}}
4106 \def\ifhtml{\doignore{ifhtml}}
4107 \def\ifinfo{\doignore{ifinfo}}
4108 \def\ifnottex{\doignore{ifnottex}}
4109 \def\ifplaintext{\doignore{ifplaintext}}
4110 \def\ifxml{\doignore{ifxml}}
4111 \def\ignore{\doignore{ignore}}
4112 \def\menu{\doignore{menu}}
4113 \def\xml{\doignore{xml}}
4114
4115 % Ignore text until a line `@end #1', keeping track of nested conditionals.
4116 %
4117 % A count to remember the depth of nesting.
4118 \newcount\doignorecount
4119
4120 \def\doignore#1{\begingroup
4121 % Scan in ``verbatim'' mode:
4122 \obeylines
4123 \catcode`\@ = \other
4124 \catcode`\{ = \other
4125 \catcode`\} = \other
4126 %
4127 % Make sure that spaces turn into tokens that match what \doignoretext wants.
4128 \spaceisspace
4129 %
4130 % Count number of #1's that we've seen.
4131 \doignorecount = 0
4132 %
4133 % Swallow text until we reach the matching `@end #1'.
4134 \dodoignore{#1}%
4135 }
4136
4137 { \catcode`_=11 % We want to use \_STOP_ which cannot appear in texinfo source.
4138 \obeylines %
4139 %
4140 \gdef\dodoignore#1{%
4141 % #1 contains the command name as a string, e.g., `ifinfo'.
4142 %
4143 % Define a command to find the next `@end #1'.
4144 \long\def\doignoretext##1^^M@end #1{%
4145 \doignoretextyyy##1^^M@#1\_STOP_}%
4146 %
4147 % And this command to find another #1 command, at the beginning of a
4148 % line. (Otherwise, we would consider a line `@c @ifset', for
4149 % example, to count as an @ifset for nesting.)
4150 \long\def\doignoretextyyy##1^^M@#1##2\_STOP_{\doignoreyyy{##2}\_STOP_}%
4151 %
4152 % And now expand that command.
4153 \doignoretext ^^M%
4154 }%
4155 }
4156
4157 \def\doignoreyyy#1{%
4158 \def\temp{#1}%
4159 \ifx\temp\empty % Nothing found.
4160 \let\next\doignoretextzzz
4161 \else % Found a nested condition, ...
4162 \advance\doignorecount by 1
4163 \let\next\doignoretextyyy % ..., look for another.
4164 % If we're here, #1 ends with ^^M\ifinfo (for example).
4165 \fi
4166 \next #1% the token \_STOP_ is present just after this macro.
4167 }
4168
4169 % We have to swallow the remaining "\_STOP_".
4170 %
4171 \def\doignoretextzzz#1{%
4172 \ifnum\doignorecount = 0 % We have just found the outermost @end.
4173 \let\next\enddoignore
4174 \else % Still inside a nested condition.
4175 \advance\doignorecount by -1
4176 \let\next\doignoretext % Look for the next @end.
4177 \fi
4178 \next
4179 }
4180
4181 % Finish off ignored text.
4182 { \obeylines%
4183 % Ignore anything after the last `@end #1'; this matters in verbatim
4184 % environments, where otherwise the newline after an ignored conditional
4185 % would result in a blank line in the output.
4186 \gdef\enddoignore#1^^M{\endgroup\ignorespaces}%
4187 }
4188
4189
4190 % @set VAR sets the variable VAR to an empty value.
4191 % @set VAR REST-OF-LINE sets VAR to the value REST-OF-LINE.
4192 %
4193 % Since we want to separate VAR from REST-OF-LINE (which might be
4194 % empty), we can't just use \parsearg; we have to insert a space of our
4195 % own to delimit the rest of the line, and then take it out again if we
4196 % didn't need it.
4197 % We rely on the fact that \parsearg sets \catcode`\ =10.
4198 %
4199 \parseargdef\set{\setyyy#1 \endsetyyy}
4200 \def\setyyy#1 #2\endsetyyy{%
4201 {%
4202 \makevalueexpandable
4203 \def\temp{#2}%
4204 \edef\next{\gdef\makecsname{SET#1}}%
4205 \ifx\temp\empty
4206 \next{}%
4207 \else
4208 \setzzz#2\endsetzzz
4209 \fi
4210 }%
4211 }
4212 % Remove the trailing space \setxxx inserted.
4213 \def\setzzz#1 \endsetzzz{\next{#1}}
4214
4215 % @clear VAR clears (i.e., unsets) the variable VAR.
4216 %
4217 \parseargdef\clear{%
4218 {%
4219 \makevalueexpandable
4220 \global\expandafter\let\csname SET#1\endcsname=\relax
4221 }%
4222 }
4223
4224 % @value{foo} gets the text saved in variable foo.
4225 \def\value{\begingroup\makevalueexpandable\valuexxx}
4226 \def\valuexxx#1{\expandablevalue{#1}\endgroup}
4227 {
4228 \catcode`\-=\active \catcode`\_=\active
4229 %
4230 \gdef\makevalueexpandable{%
4231 \let\value = \expandablevalue
4232 % We don't want these characters active, ...
4233 \catcode`\-=\other \catcode`\_=\other
4234 % ..., but we might end up with active ones in the argument if
4235 % we're called from @code, as @code{@value{foo-bar_}}, though.
4236 % So \let them to their normal equivalents.
4237 \let-\normaldash \let_\normalunderscore
4238 }
4239 }
4240
4241 % We have this subroutine so that we can handle at least some @value's
4242 % properly in indexes (we call \makevalueexpandable in \indexdummies).
4243 % The command has to be fully expandable (if the variable is set), since
4244 % the result winds up in the index file. This means that if the
4245 % variable's value contains other Texinfo commands, it's almost certain
4246 % it will fail (although perhaps we could fix that with sufficient work
4247 % to do a one-level expansion on the result, instead of complete).
4248 %
4249 % Unfortunately, this has the consequence that when _ is in the *value*
4250 % of an @set, it does not print properly in the roman fonts (get the cmr
4251 % dot accent at position 126 instead). No fix comes to mind, and it's
4252 % been this way since 2003 or earlier, so just ignore it.
4253 %
4254 \def\expandablevalue#1{%
4255 \expandafter\ifx\csname SET#1\endcsname\relax
4256 {[No value for ``#1'']}%
4257 \message{Variable `#1', used in @value, is not set.}%
4258 \else
4259 \csname SET#1\endcsname
4260 \fi
4261 }
4262
4263 % @ifset VAR ... @end ifset reads the `...' iff VAR has been defined
4264 % with @set.
4265 %
4266 % To get the special treatment we need for `@end ifset,' we call
4267 % \makecond and then redefine.
4268 %
4269 \makecond{ifset}
4270 \def\ifset{\parsearg{\doifset{\let\next=\ifsetfail}}}
4271 \def\doifset#1#2{%
4272 {%
4273 \makevalueexpandable
4274 \let\next=\empty
4275 \expandafter\ifx\csname SET#2\endcsname\relax
4276 #1% If not set, redefine \next.
4277 \fi
4278 \expandafter
4279 }\next
4280 }
4281 \def\ifsetfail{\doignore{ifset}}
4282
4283 % @ifclear VAR ... @end executes the `...' iff VAR has never been
4284 % defined with @set, or has been undefined with @clear.
4285 %
4286 % The `\else' inside the `\doifset' parameter is a trick to reuse the
4287 % above code: if the variable is not set, do nothing, if it is set,
4288 % then redefine \next to \ifclearfail.
4289 %
4290 \makecond{ifclear}
4291 \def\ifclear{\parsearg{\doifset{\else \let\next=\ifclearfail}}}
4292 \def\ifclearfail{\doignore{ifclear}}
4293
4294 % @ifcommandisdefined CMD ... @end executes the `...' if CMD (written
4295 % without the @) is in fact defined. We can only feasibly check at the
4296 % TeX level, so something like `mathcode' is going to considered
4297 % defined even though it is not a Texinfo command.
4298 %
4299 \makecond{ifcommanddefined}
4300 \def\ifcommanddefined{\parsearg{\doifcmddefined{\let\next=\ifcmddefinedfail}}}
4301 %
4302 \def\doifcmddefined#1#2{{%
4303 \makevalueexpandable
4304 \let\next=\empty
4305 \expandafter\ifx\csname #2\endcsname\relax
4306 #1% If not defined, \let\next as above.
4307 \fi
4308 \expandafter
4309 }\next
4310 }
4311 \def\ifcmddefinedfail{\doignore{ifcommanddefined}}
4312
4313 % @ifcommandnotdefined CMD ... handled similar to @ifclear above.
4314 \makecond{ifcommandnotdefined}
4315 \def\ifcommandnotdefined{%
4316 \parsearg{\doifcmddefined{\else \let\next=\ifcmdnotdefinedfail}}}
4317 \def\ifcmdnotdefinedfail{\doignore{ifcommandnotdefined}}
4318
4319 % Set the `txicommandconditionals' variable, so documents have a way to
4320 % test if the @ifcommand...defined conditionals are available.
4321 \set txicommandconditionals
4322
4323 % @dircategory CATEGORY -- specify a category of the dir file
4324 % which this file should belong to. Ignore this in TeX.
4325 \let\dircategory=\comment
4326
4327 % @defininfoenclose.
4328 \let\definfoenclose=\comment
4329
4330
4331 \message{indexing,}
4332 % Index generation facilities
4333
4334 % Define \newwrite to be identical to plain tex's \newwrite
4335 % except not \outer, so it can be used within macros and \if's.
4336 \edef\newwrite{\makecsname{ptexnewwrite}}
4337
4338 % \newindex {foo} defines an index named foo.
4339 % It automatically defines \fooindex such that
4340 % \fooindex ...rest of line... puts an entry in the index foo.
4341 % It also defines \fooindfile to be the number of the output channel for
4342 % the file that accumulates this index. The file's extension is foo.
4343 % The name of an index should be no more than 2 characters long
4344 % for the sake of vms.
4345 %
4346 \def\newindex#1{%
4347 \iflinks
4348 \expandafter\newwrite \csname#1indfile\endcsname
4349 \openout \csname#1indfile\endcsname \jobname.#1 % Open the file
4350 \fi
4351 \expandafter\xdef\csname#1index\endcsname{% % Define @#1index
4352 \noexpand\doindex{#1}}
4353 }
4354
4355 % @defindex foo == \newindex{foo}
4356 %
4357 \def\defindex{\parsearg\newindex}
4358
4359 % Define @defcodeindex, like @defindex except put all entries in @code.
4360 %
4361 \def\defcodeindex{\parsearg\newcodeindex}
4362 %
4363 \def\newcodeindex#1{%
4364 \iflinks
4365 \expandafter\newwrite \csname#1indfile\endcsname
4366 \openout \csname#1indfile\endcsname \jobname.#1
4367 \fi
4368 \expandafter\xdef\csname#1index\endcsname{%
4369 \noexpand\docodeindex{#1}}%
4370 }
4371
4372
4373 % @synindex foo bar makes index foo feed into index bar.
4374 % Do this instead of @defindex foo if you don't want it as a separate index.
4375 %
4376 % @syncodeindex foo bar similar, but put all entries made for index foo
4377 % inside @code.
4378 %
4379 \def\synindex#1 #2 {\dosynindex\doindex{#1}{#2}}
4380 \def\syncodeindex#1 #2 {\dosynindex\docodeindex{#1}{#2}}
4381
4382 % #1 is \doindex or \docodeindex, #2 the index getting redefined (foo),
4383 % #3 the target index (bar).
4384 \def\dosynindex#1#2#3{%
4385 % Only do \closeout if we haven't already done it, else we'll end up
4386 % closing the target index.
4387 \expandafter \ifx\csname donesynindex#2\endcsname \relax
4388 % The \closeout helps reduce unnecessary open files; the limit on the
4389 % Acorn RISC OS is a mere 16 files.
4390 \expandafter\closeout\csname#2indfile\endcsname
4391 \expandafter\let\csname donesynindex#2\endcsname = 1
4392 \fi
4393 % redefine \fooindfile:
4394 \expandafter\let\expandafter\temp\expandafter=\csname#3indfile\endcsname
4395 \expandafter\let\csname#2indfile\endcsname=\temp
4396 % redefine \fooindex:
4397 \expandafter\xdef\csname#2index\endcsname{\noexpand#1{#3}}%
4398 }
4399
4400 % Define \doindex, the driver for all \fooindex macros.
4401 % Argument #1 is generated by the calling \fooindex macro,
4402 % and it is "foo", the name of the index.
4403
4404 % \doindex just uses \parsearg; it calls \doind for the actual work.
4405 % This is because \doind is more useful to call from other macros.
4406
4407 % There is also \dosubind {index}{topic}{subtopic}
4408 % which makes an entry in a two-level index such as the operation index.
4409
4410 \def\doindex#1{\edef\indexname{#1}\parsearg\singleindexer}
4411 \def\singleindexer #1{\doind{\indexname}{#1}}
4412
4413 % like the previous two, but they put @code around the argument.
4414 \def\docodeindex#1{\edef\indexname{#1}\parsearg\singlecodeindexer}
4415 \def\singlecodeindexer #1{\doind{\indexname}{\code{#1}}}
4416
4417 % Take care of Texinfo commands that can appear in an index entry.
4418 % Since there are some commands we want to expand, and others we don't,
4419 % we have to laboriously prevent expansion for those that we don't.
4420 %
4421 \def\indexdummies{%
4422 \escapechar = `\\ % use backslash in output files.
4423 \def\@{@}% change to @@ when we switch to @ as escape char in index files.
4424 \def\ {\realbackslash\space }%
4425 %
4426 % Need these unexpandable (because we define \tt as a dummy)
4427 % definitions when @{ or @} appear in index entry text. Also, more
4428 % complicated, when \tex is in effect and \{ is a \delimiter again.
4429 % We can't use \lbracecmd and \rbracecmd because texindex assumes
4430 % braces and backslashes are used only as delimiters. Perhaps we
4431 % should define @lbrace and @rbrace commands a la @comma.
4432 \def\{{{\tt\char123}}%
4433 \def\}{{\tt\char125}}%
4434 %
4435 % I don't entirely understand this, but when an index entry is
4436 % generated from a macro call, the \endinput which \scanmacro inserts
4437 % causes processing to be prematurely terminated. This is,
4438 % apparently, because \indexsorttmp is fully expanded, and \endinput
4439 % is an expandable command. The redefinition below makes \endinput
4440 % disappear altogether for that purpose -- although logging shows that
4441 % processing continues to some further point. On the other hand, it
4442 % seems \endinput does not hurt in the printed index arg, since that
4443 % is still getting written without apparent harm.
4444 %
4445 % Sample source (mac-idx3.tex, reported by Graham Percival to
4446 % help-texinfo, 22may06):
4447 % @macro funindex {WORD}
4448 % @findex xyz
4449 % @end macro
4450 % ...
4451 % @funindex commtest
4452 %
4453 % The above is not enough to reproduce the bug, but it gives the flavor.
4454 %
4455 % Sample whatsit resulting:
4456 % .@write3{\entry{xyz}{@folio }{@code {xyz@endinput }}}
4457 %
4458 % So:
4459 \let\endinput = \empty
4460 %
4461 % Do the redefinitions.
4462 \commondummies
4463 }
4464
4465 % For the aux and toc files, @ is the escape character. So we want to
4466 % redefine everything using @ as the escape character (instead of
4467 % \realbackslash, still used for index files). When everything uses @,
4468 % this will be simpler.
4469 %
4470 \def\atdummies{%
4471 \def\@{@@}%
4472 \def\ {@ }%
4473 \let\{ = \lbraceatcmd
4474 \let\} = \rbraceatcmd
4475 %
4476 % Do the redefinitions.
4477 \commondummies
4478 \otherbackslash
4479 }
4480
4481 % Called from \indexdummies and \atdummies.
4482 %
4483 \def\commondummies{%
4484 %
4485 % \definedummyword defines \#1 as \string\#1\space, thus effectively
4486 % preventing its expansion. This is used only for control words,
4487 % not control letters, because the \space would be incorrect for
4488 % control characters, but is needed to separate the control word
4489 % from whatever follows.
4490 %
4491 % For control letters, we have \definedummyletter, which omits the
4492 % space.
4493 %
4494 % These can be used both for control words that take an argument and
4495 % those that do not. If it is followed by {arg} in the input, then
4496 % that will dutifully get written to the index (or wherever).
4497 %
4498 \def\definedummyword ##1{\def##1{\string##1\space}}%
4499 \def\definedummyletter##1{\def##1{\string##1}}%
4500 \let\definedummyaccent\definedummyletter
4501 %
4502 \commondummiesnofonts
4503 %
4504 \definedummyletter\_%
4505 \definedummyletter\-%
4506 %
4507 % Non-English letters.
4508 \definedummyword\AA
4509 \definedummyword\AE
4510 \definedummyword\DH
4511 \definedummyword\L
4512 \definedummyword\O
4513 \definedummyword\OE
4514 \definedummyword\TH
4515 \definedummyword\aa
4516 \definedummyword\ae
4517 \definedummyword\dh
4518 \definedummyword\exclamdown
4519 \definedummyword\l
4520 \definedummyword\o
4521 \definedummyword\oe
4522 \definedummyword\ordf
4523 \definedummyword\ordm
4524 \definedummyword\questiondown
4525 \definedummyword\ss
4526 \definedummyword\th
4527 %
4528 % Although these internal commands shouldn't show up, sometimes they do.
4529 \definedummyword\bf
4530 \definedummyword\gtr
4531 \definedummyword\hat
4532 \definedummyword\less
4533 \definedummyword\sf
4534 \definedummyword\sl
4535 \definedummyword\tclose
4536 \definedummyword\tt
4537 %
4538 \definedummyword\LaTeX
4539 \definedummyword\TeX
4540 %
4541 % Assorted special characters.
4542 \definedummyword\arrow
4543 \definedummyword\bullet
4544 \definedummyword\comma
4545 \definedummyword\copyright
4546 \definedummyword\registeredsymbol
4547 \definedummyword\dots
4548 \definedummyword\enddots
4549 \definedummyword\entrybreak
4550 \definedummyword\equiv
4551 \definedummyword\error
4552 \definedummyword\euro
4553 \definedummyword\expansion
4554 \definedummyword\geq
4555 \definedummyword\guillemetleft
4556 \definedummyword\guillemetright
4557 \definedummyword\guilsinglleft
4558 \definedummyword\guilsinglright
4559 \definedummyword\lbracechar
4560 \definedummyword\leq
4561 \definedummyword\minus
4562 \definedummyword\ogonek
4563 \definedummyword\pounds
4564 \definedummyword\point
4565 \definedummyword\print
4566 \definedummyword\quotedblbase
4567 \definedummyword\quotedblleft
4568 \definedummyword\quotedblright
4569 \definedummyword\quoteleft
4570 \definedummyword\quoteright
4571 \definedummyword\quotesinglbase
4572 \definedummyword\rbracechar
4573 \definedummyword\result
4574 \definedummyword\textdegree
4575 %
4576 % We want to disable all macros so that they are not expanded by \write.
4577 \macrolist
4578 %
4579 \normalturnoffactive
4580 %
4581 % Handle some cases of @value -- where it does not contain any
4582 % (non-fully-expandable) commands.
4583 \makevalueexpandable
4584 }
4585
4586 % \commondummiesnofonts: common to \commondummies and \indexnofonts.
4587 %
4588 \def\commondummiesnofonts{%
4589 % Control letters and accents.
4590 \definedummyletter\!%
4591 \definedummyaccent\"%
4592 \definedummyaccent\'%
4593 \definedummyletter\*%
4594 \definedummyaccent\,%
4595 \definedummyletter\.%
4596 \definedummyletter\/%
4597 \definedummyletter\:%
4598 \definedummyaccent\=%
4599 \definedummyletter\?%
4600 \definedummyaccent\^%
4601 \definedummyaccent\`%
4602 \definedummyaccent\~%
4603 \definedummyword\u
4604 \definedummyword\v
4605 \definedummyword\H
4606 \definedummyword\dotaccent
4607 \definedummyword\ogonek
4608 \definedummyword\ringaccent
4609 \definedummyword\tieaccent
4610 \definedummyword\ubaraccent
4611 \definedummyword\udotaccent
4612 \definedummyword\dotless
4613 %
4614 % Texinfo font commands.
4615 \definedummyword\b
4616 \definedummyword\i
4617 \definedummyword\r
4618 \definedummyword\sansserif
4619 \definedummyword\sc
4620 \definedummyword\slanted
4621 \definedummyword\t
4622 %
4623 % Commands that take arguments.
4624 \definedummyword\abbr
4625 \definedummyword\acronym
4626 \definedummyword\anchor
4627 \definedummyword\cite
4628 \definedummyword\code
4629 \definedummyword\command
4630 \definedummyword\dfn
4631 \definedummyword\dmn
4632 \definedummyword\email
4633 \definedummyword\emph
4634 \definedummyword\env
4635 \definedummyword\file
4636 \definedummyword\image
4637 \definedummyword\indicateurl
4638 \definedummyword\inforef
4639 \definedummyword\kbd
4640 \definedummyword\key
4641 \definedummyword\math
4642 \definedummyword\option
4643 \definedummyword\pxref
4644 \definedummyword\ref
4645 \definedummyword\samp
4646 \definedummyword\strong
4647 \definedummyword\tie
4648 \definedummyword\uref
4649 \definedummyword\url
4650 \definedummyword\var
4651 \definedummyword\verb
4652 \definedummyword\w
4653 \definedummyword\xref
4654 %
4655 % Consider:
4656 % @macro mkind{arg1,arg2}
4657 % @cindex \arg2\
4658 % @end macro
4659 % @mkind{foo, bar}
4660 % The space after the comma will end up in the temporary definition
4661 % that we make for arg2 (see \parsemargdef ff.). We want all this to be
4662 % expanded for the sake of the index, so we end up just seeing "bar".
4663 \let\xeatspaces = \eatspaces
4664 }
4665
4666 % \indexnofonts is used when outputting the strings to sort the index
4667 % by, and when constructing control sequence names. It eliminates all
4668 % control sequences and just writes whatever the best ASCII sort string
4669 % would be for a given command (usually its argument).
4670 %
4671 \def\indexnofonts{%
4672 % Accent commands should become @asis.
4673 \def\definedummyaccent##1{\let##1\asis}%
4674 % We can just ignore other control letters.
4675 \def\definedummyletter##1{\let##1\empty}%
4676 % All control words become @asis by default; overrides below.
4677 \let\definedummyword\definedummyaccent
4678 %
4679 \commondummiesnofonts
4680 %
4681 % Don't no-op \tt, since it isn't a user-level command
4682 % and is used in the definitions of the active chars like <, >, |, etc.
4683 % Likewise with the other plain tex font commands.
4684 %\let\tt=\asis
4685 %
4686 \def\ { }%
4687 \def\@{@}%
4688 \def\_{\normalunderscore}%
4689 \def\-{}% @- shouldn't affect sorting
4690 %
4691 % Unfortunately, texindex is not prepared to handle braces in the
4692 % content at all. So for index sorting, we map @{ and @} to strings
4693 % starting with |, since that ASCII character is between ASCII { and }.
4694 \def\{{|a}%
4695 \def\lbracechar{|a}%
4696 %
4697 \def\}{|b}%
4698 \def\rbracechar{|b}%
4699 %
4700 % Non-English letters.
4701 \def\AA{AA}%
4702 \def\AE{AE}%
4703 \def\DH{DZZ}%
4704 \def\L{L}%
4705 \def\OE{OE}%
4706 \def\O{O}%
4707 \def\TH{ZZZ}%
4708 \def\aa{aa}%
4709 \def\ae{ae}%
4710 \def\dh{dzz}%
4711 \def\exclamdown{!}%
4712 \def\l{l}%
4713 \def\oe{oe}%
4714 \def\ordf{a}%
4715 \def\ordm{o}%
4716 \def\o{o}%
4717 \def\questiondown{?}%
4718 \def\ss{ss}%
4719 \def\th{zzz}%
4720 %
4721 \def\LaTeX{LaTeX}%
4722 \def\TeX{TeX}%
4723 %
4724 % Assorted special characters.
4725 % (The following {} will end up in the sort string, but that's ok.)
4726 \def\arrow{->}%
4727 \def\bullet{bullet}%
4728 \def\comma{,}%
4729 \def\copyright{copyright}%
4730 \def\dots{...}%
4731 \def\enddots{...}%
4732 \def\equiv{==}%
4733 \def\error{error}%
4734 \def\euro{euro}%
4735 \def\expansion{==>}%
4736 \def\geq{>=}%
4737 \def\guillemetleft{<<}%
4738 \def\guillemetright{>>}%
4739 \def\guilsinglleft{<}%
4740 \def\guilsinglright{>}%
4741 \def\leq{<=}%
4742 \def\minus{-}%
4743 \def\point{.}%
4744 \def\pounds{pounds}%
4745 \def\print{-|}%
4746 \def\quotedblbase{"}%
4747 \def\quotedblleft{"}%
4748 \def\quotedblright{"}%
4749 \def\quoteleft{`}%
4750 \def\quoteright{'}%
4751 \def\quotesinglbase{,}%
4752 \def\registeredsymbol{R}%
4753 \def\result{=>}%
4754 \def\textdegree{o}%
4755 %
4756 \expandafter\ifx\csname SETtxiindexlquoteignore\endcsname\relax
4757 \else \indexlquoteignore \fi
4758 %
4759 % We need to get rid of all macros, leaving only the arguments (if present).
4760 % Of course this is not nearly correct, but it is the best we can do for now.
4761 % makeinfo does not expand macros in the argument to @deffn, which ends up
4762 % writing an index entry, and texindex isn't prepared for an index sort entry
4763 % that starts with \.
4764 %
4765 % Since macro invocations are followed by braces, we can just redefine them
4766 % to take a single TeX argument. The case of a macro invocation that
4767 % goes to end-of-line is not handled.
4768 %
4769 \macrolist
4770 }
4771
4772 % Undocumented (for FSFS 2nd ed.): @set txiindexlquoteignore makes us
4773 % ignore left quotes in the sort term.
4774 {\catcode`\`=\active
4775 \gdef\indexlquoteignore{\let`=\empty}}
4776
4777 \let\indexbackslash=0 %overridden during \printindex.
4778 \let\SETmarginindex=\relax % put index entries in margin (undocumented)?
4779
4780 % Most index entries go through here, but \dosubind is the general case.
4781 % #1 is the index name, #2 is the entry text.
4782 \def\doind#1#2{\dosubind{#1}{#2}{}}
4783
4784 % Workhorse for all \fooindexes.
4785 % #1 is name of index, #2 is stuff to put there, #3 is subentry --
4786 % empty if called from \doind, as we usually are (the main exception
4787 % is with most defuns, which call us directly).
4788 %
4789 \def\dosubind#1#2#3{%
4790 \iflinks
4791 {%
4792 % Store the main index entry text (including the third arg).
4793 \toks0 = {#2}%
4794 % If third arg is present, precede it with a space.
4795 \def\thirdarg{#3}%
4796 \ifx\thirdarg\empty \else
4797 \toks0 = \expandafter{\the\toks0 \space #3}%
4798 \fi
4799 %
4800 \edef\writeto{\csname#1indfile\endcsname}%
4801 %
4802 \safewhatsit\dosubindwrite
4803 }%
4804 \fi
4805 }
4806
4807 % Write the entry in \toks0 to the index file:
4808 %
4809 \def\dosubindwrite{%
4810 % Put the index entry in the margin if desired.
4811 \ifx\SETmarginindex\relax\else
4812 \insert\margin{\hbox{\vrule height8pt depth3pt width0pt \the\toks0}}%
4813 \fi
4814 %
4815 % Remember, we are within a group.
4816 \indexdummies % Must do this here, since \bf, etc expand at this stage
4817 \def\backslashcurfont{\indexbackslash}% \indexbackslash isn't defined now
4818 % so it will be output as is; and it will print as backslash.
4819 %
4820 % Process the index entry with all font commands turned off, to
4821 % get the string to sort by.
4822 {\indexnofonts
4823 \edef\temp{\the\toks0}% need full expansion
4824 \xdef\indexsorttmp{\temp}%
4825 }%
4826 %
4827 % Set up the complete index entry, with both the sort key and
4828 % the original text, including any font commands. We write
4829 % three arguments to \entry to the .?? file (four in the
4830 % subentry case), texindex reduces to two when writing the .??s
4831 % sorted result.
4832 \edef\temp{%
4833 \write\writeto{%
4834 \string\entry{\indexsorttmp}{\noexpand\folio}{\the\toks0}}%
4835 }%
4836 \temp
4837 }
4838
4839 % Take care of unwanted page breaks/skips around a whatsit:
4840 %
4841 % If a skip is the last thing on the list now, preserve it
4842 % by backing up by \lastskip, doing the \write, then inserting
4843 % the skip again. Otherwise, the whatsit generated by the
4844 % \write or \pdfdest will make \lastskip zero. The result is that
4845 % sequences like this:
4846 % @end defun
4847 % @tindex whatever
4848 % @defun ...
4849 % will have extra space inserted, because the \medbreak in the
4850 % start of the @defun won't see the skip inserted by the @end of
4851 % the previous defun.
4852 %
4853 % But don't do any of this if we're not in vertical mode. We
4854 % don't want to do a \vskip and prematurely end a paragraph.
4855 %
4856 % Avoid page breaks due to these extra skips, too.
4857 %
4858 % But wait, there is a catch there:
4859 % We'll have to check whether \lastskip is zero skip. \ifdim is not
4860 % sufficient for this purpose, as it ignores stretch and shrink parts
4861 % of the skip. The only way seems to be to check the textual
4862 % representation of the skip.
4863 %
4864 % The following is almost like \def\zeroskipmacro{0.0pt} except that
4865 % the ``p'' and ``t'' characters have catcode \other, not 11 (letter).
4866 %
4867 \edef\zeroskipmacro{\expandafter\the\csname z@skip\endcsname}
4868 %
4869 \newskip\whatsitskip
4870 \newcount\whatsitpenalty
4871 %
4872 % ..., ready, GO:
4873 %
4874 \def\safewhatsit#1{\ifhmode
4875 #1%
4876 \else
4877 % \lastskip and \lastpenalty cannot both be nonzero simultaneously.
4878 \whatsitskip = \lastskip
4879 \edef\lastskipmacro{\the\lastskip}%
4880 \whatsitpenalty = \lastpenalty
4881 %
4882 % If \lastskip is nonzero, that means the last item was a
4883 % skip. And since a skip is discardable, that means this
4884 % -\whatsitskip glue we're inserting is preceded by a
4885 % non-discardable item, therefore it is not a potential
4886 % breakpoint, therefore no \nobreak needed.
4887 \ifx\lastskipmacro\zeroskipmacro
4888 \else
4889 \vskip-\whatsitskip
4890 \fi
4891 %
4892 #1%
4893 %
4894 \ifx\lastskipmacro\zeroskipmacro
4895 % If \lastskip was zero, perhaps the last item was a penalty, and
4896 % perhaps it was >=10000, e.g., a \nobreak. In that case, we want
4897 % to re-insert the same penalty (values >10000 are used for various
4898 % signals); since we just inserted a non-discardable item, any
4899 % following glue (such as a \parskip) would be a breakpoint. For example:
4900 % @deffn deffn-whatever
4901 % @vindex index-whatever
4902 % Description.
4903 % would allow a break between the index-whatever whatsit
4904 % and the "Description." paragraph.
4905 \ifnum\whatsitpenalty>9999 \penalty\whatsitpenalty \fi
4906 \else
4907 % On the other hand, if we had a nonzero \lastskip,
4908 % this make-up glue would be preceded by a non-discardable item
4909 % (the whatsit from the \write), so we must insert a \nobreak.
4910 \nobreak\vskip\whatsitskip
4911 \fi
4912 \fi}
4913
4914 % The index entry written in the file actually looks like
4915 % \entry {sortstring}{page}{topic}
4916 % or
4917 % \entry {sortstring}{page}{topic}{subtopic}
4918 % The texindex program reads in these files and writes files
4919 % containing these kinds of lines:
4920 % \initial {c}
4921 % before the first topic whose initial is c
4922 % \entry {topic}{pagelist}
4923 % for a topic that is used without subtopics
4924 % \primary {topic}
4925 % for the beginning of a topic that is used with subtopics
4926 % \secondary {subtopic}{pagelist}
4927 % for each subtopic.
4928
4929 % Define the user-accessible indexing commands
4930 % @findex, @vindex, @kindex, @cindex.
4931
4932 \def\findex {\fnindex}
4933 \def\kindex {\kyindex}
4934 \def\cindex {\cpindex}
4935 \def\vindex {\vrindex}
4936 \def\tindex {\tpindex}
4937 \def\pindex {\pgindex}
4938
4939 \def\cindexsub {\begingroup\obeylines\cindexsub}
4940 {\obeylines %
4941 \gdef\cindexsub "#1" #2^^M{\endgroup %
4942 \dosubind{cp}{#2}{#1}}}
4943
4944 % Define the macros used in formatting output of the sorted index material.
4945
4946 % @printindex causes a particular index (the ??s file) to get printed.
4947 % It does not print any chapter heading (usually an @unnumbered).
4948 %
4949 \parseargdef\printindex{\begingroup
4950 \dobreak \chapheadingskip{10000}%
4951 %
4952 \smallfonts \rm
4953 \tolerance = 9500
4954 \plainfrenchspacing
4955 \everypar = {}% don't want the \kern\-parindent from indentation suppression.
4956 %
4957 % See if the index file exists and is nonempty.
4958 % Change catcode of @ here so that if the index file contains
4959 % \initial {@}
4960 % as its first line, TeX doesn't complain about mismatched braces
4961 % (because it thinks @} is a control sequence).
4962 \catcode`\@ = 11
4963 \openin 1 \jobname.#1s
4964 \ifeof 1
4965 % \enddoublecolumns gets confused if there is no text in the index,
4966 % and it loses the chapter title and the aux file entries for the
4967 % index. The easiest way to prevent this problem is to make sure
4968 % there is some text.
4969 \putwordIndexNonexistent
4970 \else
4971 %
4972 % If the index file exists but is empty, then \openin leaves \ifeof
4973 % false. We have to make TeX try to read something from the file, so
4974 % it can discover if there is anything in it.
4975 \read 1 to \temp
4976 \ifeof 1
4977 \putwordIndexIsEmpty
4978 \else
4979 % Index files are almost Texinfo source, but we use \ as the escape
4980 % character. It would be better to use @, but that's too big a change
4981 % to make right now.
4982 \def\indexbackslash{\backslashcurfont}%
4983 \catcode`\\ = 0
4984 \escapechar = `\\
4985 \begindoublecolumns
4986 \input \jobname.#1s
4987 \enddoublecolumns
4988 \fi
4989 \fi
4990 \closein 1
4991 \endgroup}
4992
4993 % These macros are used by the sorted index file itself.
4994 % Change them to control the appearance of the index.
4995
4996 \def\initial#1{{%
4997 % Some minor font changes for the special characters.
4998 \let\tentt=\sectt \let\tt=\sectt \let\sf=\sectt
4999 %
5000 % Remove any glue we may have, we'll be inserting our own.
5001 \removelastskip
5002 %
5003 % We like breaks before the index initials, so insert a bonus.
5004 \nobreak
5005 \vskip 0pt plus 3\baselineskip
5006 \penalty 0
5007 \vskip 0pt plus -3\baselineskip
5008 %
5009 % Typeset the initial. Making this add up to a whole number of
5010 % baselineskips increases the chance of the dots lining up from column
5011 % to column. It still won't often be perfect, because of the stretch
5012 % we need before each entry, but it's better.
5013 %
5014 % No shrink because it confuses \balancecolumns.
5015 \vskip 1.67\baselineskip plus .5\baselineskip
5016 \leftline{\secbf #1}%
5017 % Do our best not to break after the initial.
5018 \nobreak
5019 \vskip .33\baselineskip plus .1\baselineskip
5020 }}
5021
5022 % \entry typesets a paragraph consisting of the text (#1), dot leaders, and
5023 % then page number (#2) flushed to the right margin. It is used for index
5024 % and table of contents entries. The paragraph is indented by \leftskip.
5025 %
5026 % A straightforward implementation would start like this:
5027 % \def\entry#1#2{...
5028 % But this freezes the catcodes in the argument, and can cause problems to
5029 % @code, which sets - active. This problem was fixed by a kludge---
5030 % ``-'' was active throughout whole index, but this isn't really right.
5031 % The right solution is to prevent \entry from swallowing the whole text.
5032 % --kasal, 21nov03
5033 \def\entry{%
5034 \begingroup
5035 %
5036 % Start a new paragraph if necessary, so our assignments below can't
5037 % affect previous text.
5038 \par
5039 %
5040 % Do not fill out the last line with white space.
5041 \parfillskip = 0in
5042 %
5043 % No extra space above this paragraph.
5044 \parskip = 0in
5045 %
5046 % Do not prefer a separate line ending with a hyphen to fewer lines.
5047 \finalhyphendemerits = 0
5048 %
5049 % \hangindent is only relevant when the entry text and page number
5050 % don't both fit on one line. In that case, bob suggests starting the
5051 % dots pretty far over on the line. Unfortunately, a large
5052 % indentation looks wrong when the entry text itself is broken across
5053 % lines. So we use a small indentation and put up with long leaders.
5054 %
5055 % \hangafter is reset to 1 (which is the value we want) at the start
5056 % of each paragraph, so we need not do anything with that.
5057 \hangindent = 2em
5058 %
5059 % When the entry text needs to be broken, just fill out the first line
5060 % with blank space.
5061 \rightskip = 0pt plus1fil
5062 %
5063 % A bit of stretch before each entry for the benefit of balancing
5064 % columns.
5065 \vskip 0pt plus1pt
5066 %
5067 % When reading the text of entry, convert explicit line breaks
5068 % from @* into spaces. The user might give these in long section
5069 % titles, for instance.
5070 \def\*{\unskip\space\ignorespaces}%
5071 \def\entrybreak{\hfil\break}%
5072 %
5073 % Swallow the left brace of the text (first parameter):
5074 \afterassignment\doentry
5075 \let\temp =
5076 }
5077 \def\entrybreak{\unskip\space\ignorespaces}%
5078 \def\doentry{%
5079 \bgroup % Instead of the swallowed brace.
5080 \noindent
5081 \aftergroup\finishentry
5082 % And now comes the text of the entry.
5083 }
5084 \def\finishentry#1{%
5085 % #1 is the page number.
5086 %
5087 % The following is kludged to not output a line of dots in the index if
5088 % there are no page numbers. The next person who breaks this will be
5089 % cursed by a Unix daemon.
5090 \setbox\boxA = \hbox{#1}%
5091 \ifdim\wd\boxA = 0pt
5092 \ %
5093 \else
5094 %
5095 % If we must, put the page number on a line of its own, and fill out
5096 % this line with blank space. (The \hfil is overwhelmed with the
5097 % fill leaders glue in \indexdotfill if the page number does fit.)
5098 \hfil\penalty50
5099 \null\nobreak\indexdotfill % Have leaders before the page number.
5100 %
5101 % The `\ ' here is removed by the implicit \unskip that TeX does as
5102 % part of (the primitive) \par. Without it, a spurious underfull
5103 % \hbox ensues.
5104 \ifpdf
5105 \pdfgettoks#1.%
5106 \ \the\toksA
5107 \else
5108 \ #1%
5109 \fi
5110 \fi
5111 \par
5112 \endgroup
5113 }
5114
5115 % Like plain.tex's \dotfill, except uses up at least 1 em.
5116 \def\indexdotfill{\cleaders
5117 \hbox{$\mathsurround=0pt \mkern1.5mu.\mkern1.5mu$}\hskip 1em plus 1fill}
5118
5119 \def\primary #1{\line{#1\hfil}}
5120
5121 \newskip\secondaryindent \secondaryindent=0.5cm
5122 \def\secondary#1#2{{%
5123 \parfillskip=0in
5124 \parskip=0in
5125 \hangindent=1in
5126 \hangafter=1
5127 \noindent\hskip\secondaryindent\hbox{#1}\indexdotfill
5128 \ifpdf
5129 \pdfgettoks#2.\ \the\toksA % The page number ends the paragraph.
5130 \else
5131 #2
5132 \fi
5133 \par
5134 }}
5135
5136 % Define two-column mode, which we use to typeset indexes.
5137 % Adapted from the TeXbook, page 416, which is to say,
5138 % the manmac.tex format used to print the TeXbook itself.
5139 \catcode`\@=11
5140
5141 \newbox\partialpage
5142 \newdimen\doublecolumnhsize
5143
5144 \def\begindoublecolumns{\begingroup % ended by \enddoublecolumns
5145 % Grab any single-column material above us.
5146 \output = {%
5147 %
5148 % Here is a possibility not foreseen in manmac: if we accumulate a
5149 % whole lot of material, we might end up calling this \output
5150 % routine twice in a row (see the doublecol-lose test, which is
5151 % essentially a couple of indexes with @setchapternewpage off). In
5152 % that case we just ship out what is in \partialpage with the normal
5153 % output routine. Generally, \partialpage will be empty when this
5154 % runs and this will be a no-op. See the indexspread.tex test case.
5155 \ifvoid\partialpage \else
5156 \onepageout{\pagecontents\partialpage}%
5157 \fi
5158 %
5159 \global\setbox\partialpage = \vbox{%
5160 % Unvbox the main output page.
5161 \unvbox\PAGE
5162 \kern-\topskip \kern\baselineskip
5163 }%
5164 }%
5165 \eject % run that output routine to set \partialpage
5166 %
5167 % Use the double-column output routine for subsequent pages.
5168 \output = {\doublecolumnout}%
5169 %
5170 % Change the page size parameters. We could do this once outside this
5171 % routine, in each of @smallbook, @afourpaper, and the default 8.5x11
5172 % format, but then we repeat the same computation. Repeating a couple
5173 % of assignments once per index is clearly meaningless for the
5174 % execution time, so we may as well do it in one place.
5175 %
5176 % First we halve the line length, less a little for the gutter between
5177 % the columns. We compute the gutter based on the line length, so it
5178 % changes automatically with the paper format. The magic constant
5179 % below is chosen so that the gutter has the same value (well, +-<1pt)
5180 % as it did when we hard-coded it.
5181 %
5182 % We put the result in a separate register, \doublecolumhsize, so we
5183 % can restore it in \pagesofar, after \hsize itself has (potentially)
5184 % been clobbered.
5185 %
5186 \doublecolumnhsize = \hsize
5187 \advance\doublecolumnhsize by -.04154\hsize
5188 \divide\doublecolumnhsize by 2
5189 \hsize = \doublecolumnhsize
5190 %
5191 % Double the \vsize as well. (We don't need a separate register here,
5192 % since nobody clobbers \vsize.)
5193 \vsize = 2\vsize
5194 }
5195
5196 % The double-column output routine for all double-column pages except
5197 % the last.
5198 %
5199 \def\doublecolumnout{%
5200 \splittopskip=\topskip \splitmaxdepth=\maxdepth
5201 % Get the available space for the double columns -- the normal
5202 % (undoubled) page height minus any material left over from the
5203 % previous page.
5204 \dimen@ = \vsize
5205 \divide\dimen@ by 2
5206 \advance\dimen@ by -\ht\partialpage
5207 %
5208 % box0 will be the left-hand column, box2 the right.
5209 \setbox0=\vsplit255 to\dimen@ \setbox2=\vsplit255 to\dimen@
5210 \onepageout\pagesofar
5211 \unvbox255
5212 \penalty\outputpenalty
5213 }
5214 %
5215 % Re-output the contents of the output page -- any previous material,
5216 % followed by the two boxes we just split, in box0 and box2.
5217 \def\pagesofar{%
5218 \unvbox\partialpage
5219 %
5220 \hsize = \doublecolumnhsize
5221 \wd0=\hsize \wd2=\hsize
5222 \hbox to\pagewidth{\box0\hfil\box2}%
5223 }
5224 %
5225 % All done with double columns.
5226 \def\enddoublecolumns{%
5227 % The following penalty ensures that the page builder is exercised
5228 % _before_ we change the output routine. This is necessary in the
5229 % following situation:
5230 %
5231 % The last section of the index consists only of a single entry.
5232 % Before this section, \pagetotal is less than \pagegoal, so no
5233 % break occurs before the last section starts. However, the last
5234 % section, consisting of \initial and the single \entry, does not
5235 % fit on the page and has to be broken off. Without the following
5236 % penalty the page builder will not be exercised until \eject
5237 % below, and by that time we'll already have changed the output
5238 % routine to the \balancecolumns version, so the next-to-last
5239 % double-column page will be processed with \balancecolumns, which
5240 % is wrong: The two columns will go to the main vertical list, with
5241 % the broken-off section in the recent contributions. As soon as
5242 % the output routine finishes, TeX starts reconsidering the page
5243 % break. The two columns and the broken-off section both fit on the
5244 % page, because the two columns now take up only half of the page
5245 % goal. When TeX sees \eject from below which follows the final
5246 % section, it invokes the new output routine that we've set after
5247 % \balancecolumns below; \onepageout will try to fit the two columns
5248 % and the final section into the vbox of \pageheight (see
5249 % \pagebody), causing an overfull box.
5250 %
5251 % Note that glue won't work here, because glue does not exercise the
5252 % page builder, unlike penalties (see The TeXbook, pp. 280-281).
5253 \penalty0
5254 %
5255 \output = {%
5256 % Split the last of the double-column material. Leave it on the
5257 % current page, no automatic page break.
5258 \balancecolumns
5259 %
5260 % If we end up splitting too much material for the current page,
5261 % though, there will be another page break right after this \output
5262 % invocation ends. Having called \balancecolumns once, we do not
5263 % want to call it again. Therefore, reset \output to its normal
5264 % definition right away. (We hope \balancecolumns will never be
5265 % called on to balance too much material, but if it is, this makes
5266 % the output somewhat more palatable.)
5267 \global\output = {\onepageout{\pagecontents\PAGE}}%
5268 }%
5269 \eject
5270 \endgroup % started in \begindoublecolumns
5271 %
5272 % \pagegoal was set to the doubled \vsize above, since we restarted
5273 % the current page. We're now back to normal single-column
5274 % typesetting, so reset \pagegoal to the normal \vsize (after the
5275 % \endgroup where \vsize got restored).
5276 \pagegoal = \vsize
5277 }
5278 %
5279 % Called at the end of the double column material.
5280 \def\balancecolumns{%
5281 \setbox0 = \vbox{\unvbox255}% like \box255 but more efficient, see p.120.
5282 \dimen@ = \ht0
5283 \advance\dimen@ by \topskip
5284 \advance\dimen@ by-\baselineskip
5285 \divide\dimen@ by 2 % target to split to
5286 %debug\message{final 2-column material height=\the\ht0, target=\the\dimen@.}%
5287 \splittopskip = \topskip
5288 % Loop until we get a decent breakpoint.
5289 {%
5290 \vbadness = 10000
5291 \loop
5292 \global\setbox3 = \copy0
5293 \global\setbox1 = \vsplit3 to \dimen@
5294 \ifdim\ht3>\dimen@
5295 \global\advance\dimen@ by 1pt
5296 \repeat
5297 }%
5298 %debug\message{split to \the\dimen@, column heights: \the\ht1, \the\ht3.}%
5299 \setbox0=\vbox to\dimen@{\unvbox1}%
5300 \setbox2=\vbox to\dimen@{\unvbox3}%
5301 %
5302 \pagesofar
5303 }
5304 \catcode`\@ = \other
5305
5306
5307 \message{sectioning,}
5308 % Chapters, sections, etc.
5309
5310 % Let's start with @part.
5311 \outer\parseargdef\part{\partzzz{#1}}
5312 \def\partzzz#1{%
5313 \chapoddpage
5314 \null
5315 \vskip.3\vsize % move it down on the page a bit
5316 \begingroup
5317 \noindent \titlefonts\rmisbold #1\par % the text
5318 \let\lastnode=\empty % no node to associate with
5319 \writetocentry{part}{#1}{}% but put it in the toc
5320 \headingsoff % no headline or footline on the part page
5321 \chapoddpage
5322 \endgroup
5323 }
5324
5325 % \unnumberedno is an oxymoron. But we count the unnumbered
5326 % sections so that we can refer to them unambiguously in the pdf
5327 % outlines by their "section number". We avoid collisions with chapter
5328 % numbers by starting them at 10000. (If a document ever has 10000
5329 % chapters, we're in trouble anyway, I'm sure.)
5330 \newcount\unnumberedno \unnumberedno = 10000
5331 \newcount\chapno
5332 \newcount\secno \secno=0
5333 \newcount\subsecno \subsecno=0
5334 \newcount\subsubsecno \subsubsecno=0
5335
5336 % This counter is funny since it counts through charcodes of letters A, B, ...
5337 \newcount\appendixno \appendixno = `\@
5338 %
5339 % \def\appendixletter{\char\the\appendixno}
5340 % We do the following ugly conditional instead of the above simple
5341 % construct for the sake of pdftex, which needs the actual
5342 % letter in the expansion, not just typeset.
5343 %
5344 \def\appendixletter{%
5345 \ifnum\appendixno=`A A%
5346 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`B B%
5347 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`C C%
5348 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`D D%
5349 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`E E%
5350 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`F F%
5351 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`G G%
5352 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`H H%
5353 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`I I%
5354 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`J J%
5355 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`K K%
5356 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`L L%
5357 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`M M%
5358 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`N N%
5359 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`O O%
5360 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`P P%
5361 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`Q Q%
5362 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`R R%
5363 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`S S%
5364 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`T T%
5365 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`U U%
5366 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`V V%
5367 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`W W%
5368 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`X X%
5369 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`Y Y%
5370 \else\ifnum\appendixno=`Z Z%
5371 % The \the is necessary, despite appearances, because \appendixletter is
5372 % expanded while writing the .toc file. \char\appendixno is not
5373 % expandable, thus it is written literally, thus all appendixes come out
5374 % with the same letter (or @) in the toc without it.
5375 \else\char\the\appendixno
5376 \fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi
5377 \fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi\fi}
5378
5379 % Each @chapter defines these (using marks) as the number+name, number
5380 % and name of the chapter. Page headings and footings can use
5381 % these. @section does likewise.
5382 \def\thischapter{}
5383 \def\thischapternum{}
5384 \def\thischaptername{}
5385 \def\thissection{}
5386 \def\thissectionnum{}
5387 \def\thissectionname{}
5388
5389 \newcount\absseclevel % used to calculate proper heading level
5390 \newcount\secbase\secbase=0 % @raisesections/@lowersections modify this count
5391
5392 % @raisesections: treat @section as chapter, @subsection as section, etc.
5393 \def\raisesections{\global\advance\secbase by -1}
5394 \let\up=\raisesections % original BFox name
5395
5396 % @lowersections: treat @chapter as section, @section as subsection, etc.
5397 \def\lowersections{\global\advance\secbase by 1}
5398 \let\down=\lowersections % original BFox name
5399
5400 % we only have subsub.
5401 \chardef\maxseclevel = 3
5402 %
5403 % A numbered section within an unnumbered changes to unnumbered too.
5404 % To achieve this, remember the "biggest" unnum. sec. we are currently in:
5405 \chardef\unnlevel = \maxseclevel
5406 %
5407 % Trace whether the current chapter is an appendix or not:
5408 % \chapheadtype is "N" or "A", unnumbered chapters are ignored.
5409 \def\chapheadtype{N}
5410
5411 % Choose a heading macro
5412 % #1 is heading type
5413 % #2 is heading level
5414 % #3 is text for heading
5415 \def\genhead#1#2#3{%
5416 % Compute the abs. sec. level:
5417 \absseclevel=#2
5418 \advance\absseclevel by \secbase
5419 % Make sure \absseclevel doesn't fall outside the range:
5420 \ifnum \absseclevel < 0
5421 \absseclevel = 0
5422 \else
5423 \ifnum \absseclevel > 3
5424 \absseclevel = 3
5425 \fi
5426 \fi
5427 % The heading type:
5428 \def\headtype{#1}%
5429 \if \headtype U%
5430 \ifnum \absseclevel < \unnlevel
5431 \chardef\unnlevel = \absseclevel
5432 \fi
5433 \else
5434 % Check for appendix sections:
5435 \ifnum \absseclevel = 0
5436 \edef\chapheadtype{\headtype}%
5437 \else
5438 \if \headtype A\if \chapheadtype N%
5439 \errmessage{@appendix... within a non-appendix chapter}%
5440 \fi\fi
5441 \fi
5442 % Check for numbered within unnumbered:
5443 \ifnum \absseclevel > \unnlevel
5444 \def\headtype{U}%
5445 \else
5446 \chardef\unnlevel = 3
5447 \fi
5448 \fi
5449 % Now print the heading:
5450 \if \headtype U%
5451 \ifcase\absseclevel
5452 \unnumberedzzz{#3}%
5453 \or \unnumberedseczzz{#3}%
5454 \or \unnumberedsubseczzz{#3}%
5455 \or \unnumberedsubsubseczzz{#3}%
5456 \fi
5457 \else
5458 \if \headtype A%
5459 \ifcase\absseclevel
5460 \appendixzzz{#3}%
5461 \or \appendixsectionzzz{#3}%
5462 \or \appendixsubseczzz{#3}%
5463 \or \appendixsubsubseczzz{#3}%
5464 \fi
5465 \else
5466 \ifcase\absseclevel
5467 \chapterzzz{#3}%
5468 \or \seczzz{#3}%
5469 \or \numberedsubseczzz{#3}%
5470 \or \numberedsubsubseczzz{#3}%
5471 \fi
5472 \fi
5473 \fi
5474 \suppressfirstparagraphindent
5475 }
5476
5477 % an interface:
5478 \def\numhead{\genhead N}
5479 \def\apphead{\genhead A}
5480 \def\unnmhead{\genhead U}
5481
5482 % @chapter, @appendix, @unnumbered. Increment top-level counter, reset
5483 % all lower-level sectioning counters to zero.
5484 %
5485 % Also set \chaplevelprefix, which we prepend to @float sequence numbers
5486 % (e.g., figures), q.v. By default (before any chapter), that is empty.
5487 \let\chaplevelprefix = \empty
5488 %
5489 \outer\parseargdef\chapter{\numhead0{#1}} % normally numhead0 calls chapterzzz
5490 \def\chapterzzz#1{%
5491 % section resetting is \global in case the chapter is in a group, such
5492 % as an @include file.
5493 \global\secno=0 \global\subsecno=0 \global\subsubsecno=0
5494 \global\advance\chapno by 1
5495 %
5496 % Used for \float.
5497 \gdef\chaplevelprefix{\the\chapno.}%
5498 \resetallfloatnos
5499 %
5500 % \putwordChapter can contain complex things in translations.
5501 \toks0=\expandafter{\putwordChapter}%
5502 \message{\the\toks0 \space \the\chapno}%
5503 %
5504 % Write the actual heading.
5505 \chapmacro{#1}{Ynumbered}{\the\chapno}%
5506 %
5507 % So @section and the like are numbered underneath this chapter.
5508 \global\let\section = \numberedsec
5509 \global\let\subsection = \numberedsubsec
5510 \global\let\subsubsection = \numberedsubsubsec
5511 }
5512
5513 \outer\parseargdef\appendix{\apphead0{#1}} % normally calls appendixzzz
5514 %
5515 \def\appendixzzz#1{%
5516 \global\secno=0 \global\subsecno=0 \global\subsubsecno=0
5517 \global\advance\appendixno by 1
5518 \gdef\chaplevelprefix{\appendixletter.}%
5519 \resetallfloatnos
5520 %
5521 % \putwordAppendix can contain complex things in translations.
5522 \toks0=\expandafter{\putwordAppendix}%
5523 \message{\the\toks0 \space \appendixletter}%
5524 %
5525 \chapmacro{#1}{Yappendix}{\appendixletter}%
5526 %
5527 \global\let\section = \appendixsec
5528 \global\let\subsection = \appendixsubsec
5529 \global\let\subsubsection = \appendixsubsubsec
5530 }
5531
5532 % normally unnmhead0 calls unnumberedzzz:
5533 \outer\parseargdef\unnumbered{\unnmhead0{#1}}
5534 \def\unnumberedzzz#1{%
5535 \global\secno=0 \global\subsecno=0 \global\subsubsecno=0
5536 \global\advance\unnumberedno by 1
5537 %
5538 % Since an unnumbered has no number, no prefix for figures.
5539 \global\let\chaplevelprefix = \empty
5540 \resetallfloatnos
5541 %
5542 % This used to be simply \message{#1}, but TeX fully expands the
5543 % argument to \message. Therefore, if #1 contained @-commands, TeX
5544 % expanded them. For example, in `@unnumbered The @cite{Book}', TeX
5545 % expanded @cite (which turns out to cause errors because \cite is meant
5546 % to be executed, not expanded).
5547 %
5548 % Anyway, we don't want the fully-expanded definition of @cite to appear
5549 % as a result of the \message, we just want `@cite' itself. We use
5550 % \the<toks register> to achieve this: TeX expands \the<toks> only once,
5551 % simply yielding the contents of <toks register>. (We also do this for
5552 % the toc entries.)
5553 \toks0 = {#1}%
5554 \message{(\the\toks0)}%
5555 %
5556 \chapmacro{#1}{Ynothing}{\the\unnumberedno}%
5557 %
5558 \global\let\section = \unnumberedsec
5559 \global\let\subsection = \unnumberedsubsec
5560 \global\let\subsubsection = \unnumberedsubsubsec
5561 }
5562
5563 % @centerchap is like @unnumbered, but the heading is centered.
5564 \outer\parseargdef\centerchap{%
5565 % Well, we could do the following in a group, but that would break
5566 % an assumption that \chapmacro is called at the outermost level.
5567 % Thus we are safer this way: --kasal, 24feb04
5568 \let\centerparametersmaybe = \centerparameters
5569 \unnmhead0{#1}%
5570 \let\centerparametersmaybe = \relax
5571 }
5572
5573 % @top is like @unnumbered.
5574 \let\top\unnumbered
5575
5576 % Sections.
5577 %
5578 \outer\parseargdef\numberedsec{\numhead1{#1}} % normally calls seczzz
5579 \def\seczzz#1{%
5580 \global\subsecno=0 \global\subsubsecno=0 \global\advance\secno by 1
5581 \sectionheading{#1}{sec}{Ynumbered}{\the\chapno.\the\secno}%
5582 }
5583
5584 % normally calls appendixsectionzzz:
5585 \outer\parseargdef\appendixsection{\apphead1{#1}}
5586 \def\appendixsectionzzz#1{%
5587 \global\subsecno=0 \global\subsubsecno=0 \global\advance\secno by 1
5588 \sectionheading{#1}{sec}{Yappendix}{\appendixletter.\the\secno}%
5589 }
5590 \let\appendixsec\appendixsection
5591
5592 % normally calls unnumberedseczzz:
5593 \outer\parseargdef\unnumberedsec{\unnmhead1{#1}}
5594 \def\unnumberedseczzz#1{%
5595 \global\subsecno=0 \global\subsubsecno=0 \global\advance\secno by 1
5596 \sectionheading{#1}{sec}{Ynothing}{\the\unnumberedno.\the\secno}%
5597 }
5598
5599 % Subsections.
5600 %
5601 % normally calls numberedsubseczzz:
5602 \outer\parseargdef\numberedsubsec{\numhead2{#1}}
5603 \def\numberedsubseczzz#1{%
5604 \global\subsubsecno=0 \global\advance\subsecno by 1
5605 \sectionheading{#1}{subsec}{Ynumbered}{\the\chapno.\the\secno.\the\subsecno}%
5606 }
5607
5608 % normally calls appendixsubseczzz:
5609 \outer\parseargdef\appendixsubsec{\apphead2{#1}}
5610 \def\appendixsubseczzz#1{%
5611 \global\subsubsecno=0 \global\advance\subsecno by 1
5612 \sectionheading{#1}{subsec}{Yappendix}%
5613 {\appendixletter.\the\secno.\the\subsecno}%
5614 }
5615
5616 % normally calls unnumberedsubseczzz:
5617 \outer\parseargdef\unnumberedsubsec{\unnmhead2{#1}}
5618 \def\unnumberedsubseczzz#1{%
5619 \global\subsubsecno=0 \global\advance\subsecno by 1
5620 \sectionheading{#1}{subsec}{Ynothing}%
5621 {\the\unnumberedno.\the\secno.\the\subsecno}%
5622 }
5623
5624 % Subsubsections.
5625 %
5626 % normally numberedsubsubseczzz:
5627 \outer\parseargdef\numberedsubsubsec{\numhead3{#1}}
5628 \def\numberedsubsubseczzz#1{%
5629 \global\advance\subsubsecno by 1
5630 \sectionheading{#1}{subsubsec}{Ynumbered}%
5631 {\the\chapno.\the\secno.\the\subsecno.\the\subsubsecno}%
5632 }
5633
5634 % normally appendixsubsubseczzz:
5635 \outer\parseargdef\appendixsubsubsec{\apphead3{#1}}
5636 \def\appendixsubsubseczzz#1{%
5637 \global\advance\subsubsecno by 1
5638 \sectionheading{#1}{subsubsec}{Yappendix}%
5639 {\appendixletter.\the\secno.\the\subsecno.\the\subsubsecno}%
5640 }
5641
5642 % normally unnumberedsubsubseczzz:
5643 \outer\parseargdef\unnumberedsubsubsec{\unnmhead3{#1}}
5644 \def\unnumberedsubsubseczzz#1{%
5645 \global\advance\subsubsecno by 1
5646 \sectionheading{#1}{subsubsec}{Ynothing}%
5647 {\the\unnumberedno.\the\secno.\the\subsecno.\the\subsubsecno}%
5648 }
5649
5650 % These macros control what the section commands do, according
5651 % to what kind of chapter we are in (ordinary, appendix, or unnumbered).
5652 % Define them by default for a numbered chapter.
5653 \let\section = \numberedsec
5654 \let\subsection = \numberedsubsec
5655 \let\subsubsection = \numberedsubsubsec
5656
5657 % Define @majorheading, @heading and @subheading
5658
5659 \def\majorheading{%
5660 {\advance\chapheadingskip by 10pt \chapbreak }%
5661 \parsearg\chapheadingzzz
5662 }
5663
5664 \def\chapheading{\chapbreak \parsearg\chapheadingzzz}
5665 \def\chapheadingzzz#1{%
5666 \vbox{\chapfonts \raggedtitlesettings #1\par}%
5667 \nobreak\bigskip \nobreak
5668 \suppressfirstparagraphindent
5669 }
5670
5671 % @heading, @subheading, @subsubheading.
5672 \parseargdef\heading{\sectionheading{#1}{sec}{Yomitfromtoc}{}
5673 \suppressfirstparagraphindent}
5674 \parseargdef\subheading{\sectionheading{#1}{subsec}{Yomitfromtoc}{}
5675 \suppressfirstparagraphindent}
5676 \parseargdef\subsubheading{\sectionheading{#1}{subsubsec}{Yomitfromtoc}{}
5677 \suppressfirstparagraphindent}
5678
5679 % These macros generate a chapter, section, etc. heading only
5680 % (including whitespace, linebreaking, etc. around it),
5681 % given all the information in convenient, parsed form.
5682
5683 % Args are the skip and penalty (usually negative)
5684 \def\dobreak#1#2{\par\ifdim\lastskip<#1\removelastskip\penalty#2\vskip#1\fi}
5685
5686 % Parameter controlling skip before chapter headings (if needed)
5687 \newskip\chapheadingskip
5688
5689 % Define plain chapter starts, and page on/off switching for it.
5690 \def\chapbreak{\dobreak \chapheadingskip {-4000}}
5691 \def\chappager{\par\vfill\supereject}
5692 % Because \domark is called before \chapoddpage, the filler page will
5693 % get the headings for the next chapter, which is wrong. But we don't
5694 % care -- we just disable all headings on the filler page.
5695 \def\chapoddpage{%
5696 \chappager
5697 \ifodd\pageno \else
5698 \begingroup
5699 \headingsoff
5700 \null
5701 \chappager
5702 \endgroup
5703 \fi
5704 }
5705
5706 \def\setchapternewpage #1 {\csname CHAPPAG#1\endcsname}
5707
5708 \def\CHAPPAGoff{%
5709 \global\let\contentsalignmacro = \chappager
5710 \global\let\pchapsepmacro=\chapbreak
5711 \global\let\pagealignmacro=\chappager}
5712
5713 \def\CHAPPAGon{%
5714 \global\let\contentsalignmacro = \chappager
5715 \global\let\pchapsepmacro=\chappager
5716 \global\let\pagealignmacro=\chappager
5717 \global\def\HEADINGSon{\HEADINGSsingle}}
5718
5719 \def\CHAPPAGodd{%
5720 \global\let\contentsalignmacro = \chapoddpage
5721 \global\let\pchapsepmacro=\chapoddpage
5722 \global\let\pagealignmacro=\chapoddpage
5723 \global\def\HEADINGSon{\HEADINGSdouble}}
5724
5725 \CHAPPAGon
5726
5727 % Chapter opening.
5728 %
5729 % #1 is the text, #2 is the section type (Ynumbered, Ynothing,
5730 % Yappendix, Yomitfromtoc), #3 the chapter number.
5731 %
5732 % To test against our argument.
5733 \def\Ynothingkeyword{Ynothing}
5734 \def\Yomitfromtockeyword{Yomitfromtoc}
5735 \def\Yappendixkeyword{Yappendix}
5736 %
5737 \def\chapmacro#1#2#3{%
5738 % Insert the first mark before the heading break (see notes for \domark).
5739 \let\prevchapterdefs=\lastchapterdefs
5740 \let\prevsectiondefs=\lastsectiondefs
5741 \gdef\lastsectiondefs{\gdef\thissectionname{}\gdef\thissectionnum{}%
5742 \gdef\thissection{}}%
5743 %
5744 \def\temptype{#2}%
5745 \ifx\temptype\Ynothingkeyword
5746 \gdef\lastchapterdefs{\gdef\thischaptername{#1}\gdef\thischapternum{}%
5747 \gdef\thischapter{\thischaptername}}%
5748 \else\ifx\temptype\Yomitfromtockeyword
5749 \gdef\lastchapterdefs{\gdef\thischaptername{#1}\gdef\thischapternum{}%
5750 \gdef\thischapter{}}%
5751 \else\ifx\temptype\Yappendixkeyword
5752 \toks0={#1}%
5753 \xdef\lastchapterdefs{%
5754 \gdef\noexpand\thischaptername{\the\toks0}%
5755 \gdef\noexpand\thischapternum{\appendixletter}%
5756 % \noexpand\putwordAppendix avoids expanding indigestible
5757 % commands in some of the translations.
5758 \gdef\noexpand\thischapter{\noexpand\putwordAppendix{}
5759 \noexpand\thischapternum:
5760 \noexpand\thischaptername}%
5761 }%
5762 \else
5763 \toks0={#1}%
5764 \xdef\lastchapterdefs{%
5765 \gdef\noexpand\thischaptername{\the\toks0}%
5766 \gdef\noexpand\thischapternum{\the\chapno}%
5767 % \noexpand\putwordChapter avoids expanding indigestible
5768 % commands in some of the translations.
5769 \gdef\noexpand\thischapter{\noexpand\putwordChapter{}
5770 \noexpand\thischapternum:
5771 \noexpand\thischaptername}%
5772 }%
5773 \fi\fi\fi
5774 %
5775 % Output the mark. Pass it through \safewhatsit, to take care of
5776 % the preceding space.
5777 \safewhatsit\domark
5778 %
5779 % Insert the chapter heading break.
5780 \pchapsepmacro
5781 %
5782 % Now the second mark, after the heading break. No break points
5783 % between here and the heading.
5784 \let\prevchapterdefs=\lastchapterdefs
5785 \let\prevsectiondefs=\lastsectiondefs
5786 \domark
5787 %
5788 {%
5789 \chapfonts \rmisbold
5790 %
5791 % Have to define \lastsection before calling \donoderef, because the
5792 % xref code eventually uses it. On the other hand, it has to be called
5793 % after \pchapsepmacro, or the headline will change too soon.
5794 \gdef\lastsection{#1}%
5795 %
5796 % Only insert the separating space if we have a chapter/appendix
5797 % number, and don't print the unnumbered ``number''.
5798 \ifx\temptype\Ynothingkeyword
5799 \setbox0 = \hbox{}%
5800 \def\toctype{unnchap}%
5801 \else\ifx\temptype\Yomitfromtockeyword
5802 \setbox0 = \hbox{}% contents like unnumbered, but no toc entry
5803 \def\toctype{omit}%
5804 \else\ifx\temptype\Yappendixkeyword
5805 \setbox0 = \hbox{\putwordAppendix{} #3\enspace}%
5806 \def\toctype{app}%
5807 \else
5808 \setbox0 = \hbox{#3\enspace}%
5809 \def\toctype{numchap}%
5810 \fi\fi\fi
5811 %
5812 % Write the toc entry for this chapter. Must come before the
5813 % \donoderef, because we include the current node name in the toc
5814 % entry, and \donoderef resets it to empty.
5815 \writetocentry{\toctype}{#1}{#3}%
5816 %
5817 % For pdftex, we have to write out the node definition (aka, make
5818 % the pdfdest) after any page break, but before the actual text has
5819 % been typeset. If the destination for the pdf outline is after the
5820 % text, then jumping from the outline may wind up with the text not
5821 % being visible, for instance under high magnification.
5822 \donoderef{#2}%
5823 %
5824 % Typeset the actual heading.
5825 \nobreak % Avoid page breaks at the interline glue.
5826 \vbox{\raggedtitlesettings \hangindent=\wd0 \centerparametersmaybe
5827 \unhbox0 #1\par}%
5828 }%
5829 \nobreak\bigskip % no page break after a chapter title
5830 \nobreak
5831 }
5832
5833 % @centerchap -- centered and unnumbered.
5834 \let\centerparametersmaybe = \relax
5835 \def\centerparameters{%
5836 \advance\rightskip by 3\rightskip
5837 \leftskip = \rightskip
5838 \parfillskip = 0pt
5839 }
5840
5841
5842 % I don't think this chapter style is supported any more, so I'm not
5843 % updating it with the new noderef stuff. We'll see. --karl, 11aug03.
5844 %
5845 \def\setchapterstyle #1 {\csname CHAPF#1\endcsname}
5846 %
5847 \def\unnchfopen #1{%
5848 \chapoddpage
5849 \vbox{\chapfonts \raggedtitlesettings #1\par}%
5850 \nobreak\bigskip\nobreak
5851 }
5852 \def\chfopen #1#2{\chapoddpage {\chapfonts
5853 \vbox to 3in{\vfil \hbox to\hsize{\hfil #2} \hbox to\hsize{\hfil #1} \vfil}}%
5854 \par\penalty 5000 %
5855 }
5856 \def\centerchfopen #1{%
5857 \chapoddpage
5858 \vbox{\chapfonts \raggedtitlesettings \hfill #1\hfill}%
5859 \nobreak\bigskip \nobreak
5860 }
5861 \def\CHAPFopen{%
5862 \global\let\chapmacro=\chfopen
5863 \global\let\centerchapmacro=\centerchfopen}
5864
5865
5866 % Section titles. These macros combine the section number parts and
5867 % call the generic \sectionheading to do the printing.
5868 %
5869 \newskip\secheadingskip
5870 \def\secheadingbreak{\dobreak \secheadingskip{-1000}}
5871
5872 % Subsection titles.
5873 \newskip\subsecheadingskip
5874 \def\subsecheadingbreak{\dobreak \subsecheadingskip{-500}}
5875
5876 % Subsubsection titles.
5877 \def\subsubsecheadingskip{\subsecheadingskip}
5878 \def\subsubsecheadingbreak{\subsecheadingbreak}
5879
5880
5881 % Print any size, any type, section title.
5882 %
5883 % #1 is the text, #2 is the section level (sec/subsec/subsubsec), #3 is
5884 % the section type for xrefs (Ynumbered, Ynothing, Yappendix), #4 is the
5885 % section number.
5886 %
5887 \def\seckeyword{sec}
5888 %
5889 \def\sectionheading#1#2#3#4{%
5890 {%
5891 \checkenv{}% should not be in an environment.
5892 %
5893 % Switch to the right set of fonts.
5894 \csname #2fonts\endcsname \rmisbold
5895 %
5896 \def\sectionlevel{#2}%
5897 \def\temptype{#3}%
5898 %
5899 % Insert first mark before the heading break (see notes for \domark).
5900 \let\prevsectiondefs=\lastsectiondefs
5901 \ifx\temptype\Ynothingkeyword
5902 \ifx\sectionlevel\seckeyword
5903 \gdef\lastsectiondefs{\gdef\thissectionname{#1}\gdef\thissectionnum{}%
5904 \gdef\thissection{\thissectionname}}%
5905 \fi
5906 \else\ifx\temptype\Yomitfromtockeyword
5907 % Don't redefine \thissection.
5908 \else\ifx\temptype\Yappendixkeyword
5909 \ifx\sectionlevel\seckeyword
5910 \toks0={#1}%
5911 \xdef\lastsectiondefs{%
5912 \gdef\noexpand\thissectionname{\the\toks0}%
5913 \gdef\noexpand\thissectionnum{#4}%
5914 % \noexpand\putwordSection avoids expanding indigestible
5915 % commands in some of the translations.
5916 \gdef\noexpand\thissection{\noexpand\putwordSection{}
5917 \noexpand\thissectionnum:
5918 \noexpand\thissectionname}%
5919 }%
5920 \fi
5921 \else
5922 \ifx\sectionlevel\seckeyword
5923 \toks0={#1}%
5924 \xdef\lastsectiondefs{%
5925 \gdef\noexpand\thissectionname{\the\toks0}%
5926 \gdef\noexpand\thissectionnum{#4}%
5927 % \noexpand\putwordSection avoids expanding indigestible
5928 % commands in some of the translations.
5929 \gdef\noexpand\thissection{\noexpand\putwordSection{}
5930 \noexpand\thissectionnum:
5931 \noexpand\thissectionname}%
5932 }%
5933 \fi
5934 \fi\fi\fi
5935 %
5936 % Go into vertical mode. Usually we'll already be there, but we
5937 % don't want the following whatsit to end up in a preceding paragraph
5938 % if the document didn't happen to have a blank line.
5939 \par
5940 %
5941 % Output the mark. Pass it through \safewhatsit, to take care of
5942 % the preceding space.
5943 \safewhatsit\domark
5944 %
5945 % Insert space above the heading.
5946 \csname #2headingbreak\endcsname
5947 %
5948 % Now the second mark, after the heading break. No break points
5949 % between here and the heading.
5950 \global\let\prevsectiondefs=\lastsectiondefs
5951 \domark
5952 %
5953 % Only insert the space after the number if we have a section number.
5954 \ifx\temptype\Ynothingkeyword
5955 \setbox0 = \hbox{}%
5956 \def\toctype{unn}%
5957 \gdef\lastsection{#1}%
5958 \else\ifx\temptype\Yomitfromtockeyword
5959 % for @headings -- no section number, don't include in toc,
5960 % and don't redefine \lastsection.
5961 \setbox0 = \hbox{}%
5962 \def\toctype{omit}%
5963 \let\sectionlevel=\empty
5964 \else\ifx\temptype\Yappendixkeyword
5965 \setbox0 = \hbox{#4\enspace}%
5966 \def\toctype{app}%
5967 \gdef\lastsection{#1}%
5968 \else
5969 \setbox0 = \hbox{#4\enspace}%
5970 \def\toctype{num}%
5971 \gdef\lastsection{#1}%
5972 \fi\fi\fi
5973 %
5974 % Write the toc entry (before \donoderef). See comments in \chapmacro.
5975 \writetocentry{\toctype\sectionlevel}{#1}{#4}%
5976 %
5977 % Write the node reference (= pdf destination for pdftex).
5978 % Again, see comments in \chapmacro.
5979 \donoderef{#3}%
5980 %
5981 % Interline glue will be inserted when the vbox is completed.
5982 % That glue will be a valid breakpoint for the page, since it'll be
5983 % preceded by a whatsit (usually from the \donoderef, or from the
5984 % \writetocentry if there was no node). We don't want to allow that
5985 % break, since then the whatsits could end up on page n while the
5986 % section is on page n+1, thus toc/etc. are wrong. Debian bug 276000.
5987 \nobreak
5988 %
5989 % Output the actual section heading.
5990 \vbox{\hyphenpenalty=10000 \tolerance=5000 \parindent=0pt \ptexraggedright
5991 \hangindent=\wd0 % zero if no section number
5992 \unhbox0 #1}%
5993 }%
5994 % Add extra space after the heading -- half of whatever came above it.
5995 % Don't allow stretch, though.
5996 \kern .5 \csname #2headingskip\endcsname
5997 %
5998 % Do not let the kern be a potential breakpoint, as it would be if it
5999 % was followed by glue.
6000 \nobreak
6001 %
6002 % We'll almost certainly start a paragraph next, so don't let that
6003 % glue accumulate. (Not a breakpoint because it's preceded by a
6004 % discardable item.) However, when a paragraph is not started next
6005 % (\startdefun, \cartouche, \center, etc.), this needs to be wiped out
6006 % or the negative glue will cause weirdly wrong output, typically
6007 % obscuring the section heading with something else.
6008 \vskip-\parskip
6009 %
6010 % This is so the last item on the main vertical list is a known
6011 % \penalty > 10000, so \startdefun, etc., can recognize the situation
6012 % and do the needful.
6013 \penalty 10001
6014 }
6015
6016
6017 \message{toc,}
6018 % Table of contents.
6019 \newwrite\tocfile
6020
6021 % Write an entry to the toc file, opening it if necessary.
6022 % Called from @chapter, etc.
6023 %
6024 % Example usage: \writetocentry{sec}{Section Name}{\the\chapno.\the\secno}
6025 % We append the current node name (if any) and page number as additional
6026 % arguments for the \{chap,sec,...}entry macros which will eventually
6027 % read this. The node name is used in the pdf outlines as the
6028 % destination to jump to.
6029 %
6030 % We open the .toc file for writing here instead of at @setfilename (or
6031 % any other fixed time) so that @contents can be anywhere in the document.
6032 % But if #1 is `omit', then we don't do anything. This is used for the
6033 % table of contents chapter openings themselves.
6034 %
6035 \newif\iftocfileopened
6036 \def\omitkeyword{omit}%
6037 %
6038 \def\writetocentry#1#2#3{%
6039 \edef\writetoctype{#1}%
6040 \ifx\writetoctype\omitkeyword \else
6041 \iftocfileopened\else
6042 \immediate\openout\tocfile = \jobname.toc
6043 \global\tocfileopenedtrue
6044 \fi
6045 %
6046 \iflinks
6047 {\atdummies
6048 \edef\temp{%
6049 \write\tocfile{@#1entry{#2}{#3}{\lastnode}{\noexpand\folio}}}%
6050 \temp
6051 }%
6052 \fi
6053 \fi
6054 %
6055 % Tell \shipout to create a pdf destination on each page, if we're
6056 % writing pdf. These are used in the table of contents. We can't
6057 % just write one on every page because the title pages are numbered
6058 % 1 and 2 (the page numbers aren't printed), and so are the first
6059 % two pages of the document. Thus, we'd have two destinations named
6060 % `1', and two named `2'.
6061 \ifpdf \global\pdfmakepagedesttrue \fi
6062 }
6063
6064
6065 % These characters do not print properly in the Computer Modern roman
6066 % fonts, so we must take special care. This is more or less redundant
6067 % with the Texinfo input format setup at the end of this file.
6068 %
6069 \def\activecatcodes{%
6070 \catcode`\"=\active
6071 \catcode`\$=\active
6072 \catcode`\<=\active
6073 \catcode`\>=\active
6074 \catcode`\\=\active
6075 \catcode`\^=\active
6076 \catcode`\_=\active
6077 \catcode`\|=\active
6078 \catcode`\~=\active
6079 }
6080
6081
6082 % Read the toc file, which is essentially Texinfo input.
6083 \def\readtocfile{%
6084 \setupdatafile
6085 \activecatcodes
6086 \input \tocreadfilename
6087 }
6088
6089 \newskip\contentsrightmargin \contentsrightmargin=1in
6090 \newcount\savepageno
6091 \newcount\lastnegativepageno \lastnegativepageno = -1
6092
6093 % Prepare to read what we've written to \tocfile.
6094 %
6095 \def\startcontents#1{%
6096 % If @setchapternewpage on, and @headings double, the contents should
6097 % start on an odd page, unlike chapters. Thus, we maintain
6098 % \contentsalignmacro in parallel with \pagealignmacro.
6099 % From: Torbjorn Granlund <tege@matematik.su.se>
6100 \contentsalignmacro
6101 \immediate\closeout\tocfile
6102 %
6103 % Don't need to put `Contents' or `Short Contents' in the headline.
6104 % It is abundantly clear what they are.
6105 \chapmacro{#1}{Yomitfromtoc}{}%
6106 %
6107 \savepageno = \pageno
6108 \begingroup % Set up to handle contents files properly.
6109 \raggedbottom % Worry more about breakpoints than the bottom.
6110 \advance\hsize by -\contentsrightmargin % Don't use the full line length.
6111 %
6112 % Roman numerals for page numbers.
6113 \ifnum \pageno>0 \global\pageno = \lastnegativepageno \fi
6114 }
6115
6116 % redefined for the two-volume lispref. We always output on
6117 % \jobname.toc even if this is redefined.
6118 %
6119 \def\tocreadfilename{\jobname.toc}
6120
6121 % Normal (long) toc.
6122 %
6123 \def\contents{%
6124 \startcontents{\putwordTOC}%
6125 \openin 1 \tocreadfilename\space
6126 \ifeof 1 \else
6127 \readtocfile
6128 \fi
6129 \vfill \eject
6130 \contentsalignmacro % in case @setchapternewpage odd is in effect
6131 \ifeof 1 \else
6132 \pdfmakeoutlines
6133 \fi
6134 \closein 1
6135 \endgroup
6136 \lastnegativepageno = \pageno
6137 \global\pageno = \savepageno
6138 }
6139
6140 % And just the chapters.
6141 \def\summarycontents{%
6142 \startcontents{\putwordShortTOC}%
6143 %
6144 \let\partentry = \shortpartentry
6145 \let\numchapentry = \shortchapentry
6146 \let\appentry = \shortchapentry
6147 \let\unnchapentry = \shortunnchapentry
6148 % We want a true roman here for the page numbers.
6149 \secfonts
6150 \let\rm=\shortcontrm \let\bf=\shortcontbf
6151 \let\sl=\shortcontsl \let\tt=\shortconttt
6152 \rm
6153 \hyphenpenalty = 10000
6154 \advance\baselineskip by 1pt % Open it up a little.
6155 \def\numsecentry##1##2##3##4{}
6156 \let\appsecentry = \numsecentry
6157 \let\unnsecentry = \numsecentry
6158 \let\numsubsecentry = \numsecentry
6159 \let\appsubsecentry = \numsecentry
6160 \let\unnsubsecentry = \numsecentry
6161 \let\numsubsubsecentry = \numsecentry
6162 \let\appsubsubsecentry = \numsecentry
6163 \let\unnsubsubsecentry = \numsecentry
6164 \openin 1 \tocreadfilename\space
6165 \ifeof 1 \else
6166 \readtocfile
6167 \fi
6168 \closein 1
6169 \vfill \eject
6170 \contentsalignmacro % in case @setchapternewpage odd is in effect
6171 \endgroup
6172 \lastnegativepageno = \pageno
6173 \global\pageno = \savepageno
6174 }
6175 \let\shortcontents = \summarycontents
6176
6177 % Typeset the label for a chapter or appendix for the short contents.
6178 % The arg is, e.g., `A' for an appendix, or `3' for a chapter.
6179 %
6180 \def\shortchaplabel#1{%
6181 % This space should be enough, since a single number is .5em, and the
6182 % widest letter (M) is 1em, at least in the Computer Modern fonts.
6183 % But use \hss just in case.
6184 % (This space doesn't include the extra space that gets added after
6185 % the label; that gets put in by \shortchapentry above.)
6186 %
6187 % We'd like to right-justify chapter numbers, but that looks strange
6188 % with appendix letters. And right-justifying numbers and
6189 % left-justifying letters looks strange when there is less than 10
6190 % chapters. Have to read the whole toc once to know how many chapters
6191 % there are before deciding ...
6192 \hbox to 1em{#1\hss}%
6193 }
6194
6195 % These macros generate individual entries in the table of contents.
6196 % The first argument is the chapter or section name.
6197 % The last argument is the page number.
6198 % The arguments in between are the chapter number, section number, ...
6199
6200 % Parts, in the main contents. Replace the part number, which doesn't
6201 % exist, with an empty box. Let's hope all the numbers have the same width.
6202 % Also ignore the page number, which is conventionally not printed.
6203 \def\numeralbox{\setbox0=\hbox{8}\hbox to \wd0{\hfil}}
6204 \def\partentry#1#2#3#4{\dochapentry{\numeralbox\labelspace#1}{}}
6205 %
6206 % Parts, in the short toc.
6207 \def\shortpartentry#1#2#3#4{%
6208 \penalty-300
6209 \vskip.5\baselineskip plus.15\baselineskip minus.1\baselineskip
6210 \shortchapentry{{\bf #1}}{\numeralbox}{}{}%
6211 }
6212
6213 % Chapters, in the main contents.
6214 \def\numchapentry#1#2#3#4{\dochapentry{#2\labelspace#1}{#4}}
6215 %
6216 % Chapters, in the short toc.
6217 % See comments in \dochapentry re vbox and related settings.
6218 \def\shortchapentry#1#2#3#4{%
6219 \tocentry{\shortchaplabel{#2}\labelspace #1}{\doshortpageno\bgroup#4\egroup}%
6220 }
6221
6222 % Appendices, in the main contents.
6223 % Need the word Appendix, and a fixed-size box.
6224 %
6225 \def\appendixbox#1{%
6226 % We use M since it's probably the widest letter.
6227 \setbox0 = \hbox{\putwordAppendix{} M}%
6228 \hbox to \wd0{\putwordAppendix{} #1\hss}}
6229 %
6230 \def\appentry#1#2#3#4{\dochapentry{\appendixbox{#2}\labelspace#1}{#4}}
6231
6232 % Unnumbered chapters.
6233 \def\unnchapentry#1#2#3#4{\dochapentry{#1}{#4}}
6234 \def\shortunnchapentry#1#2#3#4{\tocentry{#1}{\doshortpageno\bgroup#4\egroup}}
6235
6236 % Sections.
6237 \def\numsecentry#1#2#3#4{\dosecentry{#2\labelspace#1}{#4}}
6238 \let\appsecentry=\numsecentry
6239 \def\unnsecentry#1#2#3#4{\dosecentry{#1}{#4}}
6240
6241 % Subsections.
6242 \def\numsubsecentry#1#2#3#4{\dosubsecentry{#2\labelspace#1}{#4}}
6243 \let\appsubsecentry=\numsubsecentry
6244 \def\unnsubsecentry#1#2#3#4{\dosubsecentry{#1}{#4}}
6245
6246 % And subsubsections.
6247 \def\numsubsubsecentry#1#2#3#4{\dosubsubsecentry{#2\labelspace#1}{#4}}
6248 \let\appsubsubsecentry=\numsubsubsecentry
6249 \def\unnsubsubsecentry#1#2#3#4{\dosubsubsecentry{#1}{#4}}
6250
6251 % This parameter controls the indentation of the various levels.
6252 % Same as \defaultparindent.
6253 \newdimen\tocindent \tocindent = 15pt
6254
6255 % Now for the actual typesetting. In all these, #1 is the text and #2 is the
6256 % page number.
6257 %
6258 % If the toc has to be broken over pages, we want it to be at chapters
6259 % if at all possible; hence the \penalty.
6260 \def\dochapentry#1#2{%
6261 \penalty-300 \vskip1\baselineskip plus.33\baselineskip minus.25\baselineskip
6262 \begingroup
6263 \chapentryfonts
6264 \tocentry{#1}{\dopageno\bgroup#2\egroup}%
6265 \endgroup
6266 \nobreak\vskip .25\baselineskip plus.1\baselineskip
6267 }
6268
6269 \def\dosecentry#1#2{\begingroup
6270 \secentryfonts \leftskip=\tocindent
6271 \tocentry{#1}{\dopageno\bgroup#2\egroup}%
6272 \endgroup}
6273
6274 \def\dosubsecentry#1#2{\begingroup
6275 \subsecentryfonts \leftskip=2\tocindent
6276 \tocentry{#1}{\dopageno\bgroup#2\egroup}%
6277 \endgroup}
6278
6279 \def\dosubsubsecentry#1#2{\begingroup
6280 \subsubsecentryfonts \leftskip=3\tocindent
6281 \tocentry{#1}{\dopageno\bgroup#2\egroup}%
6282 \endgroup}
6283
6284 % We use the same \entry macro as for the index entries.
6285 \let\tocentry = \entry
6286
6287 % Space between chapter (or whatever) number and the title.
6288 \def\labelspace{\hskip1em \relax}
6289
6290 \def\dopageno#1{{\rm #1}}
6291 \def\doshortpageno#1{{\rm #1}}
6292
6293 \def\chapentryfonts{\secfonts \rm}
6294 \def\secentryfonts{\textfonts}
6295 \def\subsecentryfonts{\textfonts}
6296 \def\subsubsecentryfonts{\textfonts}
6297
6298
6299 \message{environments,}
6300 % @foo ... @end foo.
6301
6302 % @tex ... @end tex escapes into raw TeX temporarily.
6303 % One exception: @ is still an escape character, so that @end tex works.
6304 % But \@ or @@ will get a plain @ character.
6305
6306 \envdef\tex{%
6307 \setupmarkupstyle{tex}%
6308 \catcode `\\=0 \catcode `\{=1 \catcode `\}=2
6309 \catcode `\$=3 \catcode `\&=4 \catcode `\#=6
6310 \catcode `\^=7 \catcode `\_=8 \catcode `\~=\active \let~=\tie
6311 \catcode `\%=14
6312 \catcode `\+=\other
6313 \catcode `\"=\other
6314 \catcode `\|=\other
6315 \catcode `\<=\other
6316 \catcode `\>=\other
6317 \catcode `\`=\other
6318 \catcode `\'=\other
6319 \escapechar=`\\
6320 %
6321 % ' is active in math mode (mathcode"8000). So reset it, and all our
6322 % other math active characters (just in case), to plain's definitions.
6323 \mathactive
6324 %
6325 \let\b=\ptexb
6326 \let\bullet=\ptexbullet
6327 \let\c=\ptexc
6328 \let\,=\ptexcomma
6329 \let\.=\ptexdot
6330 \let\dots=\ptexdots
6331 \let\equiv=\ptexequiv
6332 \let\!=\ptexexclam
6333 \let\i=\ptexi
6334 \let\indent=\ptexindent
6335 \let\noindent=\ptexnoindent
6336 \let\{=\ptexlbrace
6337 \let\+=\tabalign
6338 \let\}=\ptexrbrace
6339 \let\/=\ptexslash
6340 \let\*=\ptexstar
6341 \let\t=\ptext
6342 \expandafter \let\csname top\endcsname=\ptextop % we've made it outer
6343 \let\frenchspacing=\plainfrenchspacing
6344 %
6345 \def\endldots{\mathinner{\ldots\ldots\ldots\ldots}}%
6346 \def\enddots{\relax\ifmmode\endldots\else$\mathsurround=0pt \endldots\,$\fi}%
6347 \def\@{@}%
6348 }
6349 % There is no need to define \Etex.
6350
6351 % Define @lisp ... @end lisp.
6352 % @lisp environment forms a group so it can rebind things,
6353 % including the definition of @end lisp (which normally is erroneous).
6354
6355 % Amount to narrow the margins by for @lisp.
6356 \newskip\lispnarrowing \lispnarrowing=0.4in
6357
6358 % This is the definition that ^^M gets inside @lisp, @example, and other
6359 % such environments. \null is better than a space, since it doesn't
6360 % have any width.
6361 \def\lisppar{\null\endgraf}
6362
6363 % This space is always present above and below environments.
6364 \newskip\envskipamount \envskipamount = 0pt
6365
6366 % Make spacing and below environment symmetrical. We use \parskip here
6367 % to help in doing that, since in @example-like environments \parskip
6368 % is reset to zero; thus the \afterenvbreak inserts no space -- but the
6369 % start of the next paragraph will insert \parskip.
6370 %
6371 \def\aboveenvbreak{{%
6372 % =10000 instead of <10000 because of a special case in \itemzzz and
6373 % \sectionheading, q.v.
6374 \ifnum \lastpenalty=10000 \else
6375 \advance\envskipamount by \parskip
6376 \endgraf
6377 \ifdim\lastskip<\envskipamount
6378 \removelastskip
6379 % it's not a good place to break if the last penalty was \nobreak
6380 % or better ...
6381 \ifnum\lastpenalty<10000 \penalty-50 \fi
6382 \vskip\envskipamount
6383 \fi
6384 \fi
6385 }}
6386
6387 \let\afterenvbreak = \aboveenvbreak
6388
6389 % \nonarrowing is a flag. If "set", @lisp etc don't narrow margins; it will
6390 % also clear it, so that its embedded environments do the narrowing again.
6391 \let\nonarrowing=\relax
6392
6393 % @cartouche ... @end cartouche: draw rectangle w/rounded corners around
6394 % environment contents.
6395 \font\circle=lcircle10
6396 \newdimen\circthick
6397 \newdimen\cartouter\newdimen\cartinner
6398 \newskip\normbskip\newskip\normpskip\newskip\normlskip
6399 \circthick=\fontdimen8\circle
6400 %
6401 \def\ctl{{\circle\char'013\hskip -6pt}}% 6pt from pl file: 1/2charwidth
6402 \def\ctr{{\hskip 6pt\circle\char'010}}
6403 \def\cbl{{\circle\char'012\hskip -6pt}}
6404 \def\cbr{{\hskip 6pt\circle\char'011}}
6405 \def\carttop{\hbox to \cartouter{\hskip\lskip
6406 \ctl\leaders\hrule height\circthick\hfil\ctr
6407 \hskip\rskip}}
6408 \def\cartbot{\hbox to \cartouter{\hskip\lskip
6409 \cbl\leaders\hrule height\circthick\hfil\cbr
6410 \hskip\rskip}}
6411 %
6412 \newskip\lskip\newskip\rskip
6413
6414 \envdef\cartouche{%
6415 \ifhmode\par\fi % can't be in the midst of a paragraph.
6416 \startsavinginserts
6417 \lskip=\leftskip \rskip=\rightskip
6418 \leftskip=0pt\rightskip=0pt % we want these *outside*.
6419 \cartinner=\hsize \advance\cartinner by-\lskip
6420 \advance\cartinner by-\rskip
6421 \cartouter=\hsize
6422 \advance\cartouter by 18.4pt % allow for 3pt kerns on either
6423 % side, and for 6pt waste from
6424 % each corner char, and rule thickness
6425 \normbskip=\baselineskip \normpskip=\parskip \normlskip=\lineskip
6426 %
6427 % If this cartouche directly follows a sectioning command, we need the
6428 % \parskip glue (backspaced over by default) or the cartouche can
6429 % collide with the section heading.
6430 \ifnum\lastpenalty>10000 \vskip\parskip \penalty\lastpenalty \fi
6431 %
6432 \vbox\bgroup
6433 \baselineskip=0pt\parskip=0pt\lineskip=0pt
6434 \carttop
6435 \hbox\bgroup
6436 \hskip\lskip
6437 \vrule\kern3pt
6438 \vbox\bgroup
6439 \kern3pt
6440 \hsize=\cartinner
6441 \baselineskip=\normbskip
6442 \lineskip=\normlskip
6443 \parskip=\normpskip
6444 \vskip -\parskip
6445 \comment % For explanation, see the end of def\group.
6446 }
6447 \def\Ecartouche{%
6448 \ifhmode\par\fi
6449 \kern3pt
6450 \egroup
6451 \kern3pt\vrule
6452 \hskip\rskip
6453 \egroup
6454 \cartbot
6455 \egroup
6456 \checkinserts
6457 }
6458
6459
6460 % This macro is called at the beginning of all the @example variants,
6461 % inside a group.
6462 \newdimen\nonfillparindent
6463 \def\nonfillstart{%
6464 \aboveenvbreak
6465 \ifdim\hfuzz < 12pt \hfuzz = 12pt \fi % Don't be fussy
6466 \sepspaces % Make spaces be word-separators rather than space tokens.
6467 \let\par = \lisppar % don't ignore blank lines
6468 \obeylines % each line of input is a line of output
6469 \parskip = 0pt
6470 % Turn off paragraph indentation but redefine \indent to emulate
6471 % the normal \indent.
6472 \nonfillparindent=\parindent
6473 \parindent = 0pt
6474 \let\indent\nonfillindent
6475 %
6476 \emergencystretch = 0pt % don't try to avoid overfull boxes
6477 \ifx\nonarrowing\relax
6478 \advance \leftskip by \lispnarrowing
6479 \exdentamount=\lispnarrowing
6480 \else
6481 \let\nonarrowing = \relax
6482 \fi
6483 \let\exdent=\nofillexdent
6484 }
6485
6486 \begingroup
6487 \obeyspaces
6488 % We want to swallow spaces (but not other tokens) after the fake
6489 % @indent in our nonfill-environments, where spaces are normally
6490 % active and set to @tie, resulting in them not being ignored after
6491 % @indent.
6492 \gdef\nonfillindent{\futurelet\temp\nonfillindentcheck}%
6493 \gdef\nonfillindentcheck{%
6494 \ifx\temp %
6495 \expandafter\nonfillindentgobble%
6496 \else%
6497 \leavevmode\nonfillindentbox%
6498 \fi%
6499 }%
6500 \endgroup
6501 \def\nonfillindentgobble#1{\nonfillindent}
6502 \def\nonfillindentbox{\hbox to \nonfillparindent{\hss}}
6503
6504 % If you want all examples etc. small: @set dispenvsize small.
6505 % If you want even small examples the full size: @set dispenvsize nosmall.
6506 % This affects the following displayed environments:
6507 % @example, @display, @format, @lisp
6508 %
6509 \def\smallword{small}
6510 \def\nosmallword{nosmall}
6511 \let\SETdispenvsize\relax
6512 \def\setnormaldispenv{%
6513 \ifx\SETdispenvsize\smallword
6514 % end paragraph for sake of leading, in case document has no blank
6515 % line. This is redundant with what happens in \aboveenvbreak, but
6516 % we need to do it before changing the fonts, and it's inconvenient
6517 % to change the fonts afterward.
6518 \ifnum \lastpenalty=10000 \else \endgraf \fi
6519 \smallexamplefonts \rm
6520 \fi
6521 }
6522 \def\setsmalldispenv{%
6523 \ifx\SETdispenvsize\nosmallword
6524 \else
6525 \ifnum \lastpenalty=10000 \else \endgraf \fi
6526 \smallexamplefonts \rm
6527 \fi
6528 }
6529
6530 % We often define two environments, @foo and @smallfoo.
6531 % Let's do it in one command. #1 is the env name, #2 the definition.
6532 \def\makedispenvdef#1#2{%
6533 \expandafter\envdef\csname#1\endcsname {\setnormaldispenv #2}%
6534 \expandafter\envdef\csname small#1\endcsname {\setsmalldispenv #2}%
6535 \expandafter\let\csname E#1\endcsname \afterenvbreak
6536 \expandafter\let\csname Esmall#1\endcsname \afterenvbreak
6537 }
6538
6539 % Define two environment synonyms (#1 and #2) for an environment.
6540 \def\maketwodispenvdef#1#2#3{%
6541 \makedispenvdef{#1}{#3}%
6542 \makedispenvdef{#2}{#3}%
6543 }
6544 %
6545 % @lisp: indented, narrowed, typewriter font;
6546 % @example: same as @lisp.
6547 %
6548 % @smallexample and @smalllisp: use smaller fonts.
6549 % Originally contributed by Pavel@xerox.
6550 %
6551 \maketwodispenvdef{lisp}{example}{%
6552 \nonfillstart
6553 \tt\setupmarkupstyle{example}%
6554 \let\kbdfont = \kbdexamplefont % Allow @kbd to do something special.
6555 \gobble % eat return
6556 }
6557 % @display/@smalldisplay: same as @lisp except keep current font.
6558 %
6559 \makedispenvdef{display}{%
6560 \nonfillstart
6561 \gobble
6562 }
6563
6564 % @format/@smallformat: same as @display except don't narrow margins.
6565 %
6566 \makedispenvdef{format}{%
6567 \let\nonarrowing = t%
6568 \nonfillstart
6569 \gobble
6570 }
6571
6572 % @flushleft: same as @format, but doesn't obey \SETdispenvsize.
6573 \envdef\flushleft{%
6574 \let\nonarrowing = t%
6575 \nonfillstart
6576 \gobble
6577 }
6578 \let\Eflushleft = \afterenvbreak
6579
6580 % @flushright.
6581 %
6582 \envdef\flushright{%
6583 \let\nonarrowing = t%
6584 \nonfillstart
6585 \advance\leftskip by 0pt plus 1fill\relax
6586 \gobble
6587 }
6588 \let\Eflushright = \afterenvbreak
6589
6590
6591 % @raggedright does more-or-less normal line breaking but no right
6592 % justification. From plain.tex. Don't stretch around special
6593 % characters in urls in this environment, since the stretch at the right
6594 % should be enough.
6595 \envdef\raggedright{%
6596 \rightskip0pt plus2.4em \spaceskip.3333em \xspaceskip.5em\relax
6597 \def\urefprestretchamount{0pt}%
6598 \def\urefpoststretchamount{0pt}%
6599 }
6600 \let\Eraggedright\par
6601
6602 \envdef\raggedleft{%
6603 \parindent=0pt \leftskip0pt plus2em
6604 \spaceskip.3333em \xspaceskip.5em \parfillskip=0pt
6605 \hbadness=10000 % Last line will usually be underfull, so turn off
6606 % badness reporting.
6607 }
6608 \let\Eraggedleft\par
6609
6610 \envdef\raggedcenter{%
6611 \parindent=0pt \rightskip0pt plus1em \leftskip0pt plus1em
6612 \spaceskip.3333em \xspaceskip.5em \parfillskip=0pt
6613 \hbadness=10000 % Last line will usually be underfull, so turn off
6614 % badness reporting.
6615 }
6616 \let\Eraggedcenter\par
6617
6618
6619 % @quotation does normal linebreaking (hence we can't use \nonfillstart)
6620 % and narrows the margins. We keep \parskip nonzero in general, since
6621 % we're doing normal filling. So, when using \aboveenvbreak and
6622 % \afterenvbreak, temporarily make \parskip 0.
6623 %
6624 \makedispenvdef{quotation}{\quotationstart}
6625 %
6626 \def\quotationstart{%
6627 \indentedblockstart % same as \indentedblock, but increase right margin too.
6628 \ifx\nonarrowing\relax
6629 \advance\rightskip by \lispnarrowing
6630 \fi
6631 \parsearg\quotationlabel
6632 }
6633
6634 % We have retained a nonzero parskip for the environment, since we're
6635 % doing normal filling.
6636 %
6637 \def\Equotation{%
6638 \par
6639 \ifx\quotationauthor\thisisundefined\else
6640 % indent a bit.
6641 \leftline{\kern 2\leftskip \sl ---\quotationauthor}%
6642 \fi
6643 {\parskip=0pt \afterenvbreak}%
6644 }
6645 \def\Esmallquotation{\Equotation}
6646
6647 % If we're given an argument, typeset it in bold with a colon after.
6648 \def\quotationlabel#1{%
6649 \def\temp{#1}%
6650 \ifx\temp\empty \else
6651 {\bf #1: }%
6652 \fi
6653 }
6654
6655 % @indentedblock is like @quotation, but indents only on the left and
6656 % has no optional argument.
6657 %
6658 \makedispenvdef{indentedblock}{\indentedblockstart}
6659 %
6660 \def\indentedblockstart{%
6661 {\parskip=0pt \aboveenvbreak}% because \aboveenvbreak inserts \parskip
6662 \parindent=0pt
6663 %
6664 % @cartouche defines \nonarrowing to inhibit narrowing at next level down.
6665 \ifx\nonarrowing\relax
6666 \advance\leftskip by \lispnarrowing
6667 \exdentamount = \lispnarrowing
6668 \else
6669 \let\nonarrowing = \relax
6670 \fi
6671 }
6672
6673 % Keep a nonzero parskip for the environment, since we're doing normal filling.
6674 %
6675 \def\Eindentedblock{%
6676 \par
6677 {\parskip=0pt \afterenvbreak}%
6678 }
6679 \def\Esmallindentedblock{\Eindentedblock}
6680
6681
6682 % LaTeX-like @verbatim...@end verbatim and @verb{<char>...<char>}
6683 % If we want to allow any <char> as delimiter,
6684 % we need the curly braces so that makeinfo sees the @verb command, eg:
6685 % `@verbx...x' would look like the '@verbx' command. --janneke@gnu.org
6686 %
6687 % [Knuth]: Donald Ervin Knuth, 1996. The TeXbook.
6688 %
6689 % [Knuth] p.344; only we need to do the other characters Texinfo sets
6690 % active too. Otherwise, they get lost as the first character on a
6691 % verbatim line.
6692 \def\dospecials{%
6693 \do\ \do\\\do\{\do\}\do\$\do\&%
6694 \do\#\do\^\do\^^K\do\_\do\^^A\do\%\do\~%
6695 \do\<\do\>\do\|\do\@\do+\do\"%
6696 % Don't do the quotes -- if we do, @set txicodequoteundirected and
6697 % @set txicodequotebacktick will not have effect on @verb and
6698 % @verbatim, and ?` and !` ligatures won't get disabled.
6699 %\do\`\do\'%
6700 }
6701 %
6702 % [Knuth] p. 380
6703 \def\uncatcodespecials{%
6704 \def\do##1{\catcode`##1=\other}\dospecials}
6705 %
6706 % Setup for the @verb command.
6707 %
6708 % Eight spaces for a tab
6709 \begingroup
6710 \catcode`\^^I=\active
6711 \gdef\tabeightspaces{\catcode`\^^I=\active\def^^I{\ \ \ \ \ \ \ \ }}
6712 \endgroup
6713 %
6714 \def\setupverb{%
6715 \tt % easiest (and conventionally used) font for verbatim
6716 \def\par{\leavevmode\endgraf}%
6717 \setupmarkupstyle{verb}%
6718 \tabeightspaces
6719 % Respect line breaks,
6720 % print special symbols as themselves, and
6721 % make each space count
6722 % must do in this order:
6723 \obeylines \uncatcodespecials \sepspaces
6724 }
6725
6726 % Setup for the @verbatim environment
6727 %
6728 % Real tab expansion.
6729 \newdimen\tabw \setbox0=\hbox{\tt\space} \tabw=8\wd0 % tab amount
6730 %
6731 % We typeset each line of the verbatim in an \hbox, so we can handle
6732 % tabs. The \global is in case the verbatim line starts with an accent,
6733 % or some other command that starts with a begin-group. Otherwise, the
6734 % entire \verbbox would disappear at the corresponding end-group, before
6735 % it is typeset. Meanwhile, we can't have nested verbatim commands
6736 % (can we?), so the \global won't be overwriting itself.
6737 \newbox\verbbox
6738 \def\starttabbox{\global\setbox\verbbox=\hbox\bgroup}
6739 %
6740 \begingroup
6741 \catcode`\^^I=\active
6742 \gdef\tabexpand{%
6743 \catcode`\^^I=\active
6744 \def^^I{\leavevmode\egroup
6745 \dimen\verbbox=\wd\verbbox % the width so far, or since the previous tab
6746 \divide\dimen\verbbox by\tabw
6747 \multiply\dimen\verbbox by\tabw % compute previous multiple of \tabw
6748 \advance\dimen\verbbox by\tabw % advance to next multiple of \tabw
6749 \wd\verbbox=\dimen\verbbox \box\verbbox \starttabbox
6750 }%
6751 }
6752 \endgroup
6753
6754 % start the verbatim environment.
6755 \def\setupverbatim{%
6756 \let\nonarrowing = t%
6757 \nonfillstart
6758 \tt % easiest (and conventionally used) font for verbatim
6759 % The \leavevmode here is for blank lines. Otherwise, we would
6760 % never \starttabox and the \egroup would end verbatim mode.
6761 \def\par{\leavevmode\egroup\box\verbbox\endgraf}%
6762 \tabexpand
6763 \setupmarkupstyle{verbatim}%
6764 % Respect line breaks,
6765 % print special symbols as themselves, and
6766 % make each space count.
6767 % Must do in this order:
6768 \obeylines \uncatcodespecials \sepspaces
6769 \everypar{\starttabbox}%
6770 }
6771
6772 % Do the @verb magic: verbatim text is quoted by unique
6773 % delimiter characters. Before first delimiter expect a
6774 % right brace, after last delimiter expect closing brace:
6775 %
6776 % \def\doverb'{'<char>#1<char>'}'{#1}
6777 %
6778 % [Knuth] p. 382; only eat outer {}
6779 \begingroup
6780 \catcode`[=1\catcode`]=2\catcode`\{=\other\catcode`\}=\other
6781 \gdef\doverb{#1[\def\next##1#1}[##1\endgroup]\next]
6782 \endgroup
6783 %
6784 \def\verb{\begingroup\setupverb\doverb}
6785 %
6786 %
6787 % Do the @verbatim magic: define the macro \doverbatim so that
6788 % the (first) argument ends when '@end verbatim' is reached, ie:
6789 %
6790 % \def\doverbatim#1@end verbatim{#1}
6791 %
6792 % For Texinfo it's a lot easier than for LaTeX,
6793 % because texinfo's \verbatim doesn't stop at '\end{verbatim}':
6794 % we need not redefine '\', '{' and '}'.
6795 %
6796 % Inspired by LaTeX's verbatim command set [latex.ltx]
6797 %
6798 \begingroup
6799 \catcode`\ =\active
6800 \obeylines %
6801 % ignore everything up to the first ^^M, that's the newline at the end
6802 % of the @verbatim input line itself. Otherwise we get an extra blank
6803 % line in the output.
6804 \xdef\doverbatim#1^^M#2@end verbatim{#2\noexpand\end\gobble verbatim}%
6805 % We really want {...\end verbatim} in the body of the macro, but
6806 % without the active space; thus we have to use \xdef and \gobble.
6807 \endgroup
6808 %
6809 \envdef\verbatim{%
6810 \setupverbatim\doverbatim
6811 }
6812 \let\Everbatim = \afterenvbreak
6813
6814
6815 % @verbatiminclude FILE - insert text of file in verbatim environment.
6816 %
6817 \def\verbatiminclude{\parseargusing\filenamecatcodes\doverbatiminclude}
6818 %
6819 \def\doverbatiminclude#1{%
6820 {%
6821 \makevalueexpandable
6822 \setupverbatim
6823 \indexnofonts % Allow `@@' and other weird things in file names.
6824 \wlog{texinfo.tex: doing @verbatiminclude of #1^^J}%
6825 \input #1
6826 \afterenvbreak
6827 }%
6828 }
6829
6830 % @copying ... @end copying.
6831 % Save the text away for @insertcopying later.
6832 %
6833 % We save the uninterpreted tokens, rather than creating a box.
6834 % Saving the text in a box would be much easier, but then all the
6835 % typesetting commands (@smallbook, font changes, etc.) have to be done
6836 % beforehand -- and a) we want @copying to be done first in the source
6837 % file; b) letting users define the frontmatter in as flexible order as
6838 % possible is very desirable.
6839 %
6840 \def\copying{\checkenv{}\begingroup\scanargctxt\docopying}
6841 \def\docopying#1@end copying{\endgroup\def\copyingtext{#1}}
6842 %
6843 \def\insertcopying{%
6844 \begingroup
6845 \parindent = 0pt % paragraph indentation looks wrong on title page
6846 \scanexp\copyingtext
6847 \endgroup
6848 }
6849
6850
6851 \message{defuns,}
6852 % @defun etc.
6853
6854 \newskip\defbodyindent \defbodyindent=.4in
6855 \newskip\defargsindent \defargsindent=50pt
6856 \newskip\deflastargmargin \deflastargmargin=18pt
6857 \newcount\defunpenalty
6858
6859 % Start the processing of @deffn:
6860 \def\startdefun{%
6861 \ifnum\lastpenalty<10000
6862 \medbreak
6863 \defunpenalty=10003 % Will keep this @deffn together with the
6864 % following @def command, see below.
6865 \else
6866 % If there are two @def commands in a row, we'll have a \nobreak,
6867 % which is there to keep the function description together with its
6868 % header. But if there's nothing but headers, we need to allow a
6869 % break somewhere. Check specifically for penalty 10002, inserted
6870 % by \printdefunline, instead of 10000, since the sectioning
6871 % commands also insert a nobreak penalty, and we don't want to allow
6872 % a break between a section heading and a defun.
6873 %
6874 % As a further refinement, we avoid "club" headers by signalling
6875 % with penalty of 10003 after the very first @deffn in the
6876 % sequence (see above), and penalty of 10002 after any following
6877 % @def command.
6878 \ifnum\lastpenalty=10002 \penalty2000 \else \defunpenalty=10002 \fi
6879 %
6880 % Similarly, after a section heading, do not allow a break.
6881 % But do insert the glue.
6882 \medskip % preceded by discardable penalty, so not a breakpoint
6883 \fi
6884 %
6885 \parindent=0in
6886 \advance\leftskip by \defbodyindent
6887 \exdentamount=\defbodyindent
6888 }
6889
6890 \def\dodefunx#1{%
6891 % First, check whether we are in the right environment:
6892 \checkenv#1%
6893 %
6894 % As above, allow line break if we have multiple x headers in a row.
6895 % It's not a great place, though.
6896 \ifnum\lastpenalty=10002 \penalty3000 \else \defunpenalty=10002 \fi
6897 %
6898 % And now, it's time to reuse the body of the original defun:
6899 \expandafter\gobbledefun#1%
6900 }
6901 \def\gobbledefun#1\startdefun{}
6902
6903 % \printdefunline \deffnheader{text}
6904 %
6905 \def\printdefunline#1#2{%
6906 \begingroup
6907 % call \deffnheader:
6908 #1#2 \endheader
6909 % common ending:
6910 \interlinepenalty = 10000
6911 \advance\rightskip by 0pt plus 1fil\relax
6912 \endgraf
6913 \nobreak\vskip -\parskip
6914 \penalty\defunpenalty % signal to \startdefun and \dodefunx
6915 % Some of the @defun-type tags do not enable magic parentheses,
6916 % rendering the following check redundant. But we don't optimize.
6917 \checkparencounts
6918 \endgroup
6919 }
6920
6921 \def\Edefun{\endgraf\medbreak}
6922
6923 % \makedefun{deffn} creates \deffn, \deffnx and \Edeffn;
6924 % the only thing remaining is to define \deffnheader.
6925 %
6926 \def\makedefun#1{%
6927 \expandafter\let\csname E#1\endcsname = \Edefun
6928 \edef\temp{\noexpand\domakedefun
6929 \makecsname{#1}\makecsname{#1x}\makecsname{#1header}}%
6930 \temp
6931 }
6932
6933 % \domakedefun \deffn \deffnx \deffnheader
6934 %
6935 % Define \deffn and \deffnx, without parameters.
6936 % \deffnheader has to be defined explicitly.
6937 %
6938 \def\domakedefun#1#2#3{%
6939 \envdef#1{%
6940 \startdefun
6941 \doingtypefnfalse % distinguish typed functions from all else
6942 \parseargusing\activeparens{\printdefunline#3}%
6943 }%
6944 \def#2{\dodefunx#1}%
6945 \def#3%
6946 }
6947
6948 \newif\ifdoingtypefn % doing typed function?
6949 \newif\ifrettypeownline % typeset return type on its own line?
6950
6951 % @deftypefnnewline on|off says whether the return type of typed functions
6952 % are printed on their own line. This affects @deftypefn, @deftypefun,
6953 % @deftypeop, and @deftypemethod.
6954 %
6955 \parseargdef\deftypefnnewline{%
6956 \def\temp{#1}%
6957 \ifx\temp\onword
6958 \expandafter\let\csname SETtxideftypefnnl\endcsname
6959 = \empty
6960 \else\ifx\temp\offword
6961 \expandafter\let\csname SETtxideftypefnnl\endcsname
6962 = \relax
6963 \else
6964 \errhelp = \EMsimple
6965 \errmessage{Unknown @txideftypefnnl value `\temp',
6966 must be on|off}%
6967 \fi\fi
6968 }
6969
6970 % Untyped functions:
6971
6972 % @deffn category name args
6973 \makedefun{deffn}{\deffngeneral{}}
6974
6975 % @deffn category class name args
6976 \makedefun{defop}#1 {\defopon{#1\ \putwordon}}
6977
6978 % \defopon {category on}class name args
6979 \def\defopon#1#2 {\deffngeneral{\putwordon\ \code{#2}}{#1\ \code{#2}} }
6980
6981 % \deffngeneral {subind}category name args
6982 %
6983 \def\deffngeneral#1#2 #3 #4\endheader{%
6984 % Remember that \dosubind{fn}{foo}{} is equivalent to \doind{fn}{foo}.
6985 \dosubind{fn}{\code{#3}}{#1}%
6986 \defname{#2}{}{#3}\magicamp\defunargs{#4\unskip}%
6987 }
6988
6989 % Typed functions:
6990
6991 % @deftypefn category type name args
6992 \makedefun{deftypefn}{\deftypefngeneral{}}
6993
6994 % @deftypeop category class type name args
6995 \makedefun{deftypeop}#1 {\deftypeopon{#1\ \putwordon}}
6996
6997 % \deftypeopon {category on}class type name args
6998 \def\deftypeopon#1#2 {\deftypefngeneral{\putwordon\ \code{#2}}{#1\ \code{#2}} }
6999
7000 % \deftypefngeneral {subind}category type name args
7001 %
7002 \def\deftypefngeneral#1#2 #3 #4 #5\endheader{%
7003 \dosubind{fn}{\code{#4}}{#1}%
7004 \doingtypefntrue
7005 \defname{#2}{#3}{#4}\defunargs{#5\unskip}%
7006 }
7007
7008 % Typed variables:
7009
7010 % @deftypevr category type var args
7011 \makedefun{deftypevr}{\deftypecvgeneral{}}
7012
7013 % @deftypecv category class type var args
7014 \makedefun{deftypecv}#1 {\deftypecvof{#1\ \putwordof}}
7015
7016 % \deftypecvof {category of}class type var args
7017 \def\deftypecvof#1#2 {\deftypecvgeneral{\putwordof\ \code{#2}}{#1\ \code{#2}} }
7018
7019 % \deftypecvgeneral {subind}category type var args
7020 %
7021 \def\deftypecvgeneral#1#2 #3 #4 #5\endheader{%
7022 \dosubind{vr}{\code{#4}}{#1}%
7023 \defname{#2}{#3}{#4}\defunargs{#5\unskip}%
7024 }
7025
7026 % Untyped variables:
7027
7028 % @defvr category var args
7029 \makedefun{defvr}#1 {\deftypevrheader{#1} {} }
7030
7031 % @defcv category class var args
7032 \makedefun{defcv}#1 {\defcvof{#1\ \putwordof}}
7033
7034 % \defcvof {category of}class var args
7035 \def\defcvof#1#2 {\deftypecvof{#1}#2 {} }
7036
7037 % Types:
7038
7039 % @deftp category name args
7040 \makedefun{deftp}#1 #2 #3\endheader{%
7041 \doind{tp}{\code{#2}}%
7042 \defname{#1}{}{#2}\defunargs{#3\unskip}%
7043 }
7044
7045 % Remaining @defun-like shortcuts:
7046 \makedefun{defun}{\deffnheader{\putwordDeffunc} }
7047 \makedefun{defmac}{\deffnheader{\putwordDefmac} }
7048 \makedefun{defspec}{\deffnheader{\putwordDefspec} }
7049 \makedefun{deftypefun}{\deftypefnheader{\putwordDeffunc} }
7050 \makedefun{defvar}{\defvrheader{\putwordDefvar} }
7051 \makedefun{defopt}{\defvrheader{\putwordDefopt} }
7052 \makedefun{deftypevar}{\deftypevrheader{\putwordDefvar} }
7053 \makedefun{defmethod}{\defopon\putwordMethodon}
7054 \makedefun{deftypemethod}{\deftypeopon\putwordMethodon}
7055 \makedefun{defivar}{\defcvof\putwordInstanceVariableof}
7056 \makedefun{deftypeivar}{\deftypecvof\putwordInstanceVariableof}
7057
7058 % \defname, which formats the name of the @def (not the args).
7059 % #1 is the category, such as "Function".
7060 % #2 is the return type, if any.
7061 % #3 is the function name.
7062 %
7063 % We are followed by (but not passed) the arguments, if any.
7064 %
7065 \def\defname#1#2#3{%
7066 \par
7067 % Get the values of \leftskip and \rightskip as they were outside the @def...
7068 \advance\leftskip by -\defbodyindent
7069 %
7070 % Determine if we are typesetting the return type of a typed function
7071 % on a line by itself.
7072 \rettypeownlinefalse
7073 \ifdoingtypefn % doing a typed function specifically?
7074 % then check user option for putting return type on its own line:
7075 \expandafter\ifx\csname SETtxideftypefnnl\endcsname\relax \else
7076 \rettypeownlinetrue
7077 \fi
7078 \fi
7079 %
7080 % How we'll format the category name. Putting it in brackets helps
7081 % distinguish it from the body text that may end up on the next line
7082 % just below it.
7083 \def\temp{#1}%
7084 \setbox0=\hbox{\kern\deflastargmargin \ifx\temp\empty\else [\rm\temp]\fi}
7085 %
7086 % Figure out line sizes for the paragraph shape. We'll always have at
7087 % least two.
7088 \tempnum = 2
7089 %
7090 % The first line needs space for \box0; but if \rightskip is nonzero,
7091 % we need only space for the part of \box0 which exceeds it:
7092 \dimen0=\hsize \advance\dimen0 by -\wd0 \advance\dimen0 by \rightskip
7093 %
7094 % If doing a return type on its own line, we'll have another line.
7095 \ifrettypeownline
7096 \advance\tempnum by 1
7097 \def\maybeshapeline{0in \hsize}%
7098 \else
7099 \def\maybeshapeline{}%
7100 \fi
7101 %
7102 % The continuations:
7103 \dimen2=\hsize \advance\dimen2 by -\defargsindent
7104 %
7105 % The final paragraph shape:
7106 \parshape \tempnum 0in \dimen0 \maybeshapeline \defargsindent \dimen2
7107 %
7108 % Put the category name at the right margin.
7109 \noindent
7110 \hbox to 0pt{%
7111 \hfil\box0 \kern-\hsize
7112 % \hsize has to be shortened this way:
7113 \kern\leftskip
7114 % Intentionally do not respect \rightskip, since we need the space.
7115 }%
7116 %
7117 % Allow all lines to be underfull without complaint:
7118 \tolerance=10000 \hbadness=10000
7119 \exdentamount=\defbodyindent
7120 {%
7121 % defun fonts. We use typewriter by default (used to be bold) because:
7122 % . we're printing identifiers, they should be in tt in principle.
7123 % . in languages with many accents, such as Czech or French, it's
7124 % common to leave accents off identifiers. The result looks ok in
7125 % tt, but exceedingly strange in rm.
7126 % . we don't want -- and --- to be treated as ligatures.
7127 % . this still does not fix the ?` and !` ligatures, but so far no
7128 % one has made identifiers using them :).
7129 \df \tt
7130 \def\temp{#2}% text of the return type
7131 \ifx\temp\empty\else
7132 \tclose{\temp}% typeset the return type
7133 \ifrettypeownline
7134 % put return type on its own line; prohibit line break following:
7135 \hfil\vadjust{\nobreak}\break
7136 \else
7137 \space % type on same line, so just followed by a space
7138 \fi
7139 \fi % no return type
7140 #3% output function name
7141 }%
7142 {\rm\enskip}% hskip 0.5 em of \tenrm
7143 %
7144 \boldbrax
7145 % arguments will be output next, if any.
7146 }
7147
7148 % Print arguments in slanted roman (not ttsl), inconsistently with using
7149 % tt for the name. This is because literal text is sometimes needed in
7150 % the argument list (groff manual), and ttsl and tt are not very
7151 % distinguishable. Prevent hyphenation at `-' chars.
7152 %
7153 \def\defunargs#1{%
7154 % use sl by default (not ttsl),
7155 % tt for the names.
7156 \df \sl \hyphenchar\font=0
7157 %
7158 % On the other hand, if an argument has two dashes (for instance), we
7159 % want a way to get ttsl. We used to recommend @var for that, so
7160 % leave the code in, but it's strange for @var to lead to typewriter.
7161 % Nowadays we recommend @code, since the difference between a ttsl hyphen
7162 % and a tt hyphen is pretty tiny. @code also disables ?` !`.
7163 \def\var##1{{\setupmarkupstyle{var}\ttslanted{##1}}}%
7164 #1%
7165 \sl\hyphenchar\font=45
7166 }
7167
7168 % We want ()&[] to print specially on the defun line.
7169 %
7170 \def\activeparens{%
7171 \catcode`\(=\active \catcode`\)=\active
7172 \catcode`\[=\active \catcode`\]=\active
7173 \catcode`\&=\active
7174 }
7175
7176 % Make control sequences which act like normal parenthesis chars.
7177 \let\lparen = ( \let\rparen = )
7178
7179 % Be sure that we always have a definition for `(', etc. For example,
7180 % if the fn name has parens in it, \boldbrax will not be in effect yet,
7181 % so TeX would otherwise complain about undefined control sequence.
7182 {
7183 \activeparens
7184 \global\let(=\lparen \global\let)=\rparen
7185 \global\let[=\lbrack \global\let]=\rbrack
7186 \global\let& = \&
7187
7188 \gdef\boldbrax{\let(=\opnr\let)=\clnr\let[=\lbrb\let]=\rbrb}
7189 \gdef\magicamp{\let&=\amprm}
7190 }
7191
7192 \newcount\parencount
7193
7194 % If we encounter &foo, then turn on ()-hacking afterwards
7195 \newif\ifampseen
7196 \def\amprm#1 {\ampseentrue{\bf\&#1 }}
7197
7198 \def\parenfont{%
7199 \ifampseen
7200 % At the first level, print parens in roman,
7201 % otherwise use the default font.
7202 \ifnum \parencount=1 \rm \fi
7203 \else
7204 % The \sf parens (in \boldbrax) actually are a little bolder than
7205 % the contained text. This is especially needed for [ and ] .
7206 \sf
7207 \fi
7208 }
7209 \def\infirstlevel#1{%
7210 \ifampseen
7211 \ifnum\parencount=1
7212 #1%
7213 \fi
7214 \fi
7215 }
7216 \def\bfafterword#1 {#1 \bf}
7217
7218 \def\opnr{%
7219 \global\advance\parencount by 1
7220 {\parenfont(}%
7221 \infirstlevel \bfafterword
7222 }
7223 \def\clnr{%
7224 {\parenfont)}%
7225 \infirstlevel \sl
7226 \global\advance\parencount by -1
7227 }
7228
7229 \newcount\brackcount
7230 \def\lbrb{%
7231 \global\advance\brackcount by 1
7232 {\bf[}%
7233 }
7234 \def\rbrb{%
7235 {\bf]}%
7236 \global\advance\brackcount by -1
7237 }
7238
7239 \def\checkparencounts{%
7240 \ifnum\parencount=0 \else \badparencount \fi
7241 \ifnum\brackcount=0 \else \badbrackcount \fi
7242 }
7243 % these should not use \errmessage; the glibc manual, at least, actually
7244 % has such constructs (when documenting function pointers).
7245 \def\badparencount{%
7246 \message{Warning: unbalanced parentheses in @def...}%
7247 \global\parencount=0
7248 }
7249 \def\badbrackcount{%
7250 \message{Warning: unbalanced square brackets in @def...}%
7251 \global\brackcount=0
7252 }
7253
7254
7255 \message{macros,}
7256 % @macro.
7257
7258 % To do this right we need a feature of e-TeX, \scantokens,
7259 % which we arrange to emulate with a temporary file in ordinary TeX.
7260 \ifx\eTeXversion\thisisundefined
7261 \newwrite\macscribble
7262 \def\scantokens#1{%
7263 \toks0={#1}%
7264 \immediate\openout\macscribble=\jobname.tmp
7265 \immediate\write\macscribble{\the\toks0}%
7266 \immediate\closeout\macscribble
7267 \input \jobname.tmp
7268 }
7269 \fi
7270
7271 \def\scanmacro#1{\begingroup
7272 \newlinechar`\^^M
7273 \let\xeatspaces\eatspaces
7274 %
7275 % Undo catcode changes of \startcontents and \doprintindex
7276 % When called from @insertcopying or (short)caption, we need active
7277 % backslash to get it printed correctly. Previously, we had
7278 % \catcode`\\=\other instead. We'll see whether a problem appears
7279 % with macro expansion. --kasal, 19aug04
7280 \catcode`\@=0 \catcode`\\=\active \escapechar=`\@
7281 %
7282 % ... and for \example:
7283 \spaceisspace
7284 %
7285 % The \empty here causes a following catcode 5 newline to be eaten as
7286 % part of reading whitespace after a control sequence. It does not
7287 % eat a catcode 13 newline. There's no good way to handle the two
7288 % cases (untried: maybe e-TeX's \everyeof could help, though plain TeX
7289 % would then have different behavior). See the Macro Details node in
7290 % the manual for the workaround we recommend for macros and
7291 % line-oriented commands.
7292 %
7293 \scantokens{#1\empty}%
7294 \endgroup}
7295
7296 \def\scanexp#1{%
7297 \edef\temp{\noexpand\scanmacro{#1}}%
7298 \temp
7299 }
7300
7301 \newcount\paramno % Count of parameters
7302 \newtoks\macname % Macro name
7303 \newif\ifrecursive % Is it recursive?
7304
7305 % List of all defined macros in the form
7306 % \definedummyword\macro1\definedummyword\macro2...
7307 % Currently is also contains all @aliases; the list can be split
7308 % if there is a need.
7309 \def\macrolist{}
7310
7311 % Add the macro to \macrolist
7312 \def\addtomacrolist#1{\expandafter \addtomacrolistxxx \csname#1\endcsname}
7313 \def\addtomacrolistxxx#1{%
7314 \toks0 = \expandafter{\macrolist\definedummyword#1}%
7315 \xdef\macrolist{\the\toks0}%
7316 }
7317
7318 % Utility routines.
7319 % This does \let #1 = #2, with \csnames; that is,
7320 % \let \csname#1\endcsname = \csname#2\endcsname
7321 % (except of course we have to play expansion games).
7322 %
7323 \def\cslet#1#2{%
7324 \expandafter\let
7325 \csname#1\expandafter\endcsname
7326 \csname#2\endcsname
7327 }
7328
7329 % Trim leading and trailing spaces off a string.
7330 % Concepts from aro-bend problem 15 (see CTAN).
7331 {\catcode`\@=11
7332 \gdef\eatspaces #1{\expandafter\trim@\expandafter{#1 }}
7333 \gdef\trim@ #1{\trim@@ @#1 @ #1 @ @@}
7334 \gdef\trim@@ #1@ #2@ #3@@{\trim@@@\empty #2 @}
7335 \def\unbrace#1{#1}
7336 \unbrace{\gdef\trim@@@ #1 } #2@{#1}
7337 }
7338
7339 % Trim a single trailing ^^M off a string.
7340 {\catcode`\^^M=\other \catcode`\Q=3%
7341 \gdef\eatcr #1{\eatcra #1Q^^MQ}%
7342 \gdef\eatcra#1^^MQ{\eatcrb#1Q}%
7343 \gdef\eatcrb#1Q#2Q{#1}%
7344 }
7345
7346 % Macro bodies are absorbed as an argument in a context where
7347 % all characters are catcode 10, 11 or 12, except \ which is active
7348 % (as in normal texinfo). It is necessary to change the definition of \
7349 % to recognize macro arguments; this is the job of \mbodybackslash.
7350 %
7351 % Non-ASCII encodings make 8-bit characters active, so un-activate
7352 % them to avoid their expansion. Must do this non-globally, to
7353 % confine the change to the current group.
7354 %
7355 % It's necessary to have hard CRs when the macro is executed. This is
7356 % done by making ^^M (\endlinechar) catcode 12 when reading the macro
7357 % body, and then making it the \newlinechar in \scanmacro.
7358 %
7359 \def\scanctxt{% used as subroutine
7360 \catcode`\"=\other
7361 \catcode`\+=\other
7362 \catcode`\<=\other
7363 \catcode`\>=\other
7364 \catcode`\@=\other
7365 \catcode`\^=\other
7366 \catcode`\_=\other
7367 \catcode`\|=\other
7368 \catcode`\~=\other
7369 \ifx\declaredencoding\ascii \else \setnonasciicharscatcodenonglobal\other \fi
7370 }
7371
7372 \def\scanargctxt{% used for copying and captions, not macros.
7373 \scanctxt
7374 \catcode`\\=\other
7375 \catcode`\^^M=\other
7376 }
7377
7378 \def\macrobodyctxt{% used for @macro definitions
7379 \scanctxt
7380 \catcode`\{=\other
7381 \catcode`\}=\other
7382 \catcode`\^^M=\other
7383 \usembodybackslash
7384 }
7385
7386 \def\macroargctxt{% used when scanning invocations
7387 \scanctxt
7388 \catcode`\\=0
7389 }
7390 % why catcode 0 for \ in the above? To recognize \\ \{ \} as "escapes"
7391 % for the single characters \ { }. Thus, we end up with the "commands"
7392 % that would be written @\ @{ @} in a Texinfo document.
7393 %
7394 % We already have @{ and @}. For @\, we define it here, and only for
7395 % this purpose, to produce a typewriter backslash (so, the @\ that we
7396 % define for @math can't be used with @macro calls):
7397 %
7398 \def\\{\normalbackslash}%
7399 %
7400 % We would like to do this for \, too, since that is what makeinfo does.
7401 % But it is not possible, because Texinfo already has a command @, for a
7402 % cedilla accent. Documents must use @comma{} instead.
7403 %
7404 % \anythingelse will almost certainly be an error of some kind.
7405
7406
7407 % \mbodybackslash is the definition of \ in @macro bodies.
7408 % It maps \foo\ => \csname macarg.foo\endcsname => #N
7409 % where N is the macro parameter number.
7410 % We define \csname macarg.\endcsname to be \realbackslash, so
7411 % \\ in macro replacement text gets you a backslash.
7412 %
7413 {\catcode`@=0 @catcode`@\=@active
7414 @gdef@usembodybackslash{@let\=@mbodybackslash}
7415 @gdef@mbodybackslash#1\{@csname macarg.#1@endcsname}
7416 }
7417 \expandafter\def\csname macarg.\endcsname{\realbackslash}
7418
7419 \def\margbackslash#1{\char`\#1 }
7420
7421 \def\macro{\recursivefalse\parsearg\macroxxx}
7422 \def\rmacro{\recursivetrue\parsearg\macroxxx}
7423
7424 \def\macroxxx#1{%
7425 \getargs{#1}% now \macname is the macname and \argl the arglist
7426 \ifx\argl\empty % no arguments
7427 \paramno=0\relax
7428 \else
7429 \expandafter\parsemargdef \argl;%
7430 \if\paramno>256\relax
7431 \ifx\eTeXversion\thisisundefined
7432 \errhelp = \EMsimple
7433 \errmessage{You need eTeX to compile a file with macros with more than 256 arguments}
7434 \fi
7435 \fi
7436 \fi
7437 \if1\csname ismacro.\the\macname\endcsname
7438 \message{Warning: redefining \the\macname}%
7439 \else
7440 \expandafter\ifx\csname \the\macname\endcsname \relax
7441 \else \errmessage{Macro name \the\macname\space already defined}\fi
7442 \global\cslet{macsave.\the\macname}{\the\macname}%
7443 \global\expandafter\let\csname ismacro.\the\macname\endcsname=1%
7444 \addtomacrolist{\the\macname}%
7445 \fi
7446 \begingroup \macrobodyctxt
7447 \ifrecursive \expandafter\parsermacbody
7448 \else \expandafter\parsemacbody
7449 \fi}
7450
7451 \parseargdef\unmacro{%
7452 \if1\csname ismacro.#1\endcsname
7453 \global\cslet{#1}{macsave.#1}%
7454 \global\expandafter\let \csname ismacro.#1\endcsname=0%
7455 % Remove the macro name from \macrolist:
7456 \begingroup
7457 \expandafter\let\csname#1\endcsname \relax
7458 \let\definedummyword\unmacrodo
7459 \xdef\macrolist{\macrolist}%
7460 \endgroup
7461 \else
7462 \errmessage{Macro #1 not defined}%
7463 \fi
7464 }
7465
7466 % Called by \do from \dounmacro on each macro. The idea is to omit any
7467 % macro definitions that have been changed to \relax.
7468 %
7469 \def\unmacrodo#1{%
7470 \ifx #1\relax
7471 % remove this
7472 \else
7473 \noexpand\definedummyword \noexpand#1%
7474 \fi
7475 }
7476
7477 % This makes use of the obscure feature that if the last token of a
7478 % <parameter list> is #, then the preceding argument is delimited by
7479 % an opening brace, and that opening brace is not consumed.
7480 \def\getargs#1{\getargsxxx#1{}}
7481 \def\getargsxxx#1#{\getmacname #1 \relax\getmacargs}
7482 \def\getmacname#1 #2\relax{\macname={#1}}
7483 \def\getmacargs#1{\def\argl{#1}}
7484
7485 % For macro processing make @ a letter so that we can make Texinfo private macro names.
7486 \edef\texiatcatcode{\the\catcode`\@}
7487 \catcode `@=11\relax
7488
7489 % Parse the optional {params} list. Set up \paramno and \paramlist
7490 % so \defmacro knows what to do. Define \macarg.BLAH for each BLAH
7491 % in the params list to some hook where the argument is to be expanded. If
7492 % there are less than 10 arguments that hook is to be replaced by ##N where N
7493 % is the position in that list, that is to say the macro arguments are to be
7494 % defined `a la TeX in the macro body.
7495 %
7496 % That gets used by \mbodybackslash (above).
7497 %
7498 % We need to get `macro parameter char #' into several definitions.
7499 % The technique used is stolen from LaTeX: let \hash be something
7500 % unexpandable, insert that wherever you need a #, and then redefine
7501 % it to # just before using the token list produced.
7502 %
7503 % The same technique is used to protect \eatspaces till just before
7504 % the macro is used.
7505 %
7506 % If there are 10 or more arguments, a different technique is used, where the
7507 % hook remains in the body, and when macro is to be expanded the body is
7508 % processed again to replace the arguments.
7509 %
7510 % In that case, the hook is \the\toks N-1, and we simply set \toks N-1 to the
7511 % argument N value and then \edef the body (nothing else will expand because of
7512 % the catcode regime underwhich the body was input).
7513 %
7514 % If you compile with TeX (not eTeX), and you have macros with 10 or more
7515 % arguments, you need that no macro has more than 256 arguments, otherwise an
7516 % error is produced.
7517 \def\parsemargdef#1;{%
7518 \paramno=0\def\paramlist{}%
7519 \let\hash\relax
7520 \let\xeatspaces\relax
7521 \parsemargdefxxx#1,;,%
7522 % In case that there are 10 or more arguments we parse again the arguments
7523 % list to set new definitions for the \macarg.BLAH macros corresponding to
7524 % each BLAH argument. It was anyhow needed to parse already once this list
7525 % in order to count the arguments, and as macros with at most 9 arguments
7526 % are by far more frequent than macro with 10 or more arguments, defining
7527 % twice the \macarg.BLAH macros does not cost too much processing power.
7528 \ifnum\paramno<10\relax\else
7529 \paramno0\relax
7530 \parsemmanyargdef@@#1,;,% 10 or more arguments
7531 \fi
7532 }
7533 \def\parsemargdefxxx#1,{%
7534 \if#1;\let\next=\relax
7535 \else \let\next=\parsemargdefxxx
7536 \advance\paramno by 1
7537 \expandafter\edef\csname macarg.\eatspaces{#1}\endcsname
7538 {\xeatspaces{\hash\the\paramno}}%
7539 \edef\paramlist{\paramlist\hash\the\paramno,}%
7540 \fi\next}
7541
7542 \def\parsemmanyargdef@@#1,{%
7543 \if#1;\let\next=\relax
7544 \else
7545 \let\next=\parsemmanyargdef@@
7546 \edef\tempb{\eatspaces{#1}}%
7547 \expandafter\def\expandafter\tempa
7548 \expandafter{\csname macarg.\tempb\endcsname}%
7549 % Note that we need some extra \noexpand\noexpand, this is because we
7550 % don't want \the to be expanded in the \parsermacbody as it uses an
7551 % \xdef .
7552 \expandafter\edef\tempa
7553 {\noexpand\noexpand\noexpand\the\toks\the\paramno}%
7554 \advance\paramno by 1\relax
7555 \fi\next}
7556
7557 % These two commands read recursive and nonrecursive macro bodies.
7558 % (They're different since rec and nonrec macros end differently.)
7559 %
7560
7561 \catcode `\@\texiatcatcode
7562 \long\def\parsemacbody#1@end macro%
7563 {\xdef\temp{\eatcr{#1}}\endgroup\defmacro}%
7564 \long\def\parsermacbody#1@end rmacro%
7565 {\xdef\temp{\eatcr{#1}}\endgroup\defmacro}%
7566 \catcode `\@=11\relax
7567
7568 \let\endargs@\relax
7569 \let\nil@\relax
7570 \def\nilm@{\nil@}%
7571 \long\def\nillm@{\nil@}%
7572
7573 % This macro is expanded during the Texinfo macro expansion, not during its
7574 % definition. It gets all the arguments values and assigns them to macros
7575 % macarg.ARGNAME
7576 %
7577 % #1 is the macro name
7578 % #2 is the list of argument names
7579 % #3 is the list of argument values
7580 \def\getargvals@#1#2#3{%
7581 \def\macargdeflist@{}%
7582 \def\saveparamlist@{#2}% Need to keep a copy for parameter expansion.
7583 \def\paramlist{#2,\nil@}%
7584 \def\macroname{#1}%
7585 \begingroup
7586 \macroargctxt
7587 \def\argvaluelist{#3,\nil@}%
7588 \def\@tempa{#3}%
7589 \ifx\@tempa\empty
7590 \setemptyargvalues@
7591 \else
7592 \getargvals@@
7593 \fi
7594 }
7595
7596 %
7597 \def\getargvals@@{%
7598 \ifx\paramlist\nilm@
7599 % Some sanity check needed here that \argvaluelist is also empty.
7600 \ifx\argvaluelist\nillm@
7601 \else
7602 \errhelp = \EMsimple
7603 \errmessage{Too many arguments in macro `\macroname'!}%
7604 \fi
7605 \let\next\macargexpandinbody@
7606 \else
7607 \ifx\argvaluelist\nillm@
7608 % No more arguments values passed to macro. Set remaining named-arg
7609 % macros to empty.
7610 \let\next\setemptyargvalues@
7611 \else
7612 % pop current arg name into \@tempb
7613 \def\@tempa##1{\pop@{\@tempb}{\paramlist}##1\endargs@}%
7614 \expandafter\@tempa\expandafter{\paramlist}%
7615 % pop current argument value into \@tempc
7616 \def\@tempa##1{\longpop@{\@tempc}{\argvaluelist}##1\endargs@}%
7617 \expandafter\@tempa\expandafter{\argvaluelist}%
7618 % Here \@tempb is the current arg name and \@tempc is the current arg value.
7619 % First place the new argument macro definition into \@tempd
7620 \expandafter\macname\expandafter{\@tempc}%
7621 \expandafter\let\csname macarg.\@tempb\endcsname\relax
7622 \expandafter\def\expandafter\@tempe\expandafter{%
7623 \csname macarg.\@tempb\endcsname}%
7624 \edef\@tempd{\long\def\@tempe{\the\macname}}%
7625 \push@\@tempd\macargdeflist@
7626 \let\next\getargvals@@
7627 \fi
7628 \fi
7629 \next
7630 }
7631
7632 \def\push@#1#2{%
7633 \expandafter\expandafter\expandafter\def
7634 \expandafter\expandafter\expandafter#2%
7635 \expandafter\expandafter\expandafter{%
7636 \expandafter#1#2}%
7637 }
7638
7639 % Replace arguments by their values in the macro body, and place the result
7640 % in macro \@tempa
7641 \def\macvalstoargs@{%
7642 % To do this we use the property that token registers that are \the'ed
7643 % within an \edef expand only once. So we are going to place all argument
7644 % values into respective token registers.
7645 %
7646 % First we save the token context, and initialize argument numbering.
7647 \begingroup
7648 \paramno0\relax
7649 % Then, for each argument number #N, we place the corresponding argument
7650 % value into a new token list register \toks#N
7651 \expandafter\putargsintokens@\saveparamlist@,;,%
7652 % Then, we expand the body so that argument are replaced by their
7653 % values. The trick for values not to be expanded themselves is that they
7654 % are within tokens and that tokens expand only once in an \edef .
7655 \edef\@tempc{\csname mac.\macroname .body\endcsname}%
7656 % Now we restore the token stack pointer to free the token list registers
7657 % which we have used, but we make sure that expanded body is saved after
7658 % group.
7659 \expandafter
7660 \endgroup
7661 \expandafter\def\expandafter\@tempa\expandafter{\@tempc}%
7662 }
7663
7664 \def\macargexpandinbody@{%
7665 %% Define the named-macro outside of this group and then close this group.
7666 \expandafter
7667 \endgroup
7668 \macargdeflist@
7669 % First the replace in body the macro arguments by their values, the result
7670 % is in \@tempa .
7671 \macvalstoargs@
7672 % Then we point at the \norecurse or \gobble (for recursive) macro value
7673 % with \@tempb .
7674 \expandafter\let\expandafter\@tempb\csname mac.\macroname .recurse\endcsname
7675 % Depending on whether it is recursive or not, we need some tailing
7676 % \egroup .
7677 \ifx\@tempb\gobble
7678 \let\@tempc\relax
7679 \else
7680 \let\@tempc\egroup
7681 \fi
7682 % And now we do the real job:
7683 \edef\@tempd{\noexpand\@tempb{\macroname}\noexpand\scanmacro{\@tempa}\@tempc}%
7684 \@tempd
7685 }
7686
7687 \def\putargsintokens@#1,{%
7688 \if#1;\let\next\relax
7689 \else
7690 \let\next\putargsintokens@
7691 % First we allocate the new token list register, and give it a temporary
7692 % alias \@tempb .
7693 \toksdef\@tempb\the\paramno
7694 % Then we place the argument value into that token list register.
7695 \expandafter\let\expandafter\@tempa\csname macarg.#1\endcsname
7696 \expandafter\@tempb\expandafter{\@tempa}%
7697 \advance\paramno by 1\relax
7698 \fi
7699 \next
7700 }
7701
7702 % Save the token stack pointer into macro #1
7703 \def\texisavetoksstackpoint#1{\edef#1{\the\@cclvi}}
7704 % Restore the token stack pointer from number in macro #1
7705 \def\texirestoretoksstackpoint#1{\expandafter\mathchardef\expandafter\@cclvi#1\relax}
7706 % newtoks that can be used non \outer .
7707 \def\texinonouternewtoks{\alloc@ 5\toks \toksdef \@cclvi}
7708
7709 % Tailing missing arguments are set to empty
7710 \def\setemptyargvalues@{%
7711 \ifx\paramlist\nilm@
7712 \let\next\macargexpandinbody@
7713 \else
7714 \expandafter\setemptyargvaluesparser@\paramlist\endargs@
7715 \let\next\setemptyargvalues@
7716 \fi
7717 \next
7718 }
7719
7720 \def\setemptyargvaluesparser@#1,#2\endargs@{%
7721 \expandafter\def\expandafter\@tempa\expandafter{%
7722 \expandafter\def\csname macarg.#1\endcsname{}}%
7723 \push@\@tempa\macargdeflist@
7724 \def\paramlist{#2}%
7725 }
7726
7727 % #1 is the element target macro
7728 % #2 is the list macro
7729 % #3,#4\endargs@ is the list value
7730 \def\pop@#1#2#3,#4\endargs@{%
7731 \def#1{#3}%
7732 \def#2{#4}%
7733 }
7734 \long\def\longpop@#1#2#3,#4\endargs@{%
7735 \long\def#1{#3}%
7736 \long\def#2{#4}%
7737 }
7738
7739 % This defines a Texinfo @macro. There are eight cases: recursive and
7740 % nonrecursive macros of zero, one, up to nine, and many arguments.
7741 % Much magic with \expandafter here.
7742 % \xdef is used so that macro definitions will survive the file
7743 % they're defined in; @include reads the file inside a group.
7744 %
7745 \def\defmacro{%
7746 \let\hash=##% convert placeholders to macro parameter chars
7747 \ifrecursive
7748 \ifcase\paramno
7749 % 0
7750 \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname\endcsname{%
7751 \noexpand\scanmacro{\temp}}%
7752 \or % 1
7753 \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname\endcsname{%
7754 \bgroup\noexpand\macroargctxt
7755 \noexpand\braceorline
7756 \expandafter\noexpand\csname\the\macname xxx\endcsname}%
7757 \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname xxx\endcsname##1{%
7758 \egroup\noexpand\scanmacro{\temp}}%
7759 \else
7760 \ifnum\paramno<10\relax % at most 9
7761 \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname\endcsname{%
7762 \bgroup\noexpand\macroargctxt
7763 \noexpand\csname\the\macname xx\endcsname}%
7764 \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname xx\endcsname##1{%
7765 \expandafter\noexpand\csname\the\macname xxx\endcsname ##1,}%
7766 \expandafter\expandafter
7767 \expandafter\xdef
7768 \expandafter\expandafter
7769 \csname\the\macname xxx\endcsname
7770 \paramlist{\egroup\noexpand\scanmacro{\temp}}%
7771 \else % 10 or more
7772 \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname\endcsname{%
7773 \noexpand\getargvals@{\the\macname}{\argl}%
7774 }%
7775 \global\expandafter\let\csname mac.\the\macname .body\endcsname\temp
7776 \global\expandafter\let\csname mac.\the\macname .recurse\endcsname\gobble
7777 \fi
7778 \fi
7779 \else
7780 \ifcase\paramno
7781 % 0
7782 \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname\endcsname{%
7783 \noexpand\norecurse{\the\macname}%
7784 \noexpand\scanmacro{\temp}\egroup}%
7785 \or % 1
7786 \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname\endcsname{%
7787 \bgroup\noexpand\macroargctxt
7788 \noexpand\braceorline
7789 \expandafter\noexpand\csname\the\macname xxx\endcsname}%
7790 \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname xxx\endcsname##1{%
7791 \egroup
7792 \noexpand\norecurse{\the\macname}%
7793 \noexpand\scanmacro{\temp}\egroup}%
7794 \else % at most 9
7795 \ifnum\paramno<10\relax
7796 \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname\endcsname{%
7797 \bgroup\noexpand\macroargctxt
7798 \expandafter\noexpand\csname\the\macname xx\endcsname}%
7799 \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname xx\endcsname##1{%
7800 \expandafter\noexpand\csname\the\macname xxx\endcsname ##1,}%
7801 \expandafter\expandafter
7802 \expandafter\xdef
7803 \expandafter\expandafter
7804 \csname\the\macname xxx\endcsname
7805 \paramlist{%
7806 \egroup
7807 \noexpand\norecurse{\the\macname}%
7808 \noexpand\scanmacro{\temp}\egroup}%
7809 \else % 10 or more:
7810 \expandafter\xdef\csname\the\macname\endcsname{%
7811 \noexpand\getargvals@{\the\macname}{\argl}%
7812 }%
7813 \global\expandafter\let\csname mac.\the\macname .body\endcsname\temp
7814 \global\expandafter\let\csname mac.\the\macname .recurse\endcsname\norecurse
7815 \fi
7816 \fi
7817 \fi}
7818
7819 \catcode `\@\texiatcatcode\relax
7820
7821 \def\norecurse#1{\bgroup\cslet{#1}{macsave.#1}}
7822
7823 % \braceorline decides whether the next nonwhitespace character is a
7824 % {. If so it reads up to the closing }, if not, it reads the whole
7825 % line. Whatever was read is then fed to the next control sequence
7826 % as an argument (by \parsebrace or \parsearg).
7827 %
7828 \def\braceorline#1{\let\macnamexxx=#1\futurelet\nchar\braceorlinexxx}
7829 \def\braceorlinexxx{%
7830 \ifx\nchar\bgroup\else
7831 \expandafter\parsearg
7832 \fi \macnamexxx}
7833
7834
7835 % @alias.
7836 % We need some trickery to remove the optional spaces around the equal
7837 % sign. Make them active and then expand them all to nothing.
7838 %
7839 \def\alias{\parseargusing\obeyspaces\aliasxxx}
7840 \def\aliasxxx #1{\aliasyyy#1\relax}
7841 \def\aliasyyy #1=#2\relax{%
7842 {%
7843 \expandafter\let\obeyedspace=\empty
7844 \addtomacrolist{#1}%
7845 \xdef\next{\global\let\makecsname{#1}=\makecsname{#2}}%
7846 }%
7847 \next
7848 }
7849
7850
7851 \message{cross references,}
7852
7853 \newwrite\auxfile
7854 \newif\ifhavexrefs % True if xref values are known.
7855 \newif\ifwarnedxrefs % True if we warned once that they aren't known.
7856
7857 % @inforef is relatively simple.
7858 \def\inforef #1{\inforefzzz #1,,,,**}
7859 \def\inforefzzz #1,#2,#3,#4**{%
7860 \putwordSee{} \putwordInfo{} \putwordfile{} \file{\ignorespaces #3{}},
7861 node \samp{\ignorespaces#1{}}}
7862
7863 % @node's only job in TeX is to define \lastnode, which is used in
7864 % cross-references. The @node line might or might not have commas, and
7865 % might or might not have spaces before the first comma, like:
7866 % @node foo , bar , ...
7867 % We don't want such trailing spaces in the node name.
7868 %
7869 \parseargdef\node{\checkenv{}\donode #1 ,\finishnodeparse}
7870 %
7871 % also remove a trailing comma, in case of something like this:
7872 % @node Help-Cross, , , Cross-refs
7873 \def\donode#1 ,#2\finishnodeparse{\dodonode #1,\finishnodeparse}
7874 \def\dodonode#1,#2\finishnodeparse{\gdef\lastnode{#1}}
7875
7876 \let\nwnode=\node
7877 \let\lastnode=\empty
7878
7879 % Write a cross-reference definition for the current node. #1 is the
7880 % type (Ynumbered, Yappendix, Ynothing).
7881 %
7882 \def\donoderef#1{%
7883 \ifx\lastnode\empty\else
7884 \setref{\lastnode}{#1}%
7885 \global\let\lastnode=\empty
7886 \fi
7887 }
7888
7889 % @anchor{NAME} -- define xref target at arbitrary point.
7890 %
7891 \newcount\savesfregister
7892 %
7893 \def\savesf{\relax \ifhmode \savesfregister=\spacefactor \fi}
7894 \def\restoresf{\relax \ifhmode \spacefactor=\savesfregister \fi}
7895 \def\anchor#1{\savesf \setref{#1}{Ynothing}\restoresf \ignorespaces}
7896
7897 % \setref{NAME}{SNT} defines a cross-reference point NAME (a node or an
7898 % anchor), which consists of three parts:
7899 % 1) NAME-title - the current sectioning name taken from \lastsection,
7900 % or the anchor name.
7901 % 2) NAME-snt - section number and type, passed as the SNT arg, or
7902 % empty for anchors.
7903 % 3) NAME-pg - the page number.
7904 %
7905 % This is called from \donoderef, \anchor, and \dofloat. In the case of
7906 % floats, there is an additional part, which is not written here:
7907 % 4) NAME-lof - the text as it should appear in a @listoffloats.
7908 %
7909 \def\setref#1#2{%
7910 \pdfmkdest{#1}%
7911 \iflinks
7912 {%
7913 \atdummies % preserve commands, but don't expand them
7914 \edef\writexrdef##1##2{%
7915 \write\auxfile{@xrdef{#1-% #1 of \setref, expanded by the \edef
7916 ##1}{##2}}% these are parameters of \writexrdef
7917 }%
7918 \toks0 = \expandafter{\lastsection}%
7919 \immediate \writexrdef{title}{\the\toks0 }%
7920 \immediate \writexrdef{snt}{\csname #2\endcsname}% \Ynumbered etc.
7921 \safewhatsit{\writexrdef{pg}{\folio}}% will be written later, at \shipout
7922 }%
7923 \fi
7924 }
7925
7926 % @xrefautosectiontitle on|off says whether @section(ing) names are used
7927 % automatically in xrefs, if the third arg is not explicitly specified.
7928 % This was provided as a "secret" @set xref-automatic-section-title
7929 % variable, now it's official.
7930 %
7931 \parseargdef\xrefautomaticsectiontitle{%
7932 \def\temp{#1}%
7933 \ifx\temp\onword
7934 \expandafter\let\csname SETxref-automatic-section-title\endcsname
7935 = \empty
7936 \else\ifx\temp\offword
7937 \expandafter\let\csname SETxref-automatic-section-title\endcsname
7938 = \relax
7939 \else
7940 \errhelp = \EMsimple
7941 \errmessage{Unknown @xrefautomaticsectiontitle value `\temp',
7942 must be on|off}%
7943 \fi\fi
7944 }
7945
7946 % \f
7947 % @xref, @pxref, and @ref generate cross-references. For \xrefX, #1 is
7948 % the node name, #2 the name of the Info cross-reference, #3 the printed
7949 % node name, #4 the name of the Info file, #5 the name of the printed
7950 % manual. All but the node name can be omitted.
7951 %
7952 \def\pxref#1{\putwordsee{} \xrefX[#1,,,,,,,]}
7953 \def\xref#1{\putwordSee{} \xrefX[#1,,,,,,,]}
7954 \def\ref#1{\xrefX[#1,,,,,,,]}
7955 %
7956 \newbox\toprefbox
7957 \newbox\printedrefnamebox
7958 \newbox\infofilenamebox
7959 \newbox\printedmanualbox
7960 %
7961 \def\xrefX[#1,#2,#3,#4,#5,#6]{\begingroup
7962 \unsepspaces
7963 %
7964 % Get args without leading/trailing spaces.
7965 \def\printedrefname{\ignorespaces #3}%
7966 \setbox\printedrefnamebox = \hbox{\printedrefname\unskip}%
7967 %
7968 \def\infofilename{\ignorespaces #4}%
7969 \setbox\infofilenamebox = \hbox{\infofilename\unskip}%
7970 %
7971 \def\printedmanual{\ignorespaces #5}%
7972 \setbox\printedmanualbox = \hbox{\printedmanual\unskip}%
7973 %
7974 % If the printed reference name (arg #3) was not explicitly given in
7975 % the @xref, figure out what we want to use.
7976 \ifdim \wd\printedrefnamebox = 0pt
7977 % No printed node name was explicitly given.
7978 \expandafter\ifx\csname SETxref-automatic-section-title\endcsname \relax
7979 % Not auto section-title: use node name inside the square brackets.
7980 \def\printedrefname{\ignorespaces #1}%
7981 \else
7982 % Auto section-title: use chapter/section title inside
7983 % the square brackets if we have it.
7984 \ifdim \wd\printedmanualbox > 0pt
7985 % It is in another manual, so we don't have it; use node name.
7986 \def\printedrefname{\ignorespaces #1}%
7987 \else
7988 \ifhavexrefs
7989 % We (should) know the real title if we have the xref values.
7990 \def\printedrefname{\refx{#1-title}{}}%
7991 \else
7992 % Otherwise just copy the Info node name.
7993 \def\printedrefname{\ignorespaces #1}%
7994 \fi%
7995 \fi
7996 \fi
7997 \fi
7998 %
7999 % Make link in pdf output.
8000 \ifpdf
8001 {\indexnofonts
8002 \turnoffactive
8003 \makevalueexpandable
8004 % This expands tokens, so do it after making catcode changes, so _
8005 % etc. don't get their TeX definitions. This ignores all spaces in
8006 % #4, including (wrongly) those in the middle of the filename.
8007 \getfilename{#4}%
8008 %
8009 % This (wrongly) does not take account of leading or trailing
8010 % spaces in #1, which should be ignored.
8011 \edef\pdfxrefdest{#1}%
8012 \ifx\pdfxrefdest\empty
8013 \def\pdfxrefdest{Top}% no empty targets
8014 \else
8015 \txiescapepdf\pdfxrefdest % escape PDF special chars
8016 \fi
8017 %
8018 \leavevmode
8019 \startlink attr{/Border [0 0 0]}%
8020 \ifnum\filenamelength>0
8021 goto file{\the\filename.pdf} name{\pdfxrefdest}%
8022 \else
8023 goto name{\pdfmkpgn{\pdfxrefdest}}%
8024 \fi
8025 }%
8026 \setcolor{\linkcolor}%
8027 \fi
8028 %
8029 % Float references are printed completely differently: "Figure 1.2"
8030 % instead of "[somenode], p.3". We distinguish them by the
8031 % LABEL-title being set to a magic string.
8032 {%
8033 % Have to otherify everything special to allow the \csname to
8034 % include an _ in the xref name, etc.
8035 \indexnofonts
8036 \turnoffactive
8037 \expandafter\global\expandafter\let\expandafter\Xthisreftitle
8038 \csname XR#1-title\endcsname
8039 }%
8040 \iffloat\Xthisreftitle
8041 % If the user specified the print name (third arg) to the ref,
8042 % print it instead of our usual "Figure 1.2".
8043 \ifdim\wd\printedrefnamebox = 0pt
8044 \refx{#1-snt}{}%
8045 \else
8046 \printedrefname
8047 \fi
8048 %
8049 % If the user also gave the printed manual name (fifth arg), append
8050 % "in MANUALNAME".
8051 \ifdim \wd\printedmanualbox > 0pt
8052 \space \putwordin{} \cite{\printedmanual}%
8053 \fi
8054 \else
8055 % node/anchor (non-float) references.
8056 %
8057 % If we use \unhbox to print the node names, TeX does not insert
8058 % empty discretionaries after hyphens, which means that it will not
8059 % find a line break at a hyphen in a node names. Since some manuals
8060 % are best written with fairly long node names, containing hyphens,
8061 % this is a loss. Therefore, we give the text of the node name
8062 % again, so it is as if TeX is seeing it for the first time.
8063 %
8064 \ifdim \wd\printedmanualbox > 0pt
8065 % Cross-manual reference with a printed manual name.
8066 %
8067 \crossmanualxref{\cite{\printedmanual\unskip}}%
8068 %
8069 \else\ifdim \wd\infofilenamebox > 0pt
8070 % Cross-manual reference with only an info filename (arg 4), no
8071 % printed manual name (arg 5). This is essentially the same as
8072 % the case above; we output the filename, since we have nothing else.
8073 %
8074 \crossmanualxref{\code{\infofilename\unskip}}%
8075 %
8076 \else
8077 % Reference within this manual.
8078 %
8079 % _ (for example) has to be the character _ for the purposes of the
8080 % control sequence corresponding to the node, but it has to expand
8081 % into the usual \leavevmode...\vrule stuff for purposes of
8082 % printing. So we \turnoffactive for the \refx-snt, back on for the
8083 % printing, back off for the \refx-pg.
8084 {\turnoffactive
8085 % Only output a following space if the -snt ref is nonempty; for
8086 % @unnumbered and @anchor, it won't be.
8087 \setbox2 = \hbox{\ignorespaces \refx{#1-snt}{}}%
8088 \ifdim \wd2 > 0pt \refx{#1-snt}\space\fi
8089 }%
8090 % output the `[mynode]' via the macro below so it can be overridden.
8091 \xrefprintnodename\printedrefname
8092 %
8093 % But we always want a comma and a space:
8094 ,\space
8095 %
8096 % output the `page 3'.
8097 \turnoffactive \putwordpage\tie\refx{#1-pg}{}%
8098 \fi\fi
8099 \fi
8100 \endlink
8101 \endgroup}
8102
8103 % Output a cross-manual xref to #1. Used just above (twice).
8104 %
8105 % Only include the text "Section ``foo'' in" if the foo is neither
8106 % missing or Top. Thus, @xref{,,,foo,The Foo Manual} outputs simply
8107 % "see The Foo Manual", the idea being to refer to the whole manual.
8108 %
8109 % But, this being TeX, we can't easily compare our node name against the
8110 % string "Top" while ignoring the possible spaces before and after in
8111 % the input. By adding the arbitrary 7sp below, we make it much less
8112 % likely that a real node name would have the same width as "Top" (e.g.,
8113 % in a monospaced font). Hopefully it will never happen in practice.
8114 %
8115 % For the same basic reason, we retypeset the "Top" at every
8116 % reference, since the current font is indeterminate.
8117 %
8118 \def\crossmanualxref#1{%
8119 \setbox\toprefbox = \hbox{Top\kern7sp}%
8120 \setbox2 = \hbox{\ignorespaces \printedrefname \unskip \kern7sp}%
8121 \ifdim \wd2 > 7sp % nonempty?
8122 \ifdim \wd2 = \wd\toprefbox \else % same as Top?
8123 \putwordSection{} ``\printedrefname'' \putwordin{}\space
8124 \fi
8125 \fi
8126 #1%
8127 }
8128
8129 % This macro is called from \xrefX for the `[nodename]' part of xref
8130 % output. It's a separate macro only so it can be changed more easily,
8131 % since square brackets don't work well in some documents. Particularly
8132 % one that Bob is working on :).
8133 %
8134 \def\xrefprintnodename#1{[#1]}
8135
8136 % Things referred to by \setref.
8137 %
8138 \def\Ynothing{}
8139 \def\Yomitfromtoc{}
8140 \def\Ynumbered{%
8141 \ifnum\secno=0
8142 \putwordChapter@tie \the\chapno
8143 \else \ifnum\subsecno=0
8144 \putwordSection@tie \the\chapno.\the\secno
8145 \else \ifnum\subsubsecno=0
8146 \putwordSection@tie \the\chapno.\the\secno.\the\subsecno
8147 \else
8148 \putwordSection@tie \the\chapno.\the\secno.\the\subsecno.\the\subsubsecno
8149 \fi\fi\fi
8150 }
8151 \def\Yappendix{%
8152 \ifnum\secno=0
8153 \putwordAppendix@tie @char\the\appendixno{}%
8154 \else \ifnum\subsecno=0
8155 \putwordSection@tie @char\the\appendixno.\the\secno
8156 \else \ifnum\subsubsecno=0
8157 \putwordSection@tie @char\the\appendixno.\the\secno.\the\subsecno
8158 \else
8159 \putwordSection@tie
8160 @char\the\appendixno.\the\secno.\the\subsecno.\the\subsubsecno
8161 \fi\fi\fi
8162 }
8163
8164 % Define \refx{NAME}{SUFFIX} to reference a cross-reference string named NAME.
8165 % If its value is nonempty, SUFFIX is output afterward.
8166 %
8167 \def\refx#1#2{%
8168 {%
8169 \indexnofonts
8170 \otherbackslash
8171 \expandafter\global\expandafter\let\expandafter\thisrefX
8172 \csname XR#1\endcsname
8173 }%
8174 \ifx\thisrefX\relax
8175 % If not defined, say something at least.
8176 \angleleft un\-de\-fined\angleright
8177 \iflinks
8178 \ifhavexrefs
8179 {\toks0 = {#1}% avoid expansion of possibly-complex value
8180 \message{\linenumber Undefined cross reference `\the\toks0'.}}%
8181 \else
8182 \ifwarnedxrefs\else
8183 \global\warnedxrefstrue
8184 \message{Cross reference values unknown; you must run TeX again.}%
8185 \fi
8186 \fi
8187 \fi
8188 \else
8189 % It's defined, so just use it.
8190 \thisrefX
8191 \fi
8192 #2% Output the suffix in any case.
8193 }
8194
8195 % This is the macro invoked by entries in the aux file. Usually it's
8196 % just a \def (we prepend XR to the control sequence name to avoid
8197 % collisions). But if this is a float type, we have more work to do.
8198 %
8199 \def\xrdef#1#2{%
8200 {% The node name might contain 8-bit characters, which in our current
8201 % implementation are changed to commands like @'e. Don't let these
8202 % mess up the control sequence name.
8203 \indexnofonts
8204 \turnoffactive
8205 \xdef\safexrefname{#1}%
8206 }%
8207 %
8208 \expandafter\gdef\csname XR\safexrefname\endcsname{#2}% remember this xref
8209 %
8210 % Was that xref control sequence that we just defined for a float?
8211 \expandafter\iffloat\csname XR\safexrefname\endcsname
8212 % it was a float, and we have the (safe) float type in \iffloattype.
8213 \expandafter\let\expandafter\floatlist
8214 \csname floatlist\iffloattype\endcsname
8215 %
8216 % Is this the first time we've seen this float type?
8217 \expandafter\ifx\floatlist\relax
8218 \toks0 = {\do}% yes, so just \do
8219 \else
8220 % had it before, so preserve previous elements in list.
8221 \toks0 = \expandafter{\floatlist\do}%
8222 \fi
8223 %
8224 % Remember this xref in the control sequence \floatlistFLOATTYPE,
8225 % for later use in \listoffloats.
8226 \expandafter\xdef\csname floatlist\iffloattype\endcsname{\the\toks0
8227 {\safexrefname}}%
8228 \fi
8229 }
8230
8231 % Read the last existing aux file, if any. No error if none exists.
8232 %
8233 \def\tryauxfile{%
8234 \openin 1 \jobname.aux
8235 \ifeof 1 \else
8236 \readdatafile{aux}%
8237 \global\havexrefstrue
8238 \fi
8239 \closein 1
8240 }
8241
8242 \def\setupdatafile{%
8243 \catcode`\^^@=\other
8244 \catcode`\^^A=\other
8245 \catcode`\^^B=\other
8246 \catcode`\^^C=\other
8247 \catcode`\^^D=\other
8248 \catcode`\^^E=\other
8249 \catcode`\^^F=\other
8250 \catcode`\^^G=\other
8251 \catcode`\^^H=\other
8252 \catcode`\^^K=\other
8253 \catcode`\^^L=\other
8254 \catcode`\^^N=\other
8255 \catcode`\^^P=\other
8256 \catcode`\^^Q=\other
8257 \catcode`\^^R=\other
8258 \catcode`\^^S=\other
8259 \catcode`\^^T=\other
8260 \catcode`\^^U=\other
8261 \catcode`\^^V=\other
8262 \catcode`\^^W=\other
8263 \catcode`\^^X=\other
8264 \catcode`\^^Z=\other
8265 \catcode`\^^[=\other
8266 \catcode`\^^\=\other
8267 \catcode`\^^]=\other
8268 \catcode`\^^^=\other
8269 \catcode`\^^_=\other
8270 % It was suggested to set the catcode of ^ to 7, which would allow ^^e4 etc.
8271 % in xref tags, i.e., node names. But since ^^e4 notation isn't
8272 % supported in the main text, it doesn't seem desirable. Furthermore,
8273 % that is not enough: for node names that actually contain a ^
8274 % character, we would end up writing a line like this: 'xrdef {'hat
8275 % b-title}{'hat b} and \xrdef does a \csname...\endcsname on the first
8276 % argument, and \hat is not an expandable control sequence. It could
8277 % all be worked out, but why? Either we support ^^ or we don't.
8278 %
8279 % The other change necessary for this was to define \auxhat:
8280 % \def\auxhat{\def^{'hat }}% extra space so ok if followed by letter
8281 % and then to call \auxhat in \setq.
8282 %
8283 \catcode`\^=\other
8284 %
8285 % Special characters. Should be turned off anyway, but...
8286 \catcode`\~=\other
8287 \catcode`\[=\other
8288 \catcode`\]=\other
8289 \catcode`\"=\other
8290 \catcode`\_=\other
8291 \catcode`\|=\other
8292 \catcode`\<=\other
8293 \catcode`\>=\other
8294 \catcode`\$=\other
8295 \catcode`\#=\other
8296 \catcode`\&=\other
8297 \catcode`\%=\other
8298 \catcode`+=\other % avoid \+ for paranoia even though we've turned it off
8299 %
8300 % This is to support \ in node names and titles, since the \
8301 % characters end up in a \csname. It's easier than
8302 % leaving it active and making its active definition an actual \
8303 % character. What I don't understand is why it works in the *value*
8304 % of the xrdef. Seems like it should be a catcode12 \, and that
8305 % should not typeset properly. But it works, so I'm moving on for
8306 % now. --karl, 15jan04.
8307 \catcode`\\=\other
8308 %
8309 % Make the characters 128-255 be printing characters.
8310 {%
8311 \count1=128
8312 \def\loop{%
8313 \catcode\count1=\other
8314 \advance\count1 by 1
8315 \ifnum \count1<256 \loop \fi
8316 }%
8317 }%
8318 %
8319 % @ is our escape character in .aux files, and we need braces.
8320 \catcode`\{=1
8321 \catcode`\}=2
8322 \catcode`\@=0
8323 }
8324
8325 \def\readdatafile#1{%
8326 \begingroup
8327 \setupdatafile
8328 \input\jobname.#1
8329 \endgroup}
8330
8331
8332 \message{insertions,}
8333 % including footnotes.
8334
8335 \newcount \footnoteno
8336
8337 % The trailing space in the following definition for supereject is
8338 % vital for proper filling; pages come out unaligned when you do a
8339 % pagealignmacro call if that space before the closing brace is
8340 % removed. (Generally, numeric constants should always be followed by a
8341 % space to prevent strange expansion errors.)
8342 \def\supereject{\par\penalty -20000\footnoteno =0 }
8343
8344 % @footnotestyle is meaningful for Info output only.
8345 \let\footnotestyle=\comment
8346
8347 {\catcode `\@=11
8348 %
8349 % Auto-number footnotes. Otherwise like plain.
8350 \gdef\footnote{%
8351 \let\indent=\ptexindent
8352 \let\noindent=\ptexnoindent
8353 %
8354 \global\advance\footnoteno by \@ne
8355 \edef\thisfootno{$^{\the\footnoteno}$}%
8356 %
8357 % In case the footnote comes at the end of a sentence, preserve the
8358 % extra spacing after we do the footnote number.
8359 \let\@sf\empty
8360 \ifhmode\edef\@sf{\spacefactor\the\spacefactor}\ptexslash\fi
8361 %
8362 % Remove inadvertent blank space before typesetting the footnote number.
8363 \unskip
8364 \thisfootno\@sf
8365 \dofootnote
8366 }%
8367
8368 % Don't bother with the trickery in plain.tex to not require the
8369 % footnote text as a parameter. Our footnotes don't need to be so general.
8370 %
8371 % Oh yes, they do; otherwise, @ifset (and anything else that uses
8372 % \parseargline) fails inside footnotes because the tokens are fixed when
8373 % the footnote is read. --karl, 16nov96.
8374 %
8375 \gdef\dofootnote{%
8376 \insert\footins\bgroup
8377 %
8378 % Nested footnotes are not supported in TeX, that would take a lot
8379 % more work. (\startsavinginserts does not suffice.)
8380 \let\footnote=\errfootnote
8381 %
8382 % We want to typeset this text as a normal paragraph, even if the
8383 % footnote reference occurs in (for example) a display environment.
8384 % So reset some parameters.
8385 \hsize=\pagewidth
8386 \interlinepenalty\interfootnotelinepenalty
8387 \splittopskip\ht\strutbox % top baseline for broken footnotes
8388 \splitmaxdepth\dp\strutbox
8389 \floatingpenalty\@MM
8390 \leftskip\z@skip
8391 \rightskip\z@skip
8392 \spaceskip\z@skip
8393 \xspaceskip\z@skip
8394 \parindent\defaultparindent
8395 %
8396 \smallfonts \rm
8397 %
8398 % Because we use hanging indentation in footnotes, a @noindent appears
8399 % to exdent this text, so make it be a no-op. makeinfo does not use
8400 % hanging indentation so @noindent can still be needed within footnote
8401 % text after an @example or the like (not that this is good style).
8402 \let\noindent = \relax
8403 %
8404 % Hang the footnote text off the number. Use \everypar in case the
8405 % footnote extends for more than one paragraph.
8406 \everypar = {\hang}%
8407 \textindent{\thisfootno}%
8408 %
8409 % Don't crash into the line above the footnote text. Since this
8410 % expands into a box, it must come within the paragraph, lest it
8411 % provide a place where TeX can split the footnote.
8412 \footstrut
8413 %
8414 % Invoke rest of plain TeX footnote routine.
8415 \futurelet\next\fo@t
8416 }
8417 }%end \catcode `\@=11
8418
8419 \def\errfootnote{%
8420 \errhelp=\EMsimple
8421 \errmessage{Nested footnotes not supported in texinfo.tex,
8422 even though they work in makeinfo; sorry}
8423 }
8424
8425 % In case a @footnote appears in a vbox, save the footnote text and create
8426 % the real \insert just after the vbox finished. Otherwise, the insertion
8427 % would be lost.
8428 % Similarly, if a @footnote appears inside an alignment, save the footnote
8429 % text to a box and make the \insert when a row of the table is finished.
8430 % And the same can be done for other insert classes. --kasal, 16nov03.
8431 %
8432 % Replace the \insert primitive by a cheating macro.
8433 % Deeper inside, just make sure that the saved insertions are not spilled
8434 % out prematurely.
8435 %
8436 \def\startsavinginserts{%
8437 \ifx \insert\ptexinsert
8438 \let\insert\saveinsert
8439 \else
8440 \let\checkinserts\relax
8441 \fi
8442 }
8443
8444 % This \insert replacement works for both \insert\footins{foo} and
8445 % \insert\footins\bgroup foo\egroup, but it doesn't work for \insert27{foo}.
8446 %
8447 \def\saveinsert#1{%
8448 \edef\next{\noexpand\savetobox \makeSAVEname#1}%
8449 \afterassignment\next
8450 % swallow the left brace
8451 \let\temp =
8452 }
8453 \def\makeSAVEname#1{\makecsname{SAVE\expandafter\gobble\string#1}}
8454 \def\savetobox#1{\global\setbox#1 = \vbox\bgroup \unvbox#1}
8455
8456 \def\checksaveins#1{\ifvoid#1\else \placesaveins#1\fi}
8457
8458 \def\placesaveins#1{%
8459 \ptexinsert \csname\expandafter\gobblesave\string#1\endcsname
8460 {\box#1}%
8461 }
8462
8463 % eat @SAVE -- beware, all of them have catcode \other:
8464 {
8465 \def\dospecials{\do S\do A\do V\do E} \uncatcodespecials % ;-)
8466 \gdef\gobblesave @SAVE{}
8467 }
8468
8469 % initialization:
8470 \def\newsaveins #1{%
8471 \edef\next{\noexpand\newsaveinsX \makeSAVEname#1}%
8472 \next
8473 }
8474 \def\newsaveinsX #1{%
8475 \csname newbox\endcsname #1%
8476 \expandafter\def\expandafter\checkinserts\expandafter{\checkinserts
8477 \checksaveins #1}%
8478 }
8479
8480 % initialize:
8481 \let\checkinserts\empty
8482 \newsaveins\footins
8483 \newsaveins\margin
8484
8485
8486 % @image. We use the macros from epsf.tex to support this.
8487 % If epsf.tex is not installed and @image is used, we complain.
8488 %
8489 % Check for and read epsf.tex up front. If we read it only at @image
8490 % time, we might be inside a group, and then its definitions would get
8491 % undone and the next image would fail.
8492 \openin 1 = epsf.tex
8493 \ifeof 1 \else
8494 % Do not bother showing banner with epsf.tex v2.7k (available in
8495 % doc/epsf.tex and on ctan).
8496 \def\epsfannounce{\toks0 = }%
8497 \input epsf.tex
8498 \fi
8499 \closein 1
8500 %
8501 % We will only complain once about lack of epsf.tex.
8502 \newif\ifwarnednoepsf
8503 \newhelp\noepsfhelp{epsf.tex must be installed for images to
8504 work. It is also included in the Texinfo distribution, or you can get
8505 it from ftp://tug.org/tex/epsf.tex.}
8506 %
8507 \def\image#1{%
8508 \ifx\epsfbox\thisisundefined
8509 \ifwarnednoepsf \else
8510 \errhelp = \noepsfhelp
8511 \errmessage{epsf.tex not found, images will be ignored}%
8512 \global\warnednoepsftrue
8513 \fi
8514 \else
8515 \imagexxx #1,,,,,\finish
8516 \fi
8517 }
8518 %
8519 % Arguments to @image:
8520 % #1 is (mandatory) image filename; we tack on .eps extension.
8521 % #2 is (optional) width, #3 is (optional) height.
8522 % #4 is (ignored optional) html alt text.
8523 % #5 is (ignored optional) extension.
8524 % #6 is just the usual extra ignored arg for parsing stuff.
8525 \newif\ifimagevmode
8526 \def\imagexxx#1,#2,#3,#4,#5,#6\finish{\begingroup
8527 \catcode`\^^M = 5 % in case we're inside an example
8528 \normalturnoffactive % allow _ et al. in names
8529 % If the image is by itself, center it.
8530 \ifvmode
8531 \imagevmodetrue
8532 \else \ifx\centersub\centerV
8533 % for @center @image, we need a vbox so we can have our vertical space
8534 \imagevmodetrue
8535 \vbox\bgroup % vbox has better behavior than vtop herev
8536 \fi\fi
8537 %
8538 \ifimagevmode
8539 \nobreak\medskip
8540 % Usually we'll have text after the image which will insert
8541 % \parskip glue, so insert it here too to equalize the space
8542 % above and below.
8543 \nobreak\vskip\parskip
8544 \nobreak
8545 \fi
8546 %
8547 % Leave vertical mode so that indentation from an enclosing
8548 % environment such as @quotation is respected.
8549 % However, if we're at the top level, we don't want the
8550 % normal paragraph indentation.
8551 % On the other hand, if we are in the case of @center @image, we don't
8552 % want to start a paragraph, which will create a hsize-width box and
8553 % eradicate the centering.
8554 \ifx\centersub\centerV\else \noindent \fi
8555 %
8556 % Output the image.
8557 \ifpdf
8558 \dopdfimage{#1}{#2}{#3}%
8559 \else
8560 % \epsfbox itself resets \epsf?size at each figure.
8561 \setbox0 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #2}\ifdim\wd0 > 0pt \epsfxsize=#2\relax \fi
8562 \setbox0 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #3}\ifdim\wd0 > 0pt \epsfysize=#3\relax \fi
8563 \epsfbox{#1.eps}%
8564 \fi
8565 %
8566 \ifimagevmode
8567 \medskip % space after a standalone image
8568 \fi
8569 \ifx\centersub\centerV \egroup \fi
8570 \endgroup}
8571
8572
8573 % @float FLOATTYPE,LABEL,LOC ... @end float for displayed figures, tables,
8574 % etc. We don't actually implement floating yet, we always include the
8575 % float "here". But it seemed the best name for the future.
8576 %
8577 \envparseargdef\float{\eatcommaspace\eatcommaspace\dofloat#1, , ,\finish}
8578
8579 % There may be a space before second and/or third parameter; delete it.
8580 \def\eatcommaspace#1, {#1,}
8581
8582 % #1 is the optional FLOATTYPE, the text label for this float, typically
8583 % "Figure", "Table", "Example", etc. Can't contain commas. If omitted,
8584 % this float will not be numbered and cannot be referred to.
8585 %
8586 % #2 is the optional xref label. Also must be present for the float to
8587 % be referable.
8588 %
8589 % #3 is the optional positioning argument; for now, it is ignored. It
8590 % will somehow specify the positions allowed to float to (here, top, bottom).
8591 %
8592 % We keep a separate counter for each FLOATTYPE, which we reset at each
8593 % chapter-level command.
8594 \let\resetallfloatnos=\empty
8595 %
8596 \def\dofloat#1,#2,#3,#4\finish{%
8597 \let\thiscaption=\empty
8598 \let\thisshortcaption=\empty
8599 %
8600 % don't lose footnotes inside @float.
8601 %
8602 % BEWARE: when the floats start float, we have to issue warning whenever an
8603 % insert appears inside a float which could possibly float. --kasal, 26may04
8604 %
8605 \startsavinginserts
8606 %
8607 % We can't be used inside a paragraph.
8608 \par
8609 %
8610 \vtop\bgroup
8611 \def\floattype{#1}%
8612 \def\floatlabel{#2}%
8613 \def\floatloc{#3}% we do nothing with this yet.
8614 %
8615 \ifx\floattype\empty
8616 \let\safefloattype=\empty
8617 \else
8618 {%
8619 % the floattype might have accents or other special characters,
8620 % but we need to use it in a control sequence name.
8621 \indexnofonts
8622 \turnoffactive
8623 \xdef\safefloattype{\floattype}%
8624 }%
8625 \fi
8626 %
8627 % If label is given but no type, we handle that as the empty type.
8628 \ifx\floatlabel\empty \else
8629 % We want each FLOATTYPE to be numbered separately (Figure 1,
8630 % Table 1, Figure 2, ...). (And if no label, no number.)
8631 %
8632 \expandafter\getfloatno\csname\safefloattype floatno\endcsname
8633 \global\advance\floatno by 1
8634 %
8635 {%
8636 % This magic value for \lastsection is output by \setref as the
8637 % XREFLABEL-title value. \xrefX uses it to distinguish float
8638 % labels (which have a completely different output format) from
8639 % node and anchor labels. And \xrdef uses it to construct the
8640 % lists of floats.
8641 %
8642 \edef\lastsection{\floatmagic=\safefloattype}%
8643 \setref{\floatlabel}{Yfloat}%
8644 }%
8645 \fi
8646 %
8647 % start with \parskip glue, I guess.
8648 \vskip\parskip
8649 %
8650 % Don't suppress indentation if a float happens to start a section.
8651 \restorefirstparagraphindent
8652 }
8653
8654 % we have these possibilities:
8655 % @float Foo,lbl & @caption{Cap}: Foo 1.1: Cap
8656 % @float Foo,lbl & no caption: Foo 1.1
8657 % @float Foo & @caption{Cap}: Foo: Cap
8658 % @float Foo & no caption: Foo
8659 % @float ,lbl & Caption{Cap}: 1.1: Cap
8660 % @float ,lbl & no caption: 1.1
8661 % @float & @caption{Cap}: Cap
8662 % @float & no caption:
8663 %
8664 \def\Efloat{%
8665 \let\floatident = \empty
8666 %
8667 % In all cases, if we have a float type, it comes first.
8668 \ifx\floattype\empty \else \def\floatident{\floattype}\fi
8669 %
8670 % If we have an xref label, the number comes next.
8671 \ifx\floatlabel\empty \else
8672 \ifx\floattype\empty \else % if also had float type, need tie first.
8673 \appendtomacro\floatident{\tie}%
8674 \fi
8675 % the number.
8676 \appendtomacro\floatident{\chaplevelprefix\the\floatno}%
8677 \fi
8678 %
8679 % Start the printed caption with what we've constructed in
8680 % \floatident, but keep it separate; we need \floatident again.
8681 \let\captionline = \floatident
8682 %
8683 \ifx\thiscaption\empty \else
8684 \ifx\floatident\empty \else
8685 \appendtomacro\captionline{: }% had ident, so need a colon between
8686 \fi
8687 %
8688 % caption text.
8689 \appendtomacro\captionline{\scanexp\thiscaption}%
8690 \fi
8691 %
8692 % If we have anything to print, print it, with space before.
8693 % Eventually this needs to become an \insert.
8694 \ifx\captionline\empty \else
8695 \vskip.5\parskip
8696 \captionline
8697 %
8698 % Space below caption.
8699 \vskip\parskip
8700 \fi
8701 %
8702 % If have an xref label, write the list of floats info. Do this
8703 % after the caption, to avoid chance of it being a breakpoint.
8704 \ifx\floatlabel\empty \else
8705 % Write the text that goes in the lof to the aux file as
8706 % \floatlabel-lof. Besides \floatident, we include the short
8707 % caption if specified, else the full caption if specified, else nothing.
8708 {%
8709 \atdummies
8710 %
8711 % since we read the caption text in the macro world, where ^^M
8712 % is turned into a normal character, we have to scan it back, so
8713 % we don't write the literal three characters "^^M" into the aux file.
8714 \scanexp{%
8715 \xdef\noexpand\gtemp{%
8716 \ifx\thisshortcaption\empty
8717 \thiscaption
8718 \else
8719 \thisshortcaption
8720 \fi
8721 }%
8722 }%
8723 \immediate\write\auxfile{@xrdef{\floatlabel-lof}{\floatident
8724 \ifx\gtemp\empty \else : \gtemp \fi}}%
8725 }%
8726 \fi
8727 \egroup % end of \vtop
8728 %
8729 % place the captured inserts
8730 %
8731 % BEWARE: when the floats start floating, we have to issue warning
8732 % whenever an insert appears inside a float which could possibly
8733 % float. --kasal, 26may04
8734 %
8735 \checkinserts
8736 }
8737
8738 % Append the tokens #2 to the definition of macro #1, not expanding either.
8739 %
8740 \def\appendtomacro#1#2{%
8741 \expandafter\def\expandafter#1\expandafter{#1#2}%
8742 }
8743
8744 % @caption, @shortcaption
8745 %
8746 \def\caption{\docaption\thiscaption}
8747 \def\shortcaption{\docaption\thisshortcaption}
8748 \def\docaption{\checkenv\float \bgroup\scanargctxt\defcaption}
8749 \def\defcaption#1#2{\egroup \def#1{#2}}
8750
8751 % The parameter is the control sequence identifying the counter we are
8752 % going to use. Create it if it doesn't exist and assign it to \floatno.
8753 \def\getfloatno#1{%
8754 \ifx#1\relax
8755 % Haven't seen this figure type before.
8756 \csname newcount\endcsname #1%
8757 %
8758 % Remember to reset this floatno at the next chap.
8759 \expandafter\gdef\expandafter\resetallfloatnos
8760 \expandafter{\resetallfloatnos #1=0 }%
8761 \fi
8762 \let\floatno#1%
8763 }
8764
8765 % \setref calls this to get the XREFLABEL-snt value. We want an @xref
8766 % to the FLOATLABEL to expand to "Figure 3.1". We call \setref when we
8767 % first read the @float command.
8768 %
8769 \def\Yfloat{\floattype@tie \chaplevelprefix\the\floatno}%
8770
8771 % Magic string used for the XREFLABEL-title value, so \xrefX can
8772 % distinguish floats from other xref types.
8773 \def\floatmagic{!!float!!}
8774
8775 % #1 is the control sequence we are passed; we expand into a conditional
8776 % which is true if #1 represents a float ref. That is, the magic
8777 % \lastsection value which we \setref above.
8778 %
8779 \def\iffloat#1{\expandafter\doiffloat#1==\finish}
8780 %
8781 % #1 is (maybe) the \floatmagic string. If so, #2 will be the
8782 % (safe) float type for this float. We set \iffloattype to #2.
8783 %
8784 \def\doiffloat#1=#2=#3\finish{%
8785 \def\temp{#1}%
8786 \def\iffloattype{#2}%
8787 \ifx\temp\floatmagic
8788 }
8789
8790 % @listoffloats FLOATTYPE - print a list of floats like a table of contents.
8791 %
8792 \parseargdef\listoffloats{%
8793 \def\floattype{#1}% floattype
8794 {%
8795 % the floattype might have accents or other special characters,
8796 % but we need to use it in a control sequence name.
8797 \indexnofonts
8798 \turnoffactive
8799 \xdef\safefloattype{\floattype}%
8800 }%
8801 %
8802 % \xrdef saves the floats as a \do-list in \floatlistSAFEFLOATTYPE.
8803 \expandafter\ifx\csname floatlist\safefloattype\endcsname \relax
8804 \ifhavexrefs
8805 % if the user said @listoffloats foo but never @float foo.
8806 \message{\linenumber No `\safefloattype' floats to list.}%
8807 \fi
8808 \else
8809 \begingroup
8810 \leftskip=\tocindent % indent these entries like a toc
8811 \let\do=\listoffloatsdo
8812 \csname floatlist\safefloattype\endcsname
8813 \endgroup
8814 \fi
8815 }
8816
8817 % This is called on each entry in a list of floats. We're passed the
8818 % xref label, in the form LABEL-title, which is how we save it in the
8819 % aux file. We strip off the -title and look up \XRLABEL-lof, which
8820 % has the text we're supposed to typeset here.
8821 %
8822 % Figures without xref labels will not be included in the list (since
8823 % they won't appear in the aux file).
8824 %
8825 \def\listoffloatsdo#1{\listoffloatsdoentry#1\finish}
8826 \def\listoffloatsdoentry#1-title\finish{{%
8827 % Can't fully expand XR#1-lof because it can contain anything. Just
8828 % pass the control sequence. On the other hand, XR#1-pg is just the
8829 % page number, and we want to fully expand that so we can get a link
8830 % in pdf output.
8831 \toksA = \expandafter{\csname XR#1-lof\endcsname}%
8832 %
8833 % use the same \entry macro we use to generate the TOC and index.
8834 \edef\writeentry{\noexpand\entry{\the\toksA}{\csname XR#1-pg\endcsname}}%
8835 \writeentry
8836 }}
8837
8838
8839 \message{localization,}
8840
8841 % For single-language documents, @documentlanguage is usually given very
8842 % early, just after @documentencoding. Single argument is the language
8843 % (de) or locale (de_DE) abbreviation.
8844 %
8845 {
8846 \catcode`\_ = \active
8847 \globaldefs=1
8848 \parseargdef\documentlanguage{\begingroup
8849 \let_=\normalunderscore % normal _ character for filenames
8850 \tex % read txi-??.tex file in plain TeX.
8851 % Read the file by the name they passed if it exists.
8852 \openin 1 txi-#1.tex
8853 \ifeof 1
8854 \documentlanguagetrywithoutunderscore{#1_\finish}%
8855 \else
8856 \globaldefs = 1 % everything in the txi-LL files needs to persist
8857 \input txi-#1.tex
8858 \fi
8859 \closein 1
8860 \endgroup % end raw TeX
8861 \endgroup}
8862 %
8863 % If they passed de_DE, and txi-de_DE.tex doesn't exist,
8864 % try txi-de.tex.
8865 %
8866 \gdef\documentlanguagetrywithoutunderscore#1_#2\finish{%
8867 \openin 1 txi-#1.tex
8868 \ifeof 1
8869 \errhelp = \nolanghelp
8870 \errmessage{Cannot read language file txi-#1.tex}%
8871 \else
8872 \globaldefs = 1 % everything in the txi-LL files needs to persist
8873 \input txi-#1.tex
8874 \fi
8875 \closein 1
8876 }
8877 }% end of special _ catcode
8878 %
8879 \newhelp\nolanghelp{The given language definition file cannot be found or
8880 is empty. Maybe you need to install it? Putting it in the current
8881 directory should work if nowhere else does.}
8882
8883 % This macro is called from txi-??.tex files; the first argument is the
8884 % \language name to set (without the "\lang@" prefix), the second and
8885 % third args are \{left,right}hyphenmin.
8886 %
8887 % The language names to pass are determined when the format is built.
8888 % See the etex.log file created at that time, e.g.,
8889 % /usr/local/texlive/2008/texmf-var/web2c/pdftex/etex.log.
8890 %
8891 % With TeX Live 2008, etex now includes hyphenation patterns for all
8892 % available languages. This means we can support hyphenation in
8893 % Texinfo, at least to some extent. (This still doesn't solve the
8894 % accented characters problem.)
8895 %
8896 \catcode`@=11
8897 \def\txisetlanguage#1#2#3{%
8898 % do not set the language if the name is undefined in the current TeX.
8899 \expandafter\ifx\csname lang@#1\endcsname \relax
8900 \message{no patterns for #1}%
8901 \else
8902 \global\language = \csname lang@#1\endcsname
8903 \fi
8904 % but there is no harm in adjusting the hyphenmin values regardless.
8905 \global\lefthyphenmin = #2\relax
8906 \global\righthyphenmin = #3\relax
8907 }
8908
8909 % Helpers for encodings.
8910 % Set the catcode of characters 128 through 255 to the specified number.
8911 %
8912 \def\setnonasciicharscatcode#1{%
8913 \count255=128
8914 \loop\ifnum\count255<256
8915 \global\catcode\count255=#1\relax
8916 \advance\count255 by 1
8917 \repeat
8918 }
8919
8920 \def\setnonasciicharscatcodenonglobal#1{%
8921 \count255=128
8922 \loop\ifnum\count255<256
8923 \catcode\count255=#1\relax
8924 \advance\count255 by 1
8925 \repeat
8926 }
8927
8928 % @documentencoding sets the definition of non-ASCII characters
8929 % according to the specified encoding.
8930 %
8931 \parseargdef\documentencoding{%
8932 % Encoding being declared for the document.
8933 \def\declaredencoding{\csname #1.enc\endcsname}%
8934 %
8935 % Supported encodings: names converted to tokens in order to be able
8936 % to compare them with \ifx.
8937 \def\ascii{\csname US-ASCII.enc\endcsname}%
8938 \def\latnine{\csname ISO-8859-15.enc\endcsname}%
8939 \def\latone{\csname ISO-8859-1.enc\endcsname}%
8940 \def\lattwo{\csname ISO-8859-2.enc\endcsname}%
8941 \def\utfeight{\csname UTF-8.enc\endcsname}%
8942 %
8943 \ifx \declaredencoding \ascii
8944 \asciichardefs
8945 %
8946 \else \ifx \declaredencoding \lattwo
8947 \setnonasciicharscatcode\active
8948 \lattwochardefs
8949 %
8950 \else \ifx \declaredencoding \latone
8951 \setnonasciicharscatcode\active
8952 \latonechardefs
8953 %
8954 \else \ifx \declaredencoding \latnine
8955 \setnonasciicharscatcode\active
8956 \latninechardefs
8957 %
8958 \else \ifx \declaredencoding \utfeight
8959 \setnonasciicharscatcode\active
8960 \utfeightchardefs
8961 %
8962 \else
8963 \message{Unknown document encoding #1, ignoring.}%
8964 %
8965 \fi % utfeight
8966 \fi % latnine
8967 \fi % latone
8968 \fi % lattwo
8969 \fi % ascii
8970 }
8971
8972 % A message to be logged when using a character that isn't available
8973 % the default font encoding (OT1).
8974 %
8975 \def\missingcharmsg#1{\message{Character missing in OT1 encoding: #1.}}
8976
8977 % Take account of \c (plain) vs. \, (Texinfo) difference.
8978 \def\cedilla#1{\ifx\c\ptexc\c{#1}\else\,{#1}\fi}
8979
8980 % First, make active non-ASCII characters in order for them to be
8981 % correctly categorized when TeX reads the replacement text of
8982 % macros containing the character definitions.
8983 \setnonasciicharscatcode\active
8984 %
8985 % Latin1 (ISO-8859-1) character definitions.
8986 \def\latonechardefs{%
8987 \gdef^^a0{\tie}
8988 \gdef^^a1{\exclamdown}
8989 \gdef^^a2{\missingcharmsg{CENT SIGN}}
8990 \gdef^^a3{{\pounds}}
8991 \gdef^^a4{\missingcharmsg{CURRENCY SIGN}}
8992 \gdef^^a5{\missingcharmsg{YEN SIGN}}
8993 \gdef^^a6{\missingcharmsg{BROKEN BAR}}
8994 \gdef^^a7{\S}
8995 \gdef^^a8{\"{}}
8996 \gdef^^a9{\copyright}
8997 \gdef^^aa{\ordf}
8998 \gdef^^ab{\guillemetleft}
8999 \gdef^^ac{$\lnot$}
9000 \gdef^^ad{\-}
9001 \gdef^^ae{\registeredsymbol}
9002 \gdef^^af{\={}}
9003 %
9004 \gdef^^b0{\textdegree}
9005 \gdef^^b1{$\pm$}
9006 \gdef^^b2{$^2$}
9007 \gdef^^b3{$^3$}
9008 \gdef^^b4{\'{}}
9009 \gdef^^b5{$\mu$}
9010 \gdef^^b6{\P}
9011 %
9012 \gdef^^b7{$^.$}
9013 \gdef^^b8{\cedilla\ }
9014 \gdef^^b9{$^1$}
9015 \gdef^^ba{\ordm}
9016 %
9017 \gdef^^bb{\guillemetright}
9018 \gdef^^bc{$1\over4$}
9019 \gdef^^bd{$1\over2$}
9020 \gdef^^be{$3\over4$}
9021 \gdef^^bf{\questiondown}
9022 %
9023 \gdef^^c0{\`A}
9024 \gdef^^c1{\'A}
9025 \gdef^^c2{\^A}
9026 \gdef^^c3{\~A}
9027 \gdef^^c4{\"A}
9028 \gdef^^c5{\ringaccent A}
9029 \gdef^^c6{\AE}
9030 \gdef^^c7{\cedilla C}
9031 \gdef^^c8{\`E}
9032 \gdef^^c9{\'E}
9033 \gdef^^ca{\^E}
9034 \gdef^^cb{\"E}
9035 \gdef^^cc{\`I}
9036 \gdef^^cd{\'I}
9037 \gdef^^ce{\^I}
9038 \gdef^^cf{\"I}
9039 %
9040 \gdef^^d0{\DH}
9041 \gdef^^d1{\~N}
9042 \gdef^^d2{\`O}
9043 \gdef^^d3{\'O}
9044 \gdef^^d4{\^O}
9045 \gdef^^d5{\~O}
9046 \gdef^^d6{\"O}
9047 \gdef^^d7{$\times$}
9048 \gdef^^d8{\O}
9049 \gdef^^d9{\`U}
9050 \gdef^^da{\'U}
9051 \gdef^^db{\^U}
9052 \gdef^^dc{\"U}
9053 \gdef^^dd{\'Y}
9054 \gdef^^de{\TH}
9055 \gdef^^df{\ss}
9056 %
9057 \gdef^^e0{\`a}
9058 \gdef^^e1{\'a}
9059 \gdef^^e2{\^a}
9060 \gdef^^e3{\~a}
9061 \gdef^^e4{\"a}
9062 \gdef^^e5{\ringaccent a}
9063 \gdef^^e6{\ae}
9064 \gdef^^e7{\cedilla c}
9065 \gdef^^e8{\`e}
9066 \gdef^^e9{\'e}
9067 \gdef^^ea{\^e}
9068 \gdef^^eb{\"e}
9069 \gdef^^ec{\`{\dotless i}}
9070 \gdef^^ed{\'{\dotless i}}
9071 \gdef^^ee{\^{\dotless i}}
9072 \gdef^^ef{\"{\dotless i}}
9073 %
9074 \gdef^^f0{\dh}
9075 \gdef^^f1{\~n}
9076 \gdef^^f2{\`o}
9077 \gdef^^f3{\'o}
9078 \gdef^^f4{\^o}
9079 \gdef^^f5{\~o}
9080 \gdef^^f6{\"o}
9081 \gdef^^f7{$\div$}
9082 \gdef^^f8{\o}
9083 \gdef^^f9{\`u}
9084 \gdef^^fa{\'u}
9085 \gdef^^fb{\^u}
9086 \gdef^^fc{\"u}
9087 \gdef^^fd{\'y}
9088 \gdef^^fe{\th}
9089 \gdef^^ff{\"y}
9090 }
9091
9092 % Latin9 (ISO-8859-15) encoding character definitions.
9093 \def\latninechardefs{%
9094 % Encoding is almost identical to Latin1.
9095 \latonechardefs
9096 %
9097 \gdef^^a4{\euro}
9098 \gdef^^a6{\v S}
9099 \gdef^^a8{\v s}
9100 \gdef^^b4{\v Z}
9101 \gdef^^b8{\v z}
9102 \gdef^^bc{\OE}
9103 \gdef^^bd{\oe}
9104 \gdef^^be{\"Y}
9105 }
9106
9107 % Latin2 (ISO-8859-2) character definitions.
9108 \def\lattwochardefs{%
9109 \gdef^^a0{\tie}
9110 \gdef^^a1{\ogonek{A}}
9111 \gdef^^a2{\u{}}
9112 \gdef^^a3{\L}
9113 \gdef^^a4{\missingcharmsg{CURRENCY SIGN}}
9114 \gdef^^a5{\v L}
9115 \gdef^^a6{\'S}
9116 \gdef^^a7{\S}
9117 \gdef^^a8{\"{}}
9118 \gdef^^a9{\v S}
9119 \gdef^^aa{\cedilla S}
9120 \gdef^^ab{\v T}
9121 \gdef^^ac{\'Z}
9122 \gdef^^ad{\-}
9123 \gdef^^ae{\v Z}
9124 \gdef^^af{\dotaccent Z}
9125 %
9126 \gdef^^b0{\textdegree}
9127 \gdef^^b1{\ogonek{a}}
9128 \gdef^^b2{\ogonek{ }}
9129 \gdef^^b3{\l}
9130 \gdef^^b4{\'{}}
9131 \gdef^^b5{\v l}
9132 \gdef^^b6{\'s}
9133 \gdef^^b7{\v{}}
9134 \gdef^^b8{\cedilla\ }
9135 \gdef^^b9{\v s}
9136 \gdef^^ba{\cedilla s}
9137 \gdef^^bb{\v t}
9138 \gdef^^bc{\'z}
9139 \gdef^^bd{\H{}}
9140 \gdef^^be{\v z}
9141 \gdef^^bf{\dotaccent z}
9142 %
9143 \gdef^^c0{\'R}
9144 \gdef^^c1{\'A}
9145 \gdef^^c2{\^A}
9146 \gdef^^c3{\u A}
9147 \gdef^^c4{\"A}
9148 \gdef^^c5{\'L}
9149 \gdef^^c6{\'C}
9150 \gdef^^c7{\cedilla C}
9151 \gdef^^c8{\v C}
9152 \gdef^^c9{\'E}
9153 \gdef^^ca{\ogonek{E}}
9154 \gdef^^cb{\"E}
9155 \gdef^^cc{\v E}
9156 \gdef^^cd{\'I}
9157 \gdef^^ce{\^I}
9158 \gdef^^cf{\v D}
9159 %
9160 \gdef^^d0{\DH}
9161 \gdef^^d1{\'N}
9162 \gdef^^d2{\v N}
9163 \gdef^^d3{\'O}
9164 \gdef^^d4{\^O}
9165 \gdef^^d5{\H O}
9166 \gdef^^d6{\"O}
9167 \gdef^^d7{$\times$}
9168 \gdef^^d8{\v R}
9169 \gdef^^d9{\ringaccent U}
9170 \gdef^^da{\'U}
9171 \gdef^^db{\H U}
9172 \gdef^^dc{\"U}
9173 \gdef^^dd{\'Y}
9174 \gdef^^de{\cedilla T}
9175 \gdef^^df{\ss}
9176 %
9177 \gdef^^e0{\'r}
9178 \gdef^^e1{\'a}
9179 \gdef^^e2{\^a}
9180 \gdef^^e3{\u a}
9181 \gdef^^e4{\"a}
9182 \gdef^^e5{\'l}
9183 \gdef^^e6{\'c}
9184 \gdef^^e7{\cedilla c}
9185 \gdef^^e8{\v c}
9186 \gdef^^e9{\'e}
9187 \gdef^^ea{\ogonek{e}}
9188 \gdef^^eb{\"e}
9189 \gdef^^ec{\v e}
9190 \gdef^^ed{\'{\dotless{i}}}
9191 \gdef^^ee{\^{\dotless{i}}}
9192 \gdef^^ef{\v d}
9193 %
9194 \gdef^^f0{\dh}
9195 \gdef^^f1{\'n}
9196 \gdef^^f2{\v n}
9197 \gdef^^f3{\'o}
9198 \gdef^^f4{\^o}
9199 \gdef^^f5{\H o}
9200 \gdef^^f6{\"o}
9201 \gdef^^f7{$\div$}
9202 \gdef^^f8{\v r}
9203 \gdef^^f9{\ringaccent u}
9204 \gdef^^fa{\'u}
9205 \gdef^^fb{\H u}
9206 \gdef^^fc{\"u}
9207 \gdef^^fd{\'y}
9208 \gdef^^fe{\cedilla t}
9209 \gdef^^ff{\dotaccent{}}
9210 }
9211
9212 % UTF-8 character definitions.
9213 %
9214 % This code to support UTF-8 is based on LaTeX's utf8.def, with some
9215 % changes for Texinfo conventions. It is included here under the GPL by
9216 % permission from Frank Mittelbach and the LaTeX team.
9217 %
9218 \newcount\countUTFx
9219 \newcount\countUTFy
9220 \newcount\countUTFz
9221
9222 \gdef\UTFviiiTwoOctets#1#2{\expandafter
9223 \UTFviiiDefined\csname u8:#1\string #2\endcsname}
9224 %
9225 \gdef\UTFviiiThreeOctets#1#2#3{\expandafter
9226 \UTFviiiDefined\csname u8:#1\string #2\string #3\endcsname}
9227 %
9228 \gdef\UTFviiiFourOctets#1#2#3#4{\expandafter
9229 \UTFviiiDefined\csname u8:#1\string #2\string #3\string #4\endcsname}
9230
9231 \gdef\UTFviiiDefined#1{%
9232 \ifx #1\relax
9233 \message{\linenumber Unicode char \string #1 not defined for Texinfo}%
9234 \else
9235 \expandafter #1%
9236 \fi
9237 }
9238
9239 \begingroup
9240 \catcode`\~13
9241 \catcode`\"12
9242
9243 \def\UTFviiiLoop{%
9244 \global\catcode\countUTFx\active
9245 \uccode`\~\countUTFx
9246 \uppercase\expandafter{\UTFviiiTmp}%
9247 \advance\countUTFx by 1
9248 \ifnum\countUTFx < \countUTFy
9249 \expandafter\UTFviiiLoop
9250 \fi}
9251
9252 \countUTFx = "C2
9253 \countUTFy = "E0
9254 \def\UTFviiiTmp{%
9255 \xdef~{\noexpand\UTFviiiTwoOctets\string~}}
9256 \UTFviiiLoop
9257
9258 \countUTFx = "E0
9259 \countUTFy = "F0
9260 \def\UTFviiiTmp{%
9261 \xdef~{\noexpand\UTFviiiThreeOctets\string~}}
9262 \UTFviiiLoop
9263
9264 \countUTFx = "F0
9265 \countUTFy = "F4
9266 \def\UTFviiiTmp{%
9267 \xdef~{\noexpand\UTFviiiFourOctets\string~}}
9268 \UTFviiiLoop
9269 \endgroup
9270
9271 \begingroup
9272 \catcode`\"=12
9273 \catcode`\<=12
9274 \catcode`\.=12
9275 \catcode`\,=12
9276 \catcode`\;=12
9277 \catcode`\!=12
9278 \catcode`\~=13
9279
9280 \gdef\DeclareUnicodeCharacter#1#2{%
9281 \countUTFz = "#1\relax
9282 %\wlog{\space\space defining Unicode char U+#1 (decimal \the\countUTFz)}%
9283 \begingroup
9284 \parseXMLCharref
9285 \def\UTFviiiTwoOctets##1##2{%
9286 \csname u8:##1\string ##2\endcsname}%
9287 \def\UTFviiiThreeOctets##1##2##3{%
9288 \csname u8:##1\string ##2\string ##3\endcsname}%
9289 \def\UTFviiiFourOctets##1##2##3##4{%
9290 \csname u8:##1\string ##2\string ##3\string ##4\endcsname}%
9291 \expandafter\expandafter\expandafter\expandafter
9292 \expandafter\expandafter\expandafter
9293 \gdef\UTFviiiTmp{#2}%
9294 \endgroup}
9295
9296 \gdef\parseXMLCharref{%
9297 \ifnum\countUTFz < "A0\relax
9298 \errhelp = \EMsimple
9299 \errmessage{Cannot define Unicode char value < 00A0}%
9300 \else\ifnum\countUTFz < "800\relax
9301 \parseUTFviiiA,%
9302 \parseUTFviiiB C\UTFviiiTwoOctets.,%
9303 \else\ifnum\countUTFz < "10000\relax
9304 \parseUTFviiiA;%
9305 \parseUTFviiiA,%
9306 \parseUTFviiiB E\UTFviiiThreeOctets.{,;}%
9307 \else
9308 \parseUTFviiiA;%
9309 \parseUTFviiiA,%
9310 \parseUTFviiiA!%
9311 \parseUTFviiiB F\UTFviiiFourOctets.{!,;}%
9312 \fi\fi\fi
9313 }
9314
9315 \gdef\parseUTFviiiA#1{%
9316 \countUTFx = \countUTFz
9317 \divide\countUTFz by 64
9318 \countUTFy = \countUTFz
9319 \multiply\countUTFz by 64
9320 \advance\countUTFx by -\countUTFz
9321 \advance\countUTFx by 128
9322 \uccode `#1\countUTFx
9323 \countUTFz = \countUTFy}
9324
9325 \gdef\parseUTFviiiB#1#2#3#4{%
9326 \advance\countUTFz by "#10\relax
9327 \uccode `#3\countUTFz
9328 \uppercase{\gdef\UTFviiiTmp{#2#3#4}}}
9329 \endgroup
9330
9331 \def\utfeightchardefs{%
9332 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00A0}{\tie}
9333 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00A1}{\exclamdown}
9334 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00A3}{\pounds}
9335 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00A8}{\"{ }}
9336 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00A9}{\copyright}
9337 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00AA}{\ordf}
9338 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00AB}{\guillemetleft}
9339 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00AD}{\-}
9340 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00AE}{\registeredsymbol}
9341 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00AF}{\={ }}
9342
9343 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00B0}{\ringaccent{ }}
9344 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00B4}{\'{ }}
9345 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00B8}{\cedilla{ }}
9346 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00BA}{\ordm}
9347 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00BB}{\guillemetright}
9348 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00BF}{\questiondown}
9349
9350 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00C0}{\`A}
9351 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00C1}{\'A}
9352 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00C2}{\^A}
9353 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00C3}{\~A}
9354 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00C4}{\"A}
9355 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00C5}{\AA}
9356 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00C6}{\AE}
9357 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00C7}{\cedilla{C}}
9358 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00C8}{\`E}
9359 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00C9}{\'E}
9360 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00CA}{\^E}
9361 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00CB}{\"E}
9362 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00CC}{\`I}
9363 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00CD}{\'I}
9364 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00CE}{\^I}
9365 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00CF}{\"I}
9366
9367 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00D0}{\DH}
9368 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00D1}{\~N}
9369 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00D2}{\`O}
9370 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00D3}{\'O}
9371 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00D4}{\^O}
9372 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00D5}{\~O}
9373 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00D6}{\"O}
9374 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00D8}{\O}
9375 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00D9}{\`U}
9376 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00DA}{\'U}
9377 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00DB}{\^U}
9378 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00DC}{\"U}
9379 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00DD}{\'Y}
9380 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00DE}{\TH}
9381 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00DF}{\ss}
9382
9383 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00E0}{\`a}
9384 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00E1}{\'a}
9385 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00E2}{\^a}
9386 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00E3}{\~a}
9387 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00E4}{\"a}
9388 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00E5}{\aa}
9389 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00E6}{\ae}
9390 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00E7}{\cedilla{c}}
9391 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00E8}{\`e}
9392 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00E9}{\'e}
9393 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00EA}{\^e}
9394 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00EB}{\"e}
9395 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00EC}{\`{\dotless{i}}}
9396 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00ED}{\'{\dotless{i}}}
9397 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00EE}{\^{\dotless{i}}}
9398 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00EF}{\"{\dotless{i}}}
9399
9400 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00F0}{\dh}
9401 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00F1}{\~n}
9402 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00F2}{\`o}
9403 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00F3}{\'o}
9404 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00F4}{\^o}
9405 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00F5}{\~o}
9406 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00F6}{\"o}
9407 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00F8}{\o}
9408 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00F9}{\`u}
9409 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00FA}{\'u}
9410 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00FB}{\^u}
9411 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00FC}{\"u}
9412 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00FD}{\'y}
9413 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00FE}{\th}
9414 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{00FF}{\"y}
9415
9416 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0100}{\=A}
9417 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0101}{\=a}
9418 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0102}{\u{A}}
9419 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0103}{\u{a}}
9420 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0104}{\ogonek{A}}
9421 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0105}{\ogonek{a}}
9422 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0106}{\'C}
9423 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0107}{\'c}
9424 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0108}{\^C}
9425 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0109}{\^c}
9426 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0118}{\ogonek{E}}
9427 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0119}{\ogonek{e}}
9428 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{010A}{\dotaccent{C}}
9429 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{010B}{\dotaccent{c}}
9430 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{010C}{\v{C}}
9431 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{010D}{\v{c}}
9432 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{010E}{\v{D}}
9433
9434 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0112}{\=E}
9435 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0113}{\=e}
9436 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0114}{\u{E}}
9437 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0115}{\u{e}}
9438 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0116}{\dotaccent{E}}
9439 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0117}{\dotaccent{e}}
9440 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{011A}{\v{E}}
9441 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{011B}{\v{e}}
9442 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{011C}{\^G}
9443 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{011D}{\^g}
9444 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{011E}{\u{G}}
9445 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{011F}{\u{g}}
9446
9447 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0120}{\dotaccent{G}}
9448 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0121}{\dotaccent{g}}
9449 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0124}{\^H}
9450 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0125}{\^h}
9451 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0128}{\~I}
9452 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0129}{\~{\dotless{i}}}
9453 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{012A}{\=I}
9454 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{012B}{\={\dotless{i}}}
9455 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{012C}{\u{I}}
9456 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{012D}{\u{\dotless{i}}}
9457
9458 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0130}{\dotaccent{I}}
9459 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0131}{\dotless{i}}
9460 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0132}{IJ}
9461 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0133}{ij}
9462 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0134}{\^J}
9463 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0135}{\^{\dotless{j}}}
9464 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0139}{\'L}
9465 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{013A}{\'l}
9466
9467 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0141}{\L}
9468 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0142}{\l}
9469 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0143}{\'N}
9470 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0144}{\'n}
9471 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0147}{\v{N}}
9472 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0148}{\v{n}}
9473 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{014C}{\=O}
9474 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{014D}{\=o}
9475 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{014E}{\u{O}}
9476 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{014F}{\u{o}}
9477
9478 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0150}{\H{O}}
9479 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0151}{\H{o}}
9480 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0152}{\OE}
9481 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0153}{\oe}
9482 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0154}{\'R}
9483 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0155}{\'r}
9484 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0158}{\v{R}}
9485 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0159}{\v{r}}
9486 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{015A}{\'S}
9487 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{015B}{\'s}
9488 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{015C}{\^S}
9489 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{015D}{\^s}
9490 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{015E}{\cedilla{S}}
9491 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{015F}{\cedilla{s}}
9492
9493 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0160}{\v{S}}
9494 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0161}{\v{s}}
9495 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0162}{\cedilla{t}}
9496 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0163}{\cedilla{T}}
9497 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0164}{\v{T}}
9498
9499 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0168}{\~U}
9500 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0169}{\~u}
9501 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{016A}{\=U}
9502 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{016B}{\=u}
9503 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{016C}{\u{U}}
9504 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{016D}{\u{u}}
9505 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{016E}{\ringaccent{U}}
9506 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{016F}{\ringaccent{u}}
9507
9508 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0170}{\H{U}}
9509 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0171}{\H{u}}
9510 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0174}{\^W}
9511 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0175}{\^w}
9512 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0176}{\^Y}
9513 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0177}{\^y}
9514 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0178}{\"Y}
9515 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0179}{\'Z}
9516 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{017A}{\'z}
9517 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{017B}{\dotaccent{Z}}
9518 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{017C}{\dotaccent{z}}
9519 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{017D}{\v{Z}}
9520 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{017E}{\v{z}}
9521
9522 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01C4}{D\v{Z}}
9523 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01C5}{D\v{z}}
9524 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01C6}{d\v{z}}
9525 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01C7}{LJ}
9526 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01C8}{Lj}
9527 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01C9}{lj}
9528 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01CA}{NJ}
9529 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01CB}{Nj}
9530 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01CC}{nj}
9531 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01CD}{\v{A}}
9532 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01CE}{\v{a}}
9533 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01CF}{\v{I}}
9534
9535 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01D0}{\v{\dotless{i}}}
9536 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01D1}{\v{O}}
9537 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01D2}{\v{o}}
9538 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01D3}{\v{U}}
9539 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01D4}{\v{u}}
9540
9541 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01E2}{\={\AE}}
9542 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01E3}{\={\ae}}
9543 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01E6}{\v{G}}
9544 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01E7}{\v{g}}
9545 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01E8}{\v{K}}
9546 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01E9}{\v{k}}
9547
9548 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01F0}{\v{\dotless{j}}}
9549 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01F1}{DZ}
9550 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01F2}{Dz}
9551 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01F3}{dz}
9552 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01F4}{\'G}
9553 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01F5}{\'g}
9554 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01F8}{\`N}
9555 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01F9}{\`n}
9556 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01FC}{\'{\AE}}
9557 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01FD}{\'{\ae}}
9558 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01FE}{\'{\O}}
9559 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{01FF}{\'{\o}}
9560
9561 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{021E}{\v{H}}
9562 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{021F}{\v{h}}
9563
9564 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0226}{\dotaccent{A}}
9565 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0227}{\dotaccent{a}}
9566 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0228}{\cedilla{E}}
9567 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0229}{\cedilla{e}}
9568 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{022E}{\dotaccent{O}}
9569 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{022F}{\dotaccent{o}}
9570
9571 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0232}{\=Y}
9572 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0233}{\=y}
9573 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{0237}{\dotless{j}}
9574
9575 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{02DB}{\ogonek{ }}
9576
9577 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E02}{\dotaccent{B}}
9578 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E03}{\dotaccent{b}}
9579 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E04}{\udotaccent{B}}
9580 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E05}{\udotaccent{b}}
9581 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E06}{\ubaraccent{B}}
9582 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E07}{\ubaraccent{b}}
9583 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E0A}{\dotaccent{D}}
9584 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E0B}{\dotaccent{d}}
9585 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E0C}{\udotaccent{D}}
9586 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E0D}{\udotaccent{d}}
9587 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E0E}{\ubaraccent{D}}
9588 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E0F}{\ubaraccent{d}}
9589
9590 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E1E}{\dotaccent{F}}
9591 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E1F}{\dotaccent{f}}
9592
9593 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E20}{\=G}
9594 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E21}{\=g}
9595 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E22}{\dotaccent{H}}
9596 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E23}{\dotaccent{h}}
9597 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E24}{\udotaccent{H}}
9598 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E25}{\udotaccent{h}}
9599 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E26}{\"H}
9600 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E27}{\"h}
9601
9602 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E30}{\'K}
9603 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E31}{\'k}
9604 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E32}{\udotaccent{K}}
9605 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E33}{\udotaccent{k}}
9606 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E34}{\ubaraccent{K}}
9607 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E35}{\ubaraccent{k}}
9608 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E36}{\udotaccent{L}}
9609 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E37}{\udotaccent{l}}
9610 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E3A}{\ubaraccent{L}}
9611 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E3B}{\ubaraccent{l}}
9612 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E3E}{\'M}
9613 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E3F}{\'m}
9614
9615 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E40}{\dotaccent{M}}
9616 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E41}{\dotaccent{m}}
9617 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E42}{\udotaccent{M}}
9618 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E43}{\udotaccent{m}}
9619 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E44}{\dotaccent{N}}
9620 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E45}{\dotaccent{n}}
9621 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E46}{\udotaccent{N}}
9622 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E47}{\udotaccent{n}}
9623 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E48}{\ubaraccent{N}}
9624 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E49}{\ubaraccent{n}}
9625
9626 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E54}{\'P}
9627 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E55}{\'p}
9628 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E56}{\dotaccent{P}}
9629 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E57}{\dotaccent{p}}
9630 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E58}{\dotaccent{R}}
9631 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E59}{\dotaccent{r}}
9632 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E5A}{\udotaccent{R}}
9633 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E5B}{\udotaccent{r}}
9634 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E5E}{\ubaraccent{R}}
9635 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E5F}{\ubaraccent{r}}
9636
9637 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E60}{\dotaccent{S}}
9638 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E61}{\dotaccent{s}}
9639 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E62}{\udotaccent{S}}
9640 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E63}{\udotaccent{s}}
9641 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E6A}{\dotaccent{T}}
9642 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E6B}{\dotaccent{t}}
9643 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E6C}{\udotaccent{T}}
9644 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E6D}{\udotaccent{t}}
9645 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E6E}{\ubaraccent{T}}
9646 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E6F}{\ubaraccent{t}}
9647
9648 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E7C}{\~V}
9649 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E7D}{\~v}
9650 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E7E}{\udotaccent{V}}
9651 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E7F}{\udotaccent{v}}
9652
9653 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E80}{\`W}
9654 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E81}{\`w}
9655 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E82}{\'W}
9656 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E83}{\'w}
9657 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E84}{\"W}
9658 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E85}{\"w}
9659 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E86}{\dotaccent{W}}
9660 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E87}{\dotaccent{w}}
9661 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E88}{\udotaccent{W}}
9662 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E89}{\udotaccent{w}}
9663 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E8A}{\dotaccent{X}}
9664 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E8B}{\dotaccent{x}}
9665 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E8C}{\"X}
9666 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E8D}{\"x}
9667 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E8E}{\dotaccent{Y}}
9668 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E8F}{\dotaccent{y}}
9669
9670 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E90}{\^Z}
9671 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E91}{\^z}
9672 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E92}{\udotaccent{Z}}
9673 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E93}{\udotaccent{z}}
9674 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E94}{\ubaraccent{Z}}
9675 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E95}{\ubaraccent{z}}
9676 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E96}{\ubaraccent{h}}
9677 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E97}{\"t}
9678 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E98}{\ringaccent{w}}
9679 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1E99}{\ringaccent{y}}
9680
9681 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EA0}{\udotaccent{A}}
9682 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EA1}{\udotaccent{a}}
9683
9684 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EB8}{\udotaccent{E}}
9685 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EB9}{\udotaccent{e}}
9686 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EBC}{\~E}
9687 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EBD}{\~e}
9688
9689 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1ECA}{\udotaccent{I}}
9690 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1ECB}{\udotaccent{i}}
9691 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1ECC}{\udotaccent{O}}
9692 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1ECD}{\udotaccent{o}}
9693
9694 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EE4}{\udotaccent{U}}
9695 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EE5}{\udotaccent{u}}
9696
9697 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EF2}{\`Y}
9698 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EF3}{\`y}
9699 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EF4}{\udotaccent{Y}}
9700
9701 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EF8}{\~Y}
9702 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{1EF9}{\~y}
9703
9704 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2013}{--}
9705 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2014}{---}
9706 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2018}{\quoteleft}
9707 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2019}{\quoteright}
9708 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{201A}{\quotesinglbase}
9709 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{201C}{\quotedblleft}
9710 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{201D}{\quotedblright}
9711 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{201E}{\quotedblbase}
9712 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2022}{\bullet}
9713 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2026}{\dots}
9714 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2039}{\guilsinglleft}
9715 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{203A}{\guilsinglright}
9716 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{20AC}{\euro}
9717
9718 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2192}{\expansion}
9719 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{21D2}{\result}
9720
9721 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2212}{\minus}
9722 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2217}{\point}
9723 \DeclareUnicodeCharacter{2261}{\equiv}
9724 }% end of \utfeightchardefs
9725
9726
9727 % US-ASCII character definitions.
9728 \def\asciichardefs{% nothing need be done
9729 \relax
9730 }
9731
9732 % Make non-ASCII characters printable again for compatibility with
9733 % existing Texinfo documents that may use them, even without declaring a
9734 % document encoding.
9735 %
9736 \setnonasciicharscatcode \other
9737
9738
9739 \message{formatting,}
9740
9741 \newdimen\defaultparindent \defaultparindent = 15pt
9742
9743 \chapheadingskip = 15pt plus 4pt minus 2pt
9744 \secheadingskip = 12pt plus 3pt minus 2pt
9745 \subsecheadingskip = 9pt plus 2pt minus 2pt
9746
9747 % Prevent underfull vbox error messages.
9748 \vbadness = 10000
9749
9750 % Don't be very finicky about underfull hboxes, either.
9751 \hbadness = 6666
9752
9753 % Following George Bush, get rid of widows and orphans.
9754 \widowpenalty=10000
9755 \clubpenalty=10000
9756
9757 % Use TeX 3.0's \emergencystretch to help line breaking, but if we're
9758 % using an old version of TeX, don't do anything. We want the amount of
9759 % stretch added to depend on the line length, hence the dependence on
9760 % \hsize. We call this whenever the paper size is set.
9761 %
9762 \def\setemergencystretch{%
9763 \ifx\emergencystretch\thisisundefined
9764 % Allow us to assign to \emergencystretch anyway.
9765 \def\emergencystretch{\dimen0}%
9766 \else
9767 \emergencystretch = .15\hsize
9768 \fi
9769 }
9770
9771 % Parameters in order: 1) textheight; 2) textwidth;
9772 % 3) voffset; 4) hoffset; 5) binding offset; 6) topskip;
9773 % 7) physical page height; 8) physical page width.
9774 %
9775 % We also call \setleading{\textleading}, so the caller should define
9776 % \textleading. The caller should also set \parskip.
9777 %
9778 \def\internalpagesizes#1#2#3#4#5#6#7#8{%
9779 \voffset = #3\relax
9780 \topskip = #6\relax
9781 \splittopskip = \topskip
9782 %
9783 \vsize = #1\relax
9784 \advance\vsize by \topskip
9785 \outervsize = \vsize
9786 \advance\outervsize by 2\topandbottommargin
9787 \pageheight = \vsize
9788 %
9789 \hsize = #2\relax
9790 \outerhsize = \hsize
9791 \advance\outerhsize by 0.5in
9792 \pagewidth = \hsize
9793 %
9794 \normaloffset = #4\relax
9795 \bindingoffset = #5\relax
9796 %
9797 \ifpdf
9798 \pdfpageheight #7\relax
9799 \pdfpagewidth #8\relax
9800 % if we don't reset these, they will remain at "1 true in" of
9801 % whatever layout pdftex was dumped with.
9802 \pdfhorigin = 1 true in
9803 \pdfvorigin = 1 true in
9804 \fi
9805 %
9806 \setleading{\textleading}
9807 %
9808 \parindent = \defaultparindent
9809 \setemergencystretch
9810 }
9811
9812 % @letterpaper (the default).
9813 \def\letterpaper{{\globaldefs = 1
9814 \parskip = 3pt plus 2pt minus 1pt
9815 \textleading = 13.2pt
9816 %
9817 % If page is nothing but text, make it come out even.
9818 \internalpagesizes{607.2pt}{6in}% that's 46 lines
9819 {\voffset}{.25in}%
9820 {\bindingoffset}{36pt}%
9821 {11in}{8.5in}%
9822 }}
9823
9824 % Use @smallbook to reset parameters for 7x9.25 trim size.
9825 \def\smallbook{{\globaldefs = 1
9826 \parskip = 2pt plus 1pt
9827 \textleading = 12pt
9828 %
9829 \internalpagesizes{7.5in}{5in}%
9830 {-.2in}{0in}%
9831 {\bindingoffset}{16pt}%
9832 {9.25in}{7in}%
9833 %
9834 \lispnarrowing = 0.3in
9835 \tolerance = 700
9836 \hfuzz = 1pt
9837 \contentsrightmargin = 0pt
9838 \defbodyindent = .5cm
9839 }}
9840
9841 % Use @smallerbook to reset parameters for 6x9 trim size.
9842 % (Just testing, parameters still in flux.)
9843 \def\smallerbook{{\globaldefs = 1
9844 \parskip = 1.5pt plus 1pt
9845 \textleading = 12pt
9846 %
9847 \internalpagesizes{7.4in}{4.8in}%
9848 {-.2in}{-.4in}%
9849 {0pt}{14pt}%
9850 {9in}{6in}%
9851 %
9852 \lispnarrowing = 0.25in
9853 \tolerance = 700
9854 \hfuzz = 1pt
9855 \contentsrightmargin = 0pt
9856 \defbodyindent = .4cm
9857 }}
9858
9859 % Use @afourpaper to print on European A4 paper.
9860 \def\afourpaper{{\globaldefs = 1
9861 \parskip = 3pt plus 2pt minus 1pt
9862 \textleading = 13.2pt
9863 %
9864 % Double-side printing via postscript on Laserjet 4050
9865 % prints double-sided nicely when \bindingoffset=10mm and \hoffset=-6mm.
9866 % To change the settings for a different printer or situation, adjust
9867 % \normaloffset until the front-side and back-side texts align. Then
9868 % do the same for \bindingoffset. You can set these for testing in
9869 % your texinfo source file like this:
9870 % @tex
9871 % \global\normaloffset = -6mm
9872 % \global\bindingoffset = 10mm
9873 % @end tex
9874 \internalpagesizes{673.2pt}{160mm}% that's 51 lines
9875 {\voffset}{\hoffset}%
9876 {\bindingoffset}{44pt}%
9877 {297mm}{210mm}%
9878 %
9879 \tolerance = 700
9880 \hfuzz = 1pt
9881 \contentsrightmargin = 0pt
9882 \defbodyindent = 5mm
9883 }}
9884
9885 % Use @afivepaper to print on European A5 paper.
9886 % From romildo@urano.iceb.ufop.br, 2 July 2000.
9887 % He also recommends making @example and @lisp be small.
9888 \def\afivepaper{{\globaldefs = 1
9889 \parskip = 2pt plus 1pt minus 0.1pt
9890 \textleading = 12.5pt
9891 %
9892 \internalpagesizes{160mm}{120mm}%
9893 {\voffset}{\hoffset}%
9894 {\bindingoffset}{8pt}%
9895 {210mm}{148mm}%
9896 %
9897 \lispnarrowing = 0.2in
9898 \tolerance = 800
9899 \hfuzz = 1.2pt
9900 \contentsrightmargin = 0pt
9901 \defbodyindent = 2mm
9902 \tableindent = 12mm
9903 }}
9904
9905 % A specific text layout, 24x15cm overall, intended for A4 paper.
9906 \def\afourlatex{{\globaldefs = 1
9907 \afourpaper
9908 \internalpagesizes{237mm}{150mm}%
9909 {\voffset}{4.6mm}%
9910 {\bindingoffset}{7mm}%
9911 {297mm}{210mm}%
9912 %
9913 % Must explicitly reset to 0 because we call \afourpaper.
9914 \globaldefs = 0
9915 }}
9916
9917 % Use @afourwide to print on A4 paper in landscape format.
9918 \def\afourwide{{\globaldefs = 1
9919 \afourpaper
9920 \internalpagesizes{241mm}{165mm}%
9921 {\voffset}{-2.95mm}%
9922 {\bindingoffset}{7mm}%
9923 {297mm}{210mm}%
9924 \globaldefs = 0
9925 }}
9926
9927 % @pagesizes TEXTHEIGHT[,TEXTWIDTH]
9928 % Perhaps we should allow setting the margins, \topskip, \parskip,
9929 % and/or leading, also. Or perhaps we should compute them somehow.
9930 %
9931 \parseargdef\pagesizes{\pagesizesyyy #1,,\finish}
9932 \def\pagesizesyyy#1,#2,#3\finish{{%
9933 \setbox0 = \hbox{\ignorespaces #2}\ifdim\wd0 > 0pt \hsize=#2\relax \fi
9934 \globaldefs = 1
9935 %
9936 \parskip = 3pt plus 2pt minus 1pt
9937 \setleading{\textleading}%
9938 %
9939 \dimen0 = #1\relax
9940 \advance\dimen0 by \voffset
9941 %
9942 \dimen2 = \hsize
9943 \advance\dimen2 by \normaloffset
9944 %
9945 \internalpagesizes{#1}{\hsize}%
9946 {\voffset}{\normaloffset}%
9947 {\bindingoffset}{44pt}%
9948 {\dimen0}{\dimen2}%
9949 }}
9950
9951 % Set default to letter.
9952 %
9953 \letterpaper
9954
9955
9956 \message{and turning on texinfo input format.}
9957
9958 \def^^L{\par} % remove \outer, so ^L can appear in an @comment
9959
9960 % DEL is a comment character, in case @c does not suffice.
9961 \catcode`\^^? = 14
9962
9963 % Define macros to output various characters with catcode for normal text.
9964 \catcode`\"=\other \def\normaldoublequote{"}
9965 \catcode`\$=\other \def\normaldollar{$}%$ font-lock fix
9966 \catcode`\+=\other \def\normalplus{+}
9967 \catcode`\<=\other \def\normalless{<}
9968 \catcode`\>=\other \def\normalgreater{>}
9969 \catcode`\^=\other \def\normalcaret{^}
9970 \catcode`\_=\other \def\normalunderscore{_}
9971 \catcode`\|=\other \def\normalverticalbar{|}
9972 \catcode`\~=\other \def\normaltilde{~}
9973
9974 % This macro is used to make a character print one way in \tt
9975 % (where it can probably be output as-is), and another way in other fonts,
9976 % where something hairier probably needs to be done.
9977 %
9978 % #1 is what to print if we are indeed using \tt; #2 is what to print
9979 % otherwise. Since all the Computer Modern typewriter fonts have zero
9980 % interword stretch (and shrink), and it is reasonable to expect all
9981 % typewriter fonts to have this, we can check that font parameter.
9982 %
9983 \def\ifusingtt#1#2{\ifdim \fontdimen3\font=0pt #1\else #2\fi}
9984
9985 % Same as above, but check for italic font. Actually this also catches
9986 % non-italic slanted fonts since it is impossible to distinguish them from
9987 % italic fonts. But since this is only used by $ and it uses \sl anyway
9988 % this is not a problem.
9989 \def\ifusingit#1#2{\ifdim \fontdimen1\font>0pt #1\else #2\fi}
9990
9991 % Turn off all special characters except @
9992 % (and those which the user can use as if they were ordinary).
9993 % Most of these we simply print from the \tt font, but for some, we can
9994 % use math or other variants that look better in normal text.
9995
9996 \catcode`\"=\active
9997 \def\activedoublequote{{\tt\char34}}
9998 \let"=\activedoublequote
9999 \catcode`\~=\active \def\activetilde{{\tt\char126}} \let~ = \activetilde
10000 \chardef\hat=`\^
10001 \catcode`\^=\active \def\activehat{{\tt \hat}} \let^ = \activehat
10002
10003 \catcode`\_=\active
10004 \def_{\ifusingtt\normalunderscore\_}
10005 \let\realunder=_
10006 % Subroutine for the previous macro.
10007 \def\_{\leavevmode \kern.07em \vbox{\hrule width.3em height.1ex}\kern .07em }
10008
10009 \catcode`\|=\active
10010 \def|{{\tt\char124}}
10011
10012 \chardef \less=`\<
10013 \catcode`\<=\active \def\activeless{{\tt \less}}\let< = \activeless
10014 \chardef \gtr=`\>
10015 \catcode`\>=\active \def\activegtr{{\tt \gtr}}\let> = \activegtr
10016 \catcode`\+=\active \def+{{\tt \char 43}}
10017 \catcode`\$=\active \def${\ifusingit{{\sl\$}}\normaldollar}%$ font-lock fix
10018
10019 % used for headline/footline in the output routine, in case the page
10020 % breaks in the middle of an @tex block.
10021 \def\texinfochars{%
10022 \let< = \activeless
10023 \let> = \activegtr
10024 \let~ = \activetilde
10025 \let^ = \activehat
10026 \markupsetuplqdefault \markupsetuprqdefault
10027 \let\b = \strong
10028 \let\i = \smartitalic
10029 % in principle, all other definitions in \tex have to be undone too.
10030 }
10031
10032 % If a .fmt file is being used, characters that might appear in a file
10033 % name cannot be active until we have parsed the command line.
10034 % So turn them off again, and have \everyjob (or @setfilename) turn them on.
10035 % \otherifyactive is called near the end of this file.
10036 \def\otherifyactive{\catcode`+=\other \catcode`\_=\other}
10037
10038 % Used sometimes to turn off (effectively) the active characters even after
10039 % parsing them.
10040 \def\turnoffactive{%
10041 \normalturnoffactive
10042 \otherbackslash
10043 }
10044
10045 \catcode`\@=0
10046
10047 % \backslashcurfont outputs one backslash character in current font,
10048 % as in \char`\\.
10049 \global\chardef\backslashcurfont=`\\
10050 \global\let\rawbackslashxx=\backslashcurfont % let existing .??s files work
10051
10052 % \realbackslash is an actual character `\' with catcode other, and
10053 % \doublebackslash is two of them (for the pdf outlines).
10054 {\catcode`\\=\other @gdef@realbackslash{\} @gdef@doublebackslash{\\}}
10055
10056 % In texinfo, backslash is an active character; it prints the backslash
10057 % in fixed width font.
10058 \catcode`\\=\active % @ for escape char from now on.
10059
10060 % The story here is that in math mode, the \char of \backslashcurfont
10061 % ends up printing the roman \ from the math symbol font (because \char
10062 % in math mode uses the \mathcode, and plain.tex sets
10063 % \mathcode`\\="026E). It seems better for @backslashchar{} to always
10064 % print a typewriter backslash, hence we use an explicit \mathchar,
10065 % which is the decimal equivalent of "715c (class 7, e.g., use \fam;
10066 % ignored family value; char position "5C). We can't use " for the
10067 % usual hex value because it has already been made active.
10068 @def@normalbackslash{{@tt @ifmmode @mathchar29020 @else @backslashcurfont @fi}}
10069 @let@backslashchar = @normalbackslash % @backslashchar{} is for user documents.
10070
10071 % On startup, @fixbackslash assigns:
10072 % @let \ = @normalbackslash
10073 % \rawbackslash defines an active \ to do \backslashcurfont.
10074 % \otherbackslash defines an active \ to be a literal `\' character with
10075 % catcode other. We switch back and forth between these.
10076 @gdef@rawbackslash{@let\=@backslashcurfont}
10077 @gdef@otherbackslash{@let\=@realbackslash}
10078
10079 % Same as @turnoffactive except outputs \ as {\tt\char`\\} instead of
10080 % the literal character `\'. Also revert - to its normal character, in
10081 % case the active - from code has slipped in.
10082 %
10083 {@catcode`- = @active
10084 @gdef@normalturnoffactive{%
10085 @let-=@normaldash
10086 @let"=@normaldoublequote
10087 @let$=@normaldollar %$ font-lock fix
10088 @let+=@normalplus
10089 @let<=@normalless
10090 @let>=@normalgreater
10091 @let\=@normalbackslash
10092 @let^=@normalcaret
10093 @let_=@normalunderscore
10094 @let|=@normalverticalbar
10095 @let~=@normaltilde
10096 @markupsetuplqdefault
10097 @markupsetuprqdefault
10098 @unsepspaces
10099 }
10100 }
10101
10102 % Make _ and + \other characters, temporarily.
10103 % This is canceled by @fixbackslash.
10104 @otherifyactive
10105
10106 % If a .fmt file is being used, we don't want the `\input texinfo' to show up.
10107 % That is what \eatinput is for; after that, the `\' should revert to printing
10108 % a backslash.
10109 %
10110 @gdef@eatinput input texinfo{@fixbackslash}
10111 @global@let\ = @eatinput
10112
10113 % On the other hand, perhaps the file did not have a `\input texinfo'. Then
10114 % the first `\' in the file would cause an error. This macro tries to fix
10115 % that, assuming it is called before the first `\' could plausibly occur.
10116 % Also turn back on active characters that might appear in the input
10117 % file name, in case not using a pre-dumped format.
10118 %
10119 @gdef@fixbackslash{%
10120 @ifx\@eatinput @let\ = @normalbackslash @fi
10121 @catcode`+=@active
10122 @catcode`@_=@active
10123 }
10124
10125 % Say @foo, not \foo, in error messages.
10126 @escapechar = `@@
10127
10128 % These (along with & and #) are made active for url-breaking, so need
10129 % active definitions as the normal characters.
10130 @def@normaldot{.}
10131 @def@normalquest{?}
10132 @def@normalslash{/}
10133
10134 % These look ok in all fonts, so just make them not special.
10135 % @hashchar{} gets its own user-level command, because of #line.
10136 @catcode`@& = @other @def@normalamp{&}
10137 @catcode`@# = @other @def@normalhash{#}
10138 @catcode`@% = @other @def@normalpercent{%}
10139
10140 @let @hashchar = @normalhash
10141
10142 @c Finally, make ` and ' active, so that txicodequoteundirected and
10143 @c txicodequotebacktick work right in, e.g., @w{@code{`foo'}}. If we
10144 @c don't make ` and ' active, @code will not get them as active chars.
10145 @c Do this last of all since we use ` in the previous @catcode assignments.
10146 @catcode`@'=@active
10147 @catcode`@`=@active
10148 @markupsetuplqdefault
10149 @markupsetuprqdefault
10150
10151 @c Local variables:
10152 @c eval: (add-hook 'write-file-hooks 'time-stamp)
10153 @c page-delimiter: "^\\\\message"
10154 @c time-stamp-start: "def\\\\texinfoversion{"
10155 @c time-stamp-format: "%:y-%02m-%02d.%02H"
10156 @c time-stamp-end: "}"
10157 @c End:
10158
10159 @c vim:sw=2:
10160
10161 @ignore
10162 arch-tag: e1b36e32-c96e-4135-a41a-0b2efa2ea115
10163 @end ignore